2007 acura rl online reference owner's...
TRANSCRIPT
2007 Acura RL Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout this manual) to navigate through this reference. For a printed owner's manual, click on authorized manuals or go to www.helminc.com.
Contents
Owner's Identification Form
Introduction .........................................................................................................................................i A Few Words About Safety ................................................................................................................iii
Your Vehicle at a Glance .....................................................................................................................4 Driver and Passenger Safety ..............................................................................................................7 Proper use and care of your vehicle's seat belts, and Supplemental Restraint System. Instruments and Controls ................................................................................................................. 59 Instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use dashboard and steering column controls. Comfort and Convenience Features .............................................................................................. 197 How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features. Before Driving.................................................................................................................................. 325What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new vehicle, and how to load luggage and other cargo. Driving .............................................................................................................................................. 339 The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park, plus towing a trailer. Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................... 379 The Maintenance Schedule shows you when you need to take your vehicle to the dealer. Taking Care of the Unexpected ...................................................................................................... 427 This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and how to handle them. Technical Information..................................................................................................................... 457 ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information. Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada) ................................................................ 473A summary of the warranties covering your new Acura, and how to contact us. Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)...................................................................................................... 477 How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index...................................................................................................................................................... I
Service Information Summary A summary of information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.
Accord Value Package Audio System
This owner’s manual should beconsidered a permanent part of thevehicle and should remain with thevehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers allmodels of the Acura RL. You mayfind descriptions of equipment andfeatures that are not on yourparticular model.
The information and specificationsincluded in this publication were ineffect at the time of approval forprinting. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.reserves the right, however, todiscontinue or change specificationsor design at any time without noticeand without incurring any obligationwhatsoever.
Owner’s Identif ication
OWNER
ADDRESS
V. I. N.
DELIVERY DATE
DEALER NAME DEALER NO.
ADDRESS
OWNER’S SIGNATURE
DEALER’S SIGNATURE
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
(Date sold to original retail purchaser)
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
06/08/12 18:17:33 31SJA620 0001
One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new vehicle is toread this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls andconvenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle soyou can refer to it at any time.
Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty bookletthoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rightsand responsibilities.
As you read this manual, you willfind information that is preceded bya symbol. Thisinformation is intended to help youavoid damage to your vehicle, otherproperty, or the environment.
Congratulations on your selection of the 2007 Acura RL. We are certain youwill be pleased with your purchase of one of the finest luxury vehicles in theworld.
Maintaining your vehicle according to the maintenance minder shown in theinstrument panel helps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preservesyour investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind thatyour dealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems uniqueto your vehicle. Your dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will bepleased to answer any questions and concerns.
Introduction
i
06/08/12 18:17:38 31SJA620 0002
California Proposition 65 Warning
This product contains or emits chemicals known to the state of California to cause cancer and birthdefects or other reproductive harm.
Event Data RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with one or more devices commonly referred to as event data recorders. These devicesrecord front seat belt use, front passenger seat occupancy, airbag deployment data, and the failure of any airbagsystem component. This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone else except as legallyrequired or with the permission of the vehicle owner.
Service Diagnostic RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance. The datacan be used to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians diagnose and solve service problems. It mayalso be combined with data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains confidential and is never linked tothe vehicle owner.
Introduction
WARNING:
ii
06/08/12 18:17:42 31SJA620 0003
--
-
--
-
Your safety, and the safety of others,is very important. And operating thisvehicle safely is an importantresponsibility.
To help you make informeddecisions about safety, we haveprovided operating procedures andother information on labels and inthis manual. This information alertsyou to potential hazards that couldhurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical orpossible to warn you about all thehazards associated with operating ormaintaining your vehicle. You mustuse your own good judgement.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,including:
on the vehicle.preceded by a safety alert symbol and one of
three signal words: , , or .
such as Important Safety Reminders or ImportantSafety Precautions.
such as Driver and Passenger Safety.how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information please read itcarefully.
These signal words mean:
Safety LabelsSafety Messages
Safety Headings
Safety SectionInstructions
A Few Words About Safety
DANGER WARNING CAUTION
iii
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be HURT if you don’t followinstructions.
06/08/12 18:17:52 31SJA620 0004
*
*
*
*
Your Vehicle at a Glance
4
CLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER DOORLOCK MASTERSWITCH
INSTRUMENT PANELINDICATORS
ACCESSORYPOWER SOCKETS
HOOD RELEASE LEVER
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
DRIVING POSITIONMEMORY SYSTEM
MIRROR CONTROLAUTO BUTTON
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSION
TRUNK RELEASEBUTTON
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASEBUTTON
POWER REARMOONROOF SWITCH
SUNSHADE BUTTON
TILT BUTTON
HomeLink BUTTONS
REAR HEAD RESTRAINT
1:
INTERFACE DIAL
(P.11, 26)
CEILINGCONSOLE
DRIVER’S FRONTAIRBAG
2: RL models
PASSENGER’S FRONT AIRBAG
COMPASS SYSTEM
(P.11, 26) (P.158)
(P.160)
(P.152)
(P.181)
(P.293)(P.183)
(P.194)
(P.156)
(P.153)
(P.327)(P.329)
(P.198)
(P.207)
(P.199, 207, 241)
(P.240)
(P.343)
(P.192)
(P.62)
1
2
06/08/12 18:18:31 31SJA620 0009
****
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.If equipped.Canadian models onlyRefer to the navigation system manual.
1 :2 :3 :4 :
Your Vehicle at a Glance
Your
Vehicle
ataG
lance
5
INSTRUMENTPANEL BRIGHTNESS
HANDSFREELINKBUTTONS
WINDSHIELDWIPER/WASHER
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA)SYSTEM OFF SWITCH
PADDLE SHIFTERS
STEERING WHEEL AUDIOCONTROLS
COLLISION MITIGATIONBRAKE SYSTEM (CMBS)OFF SWITCH
ADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTINGSYSTEM (AFS) OFF SWITCH
HORN
VOICE CONTROLBUTTONS
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENTS
HEADLIGHT WASHERSWITCH
MIRROR CONTROLS
(P.345)
HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNAL/FOG LIGHTS(P.140, 142)
(P.358)
(P.372)
(P.138)
(P.158)
(P.147)
(P.307)
(P.237) (P.263)
(P.145)
DISTANCEBUTTON
(P.137)
HAZARD WARNINGBUTTON PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF INDICATOR(P.35)
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON(P.146)/HEATED MIRRORBUTTON
CRUISE CONTROLBUTTONSADAPTIVE CRUISECONTROL (ACC)BUTTONS
MULTI-INFORMATIONBUTTONS
SEAT HEATERSWITCHESSEAT HEATER ANDSEAT VENTILATIONBUTTONS
(P.159)
(P.275)/
(P.278, 283)
(P.71)
(P.178)/
(P.179)
(P.144)
(P.145)
(P.287, 292)
TM
2
2
1
4
3
2
2
2
06/08/12 18:18:40 31SJA620 0010
-
This section gives you importantinformation about how to protectyourself and your passengers. Itshows you how to use seat belts. Itexplains how your airbags work. Andit tells you how to properly restraininfants and children in your vehicle.
.........Important Safety Precautions . 8.......Your Vehicle’s Safety Features . 9
.........Protecting Adults and Teens . 13.....1. Close and Lock the Doors . 13
...........2. Adjust the Front Seats . 14............3. Adjust the Seat-Backs . 15
...4. Adjust the Head Restraints . 165. Fasten and Position the Seat
.....................................Belts . 176. Maintain a Proper Sitting
................................Position . 18.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19...Additional Safety Precautions . 20
Additional Information About.......................Your Seat Belts . 21
..Seat Belt System Components . 21
......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 22Automatic Seat Belt
...............................Tensioners . 23..........Seat Belt E-pretensioners . 24
...............Seat Belt Maintenance . 25Additional Information About
...........................Your Airbags . 26......Airbag System Components . 26
How Your Front Airbags.........................................Work . 29
...How Your Side Airbags Work . 32How Your Side Curtain
..........................Airbags Work . 34..How the SRS Indicator Works . 34
How the Side Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 35
How the Passenger Airbag...............Off Indicator Works . 35
.............................Airbag Service . 36...Additional Safety Precautions . 37
Protecting Children General................................Guidelines . 38
All Children Must Be...............................Restrained . 38
All Children Should Sit in a.................................Back Seat . 39
The Passenger’s Front Airbag.........Can Pose Serious Risks . 39
If You Must Drive with Several...................................Children . 41
If a Child Requires Close..................................Attention . 41
...Additional Safety Precautions . 41Protecting Infants and Small
...................................Children . 43.......................Protecting Infants . 43
.........Protecting Small Children . 44.....................Selecting a Child Seat . 45....................Installing a Child Seat . 46
...............................With LATCH . 47.........With a Lap/Shoulder Belt . 49
..............................With a Tether . 51...........Protecting Larger Children . 52
...............Checking Seat Belt Fit . 52..................Using a Booster Seat . 53
When Can a Larger Child Sit in.........................................Front . 54
...Additional Safety Precautions . 55.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 56
...................................Safety Labels . 57
Driver and Passenger Safety
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
7
06/08/12 18:18:46 31SJA620 0012
-You’ll find many safetyrecommendations throughout thissection, and throughout this manual.The recommendations on this pageare the ones we consider to be themost important.
Excessive speed is a major factor incrash injuries and deaths. Generally,the higher the speed, the greater therisk, but serious injuries can alsooccur at lower speeds. Never drivefaster than is safe for currentconditions, regardless of themaximum speed posted.
Having a tire blowout or amechanical failure can be extremelyhazardous. To reduce the possibilityof such problems, check your tirepressures and condition frequently,and perform all regularly scheduledmaintenance (see page ).
A seat belt is your best protection inall types of collisions. Airbags aredesigned to supplement seat belts,not replace them. So even thoughyour vehicle is equipped with airbags,make sure you and your passengersalways wear your seat belts, andwear them properly (see page ).
Children age 12 and under shouldride properly restrained in a backseat, not the front seat. Infants andsmall children should be restrainedin a child seat. Larger childrenshould use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder belt until they can use thebelt properly without a booster seat
(see pages ).
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Evenone drink can reduce your ability torespond to changing conditions, andyour reaction time gets worse withevery additional drink. So don’t drinkand drive, and don’t let your friendsdrink and drive, either.
While airbags can save lives, theycan cause serious or fatal injuries tooccupants who sit too close to them,or are not properly restrained.Infants, young children, and shortadults are at the greatest risk. Besure to follow all instructions andwarnings in this manual.
17
5538
381
Important Safety Precautions
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
Control Your Speed
Keep Your Vehicle in SafeCondition
Restrain All Children
Don’t Drink and Drive
Be Aware of Airbag Hazards
8
06/08/12 18:18:56 31SJA620 0013
*
*
Your vehicle is equipped with manyfeatures that work together toprotect you and your passengersduring a crash.
Some features do not require anyaction on your part. These include astrong steel framework that forms asafety cage around the passengercompartment; front and rear crushzones; a collapsible steering column;and tensioners that tighten the frontseat belts in a crash.
However, you and your passengerscan’t take full advantage of thesefeatures unless you remain sitting ina proper position and
. In fact, some safetyfeatures can contribute to injuries ifthey are not used properly.
The following pages explain how youcan take an active role in protectingyourself and your passengers.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
always wearyour seat belts
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
9
(1)
(2)
(2)
(4)
(5)(7)
(7)
(11)
(9)
(6)
(8) (3)
(6)(10)
(8)
(9)
(1) Safety Cage(2) Crush Zones(3) Seats and Seat-Backs(4) Head Restraints(5) Collapsible Steering Column(6) Seat Belts(7) Front Airbags(8) Side Airbags(9) Side Curtain Airbags(10) Door Locks(11) Front Seat Belt Tensioners/
Seat Belt E-pretensioners
: On model with Collision MitigationBrake System (CMBS)
06/08/12 18:19:04 31SJA620 0014
Your vehicle is equipped with seatbelts in all seating positions.
Seat belts are the single mosteffective safety device for adults andlarger children. (Infants and smallerchildren must be properly restrainedin child seats.)
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
In addition, most states and allCanadian provinces require you towear seat belts.
When properly worn, seat belts:
Keep you connected to the vehicleso you can take advantage of thevehicle’s built-in safety features.
Help protect you in almost everytype of crash, including frontal,side, and rear impacts androllovers.
Help keep you from being thrownagainst the inside of the vehicleand against other occupants.
Keep you from being thrown outof the vehicle.
Help keep you in a good positionshould the airbags ever deploy. Agood position reduces the risk ofinjury from an inflating airbag andallows you to get the bestadvantage from the airbag.
Of course, seat belts cannotcompletely protect you in everycrash. But in most cases, seat beltscan reduce your risk of seriousinjury.
Always wear your seat belt, andmake sure you wear it properly.
Your seat belt system also includesan indicator on the instrument paneland a beeper to remind you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Seat Belts
Why Wear Seat Belts
What You Should Do:
10
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
Be sure you and yourpassengers always wear seatbelts and wear them properly.
06/08/12 18:19:16 31SJA620 0015
CONTINUED
Your vehicle has a supplementalrestraint system (SRS) with frontairbags to help protect the heads andchests of the driver and a front seatpassenger during a moderate tosevere frontal collision (see page
for more information on howyour front airbags work).
Your vehicle also has side airbags tohelp protect the upper torso of thedriver or a front seat passengerduring a moderate to severe sideimpact (see page for moreinformation on how your side airbagswork).
In addition, your vehicle has sidecurtain airbags to help protect theheads of the driver, front passenger,and passengers in the outer rearseating positions during a moderateto severe side impact (see page
for more information on howyour side curtain airbags work).
29
32
34
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
11
06/08/12 18:19:23 31SJA620 0016
The most important things you needto know about your airbags are:
Always wearyour seat belt properly, and situpright and as far back from thesteering wheel as possible whileallowing full control of the vehicle. Afront passenger should move theirseat as far back from the dashboardas possible.
The rest of this section gives moredetailed information about how youcan maximize your safety.
Remember, however, that no safetysystem can prevent all injuries ordeaths that can occur in a severecrash, even when seat belts areproperly worn and the airbags deploy.
They are designed to supplementthe seat belts.
To do their job, airbags mustinflate with tremendous force. Sowhile airbags help save lives, theycan cause minor injuries or moreserious or even fatal injuries ifoccupants are not properlyrestrained or sitting properly.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
What you should do:
Airbags do not replace seat belts.
Airbags offer no protection in rearimpacts, or minor frontal or sidecollisions.
Airbags can pose serious hazards.
12
06/08/12 18:19:29 31SJA620 0017
-
The following pages provideinstructions on how to properlyprotect the driver, adultpassengers, and teenage childrenwho are large enough and matureenough to drive or ride in the front.
See pages for importantguidelines on how to properlyprotect infants, small children, andlarger children who ride in yourvehicle.
After everyone has entered thevehicle, be sure the doors areclosed and locked.
When the trunk is not tightly closed,the ‘‘TRUNK OPEN’’ indicator willstay on.
Your vehicle has door monitorindicators on the multi-informationdisplay to indicate when a specificdoor or the trunk is not tightly closed.You will see the appropriate indicatorand the message for each condition.
When one or more doors are nottightly closed, the ‘‘DOOR OPEN’’indicator will stay on.
38 42
CONTINUED
Introduction
Close and Lock the Doors1.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
13
06/08/12 18:19:38 31SJA620 0018
Adjust the driver’s seat as far to therear as possible while allowing you tomaintain full control of the vehicle.Have a front passenger adjust theirseat as far to the rear as possible.
Locking the doors reduces thechance of someone being thrown outof the vehicle during a crash, and ithelps prevent passengers fromaccidentally opening a door andfalling out.
Locking the doors also helps preventan outsider from unexpectedlyopening a door when you come to astop.
When both the trunk and one ormore doors are not tightly closed,the ‘‘DOOR & TRUNK OPEN’’indicator will stay on.
See page for how to lock thedoors.
152
Adjust the Front Seats2.
Protecting Adults and Teens
14
06/08/12 18:19:44 31SJA620 0019
If you sit too close to the steeringwheel or dashboard, you can beseriously injured by an inflating frontairbag, or by striking the steeringwheel or dashboard.
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to acomfortable, upright position,leaving ample space between yourchest and the airbag cover in thecenter of the steering wheel.
Passengers with adjustable seat-backs should also adjust their seat-back to a comfortable, uprightposition.
If you cannot get far enough awayfrom the steering wheel and stillreach the controls, we recommendthat you investigate whether sometype of adaptive equipment may help.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that driversallow at least 10 inches (25 cm)between the center of the steeringwheel and the chest. In addition toadjusting the seat, you can adjust thesteering wheel up and down, and inand out (see page ).
See page for how to adjust thefront seats.
147
155
CONTINUED
Adjust the Seat-Backs3.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
15
Sitting too close to a frontairbag can result in seriousinjury or death if the frontairbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from thefront airbags as possible.
06/08/12 18:19:53 31SJA620 0020
Adjust the driver’s head restraint sothe back of your head rests againstthe center of the restraint.
Have passengers with adjustablehead restraints adjust their restraintsproperly as well. Taller personsshould adjust their restraint as highas possible.
Properly adjusted head restraintswill help protect occupants fromwhiplash and other crash injuries.
See page for how to adjust thehead restraints.
See page for how to adjust theseat-backs.
Reclining a seat-back so that theshoulder part of the belt no longerrests against the occupant’s chestreduces the protective capability ofthe belt. It also increases the chanceof sliding under the belt in a crashand being seriously injured. Thefarther a seat-back is reclined, thegreater the risk of injury.
155
156
Adjust the Head Restraints4.
Protecting Adults and Teens
16
Improperly positioning headrestraints reduces theireffectiveness and you can beseriously injured in a crash.
Make sure head restraints arein place and positioned properlybefore driving.
Reclining the seat-back too farcan result in serious injury ordeath in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to anupright position, and sit wellback in the seat.
06/08/12 18:20:00 31SJA620 0021
If the seat belt touches or crossesyour neck, or if it crosses your arminstead of your shoulder, you need toadjust the seat belt anchor height.
Insert the latch plate into the buckle,then tug on the belt to make sure thebelt is securely latched. Check thatthe belt is not twisted, because atwisted belt can cause seriousinjuries in a crash.
This spreads the forces of a crashover the strongest bones in yourupper body.
Position the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across your hips,then pull up on the shoulder part ofthe belt so the lap part fits snugly.This lets your strong pelvic bonestake the force of a crash and reducesthe chance of internal injuries.
If necessary, pull up on the belt againto remove any slack, then check thatthe belt rests across the center ofyour chest and over your shoulder.
CONTINUED
Fasten and Position the SeatBelts
5.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
17
Improperly positioning the seatbelts can cause serious injuryor death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts areproperly positioned beforedriving.
06/08/12 18:20:08 31SJA620 0022
After all occupants have adjustedtheir seats and put on seat belts, it isvery important that they continue tosit upright, well back in their seats,with their feet on the floor, until thevehicle is parked and the engine isoff.
Sitting improperly can increase thechance of injury during a crash. Forexample, if an occupant slouches,lies down, turns sideways, sitsforward, leans forward or sideways,or puts one or both feet up, thechance of injury during a crash isgreatly increased.
This could causevery serious injuries in a crash.
See page for additionalinformation about your seat beltsand how to take care of them.
If a seat belt does not seem to workproperly, it may not protect theoccupant in a crash.
The front seats have adjustable seatbelt anchors. To adjust the height ofan anchor, press and hold the releasebuttons, and slide the anchor up ordown as needed (it has fourpositions).
Using a seatbelt that is not working properly canresult in serious injury or death.Have your dealer check the belt assoon as possible.
21
Maintain a Proper SittingPosition
6.Never place the shoulder portion of alap/shoulder belt under your arm orbehind your back.
No one should sit in a seat with aninoperative seat belt.
Protecting Adults and Teens
18
RELEASEBUTTON
06/08/12 18:20:15 31SJA620 0023
When driving, remember to situpright and adjust the seat as farback as possible while allowing fullcontrol of the vehicle. When ridingas a front passenger, adjust the seatas far back as possible.
This will reduce the risk of injuriesto both you and your unborn childthat can be caused by a crash or aninflating front airbag.
Each time you have a checkup, askyour doctor if it’s okay for you todrive.If you are pregnant, the best way to
protect yourself and your unbornchild when driving or riding in avehicle is to always wear a seat belt,and keep the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across the hips.
In addition, an occupant who is out ofposition in the front seat can beseriously or fatally injured in a crashby striking interior parts of thevehicle or being struck by aninflating front airbag.
Advice for Pregnant Women
Protecting Adults and Teens
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
19
Sitting improperly or out ofposition can result in seriousinjury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back inthe seat, with your feet on thefloor.
06/08/12 18:20:22 31SJA620 0024
If yourhands or arms are close to anairbag cover, they could be injuredif the airbag inflates.
Objects onthe covers marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’could interfere with the properoperation of the airbags or bepropelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone if the airbags inflate.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
Carrying hard or sharpobjects on your lap, or driving witha pipe or other sharp object inyour mouth, can result in injuriesif your front airbag inflates.
Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt canreduce the protective capability ofthe belt and increase the chance ofserious injury in a crash.
If a side airbag or aside curtain airbag inflates, a cupholder or other hard objectattached on or near the door couldbe propelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone.
Keep your hands and arms awayfrom the airbag covers.
Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.
Two people should never use thesame seat belt.
Do not place hard or sharp objectsbetween yourself and a frontairbag.
Do not put any accessories on seatbelts.
Do not attach hard objects on ornear a door.
Additional Safety Precautions
Protecting Adults and Teens
20
06/08/12 18:20:29 31SJA620 0025
CONTINUED
Your seat belt system includes lap/shoulder belts in all five seatingpositions. The front seat belts arealso equipped with automatic seatbelt tensioners and, on models withcollision mitigation brake system(CMBS), seat belt e-pretensioners.
The seat belt systemincludes an indicator on the
instrument panel and a beeper toremind you and your passengers tofasten your seat belts.
This system monitors the front seatbelts. If you turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position before yourseat belt is fastened, the beeper willsound and the indicator will flash. Ifyour seat belt is not fastened beforethe beeper stops, the indicator willstop flashing but remain on.
If a front passenger does not fastentheir seat belt, the indicator willcome on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
If either the driver or a frontpassenger does not fasten their seatbelt, the beeper will sound and theindicator will flash again at regularintervals.
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGERSEAT BELT’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
When no one is sitting in the frontpassenger’s seat, or a child or smalladult is riding there, the indicatorshould not come on and the beepershould not sound.
This system uses the same sensorsas the front airbags to monitorwhether the front seat belts arelatched or unlatched, and how muchweight is on the front passenger’sseat (see pages and ).31 32
79
Seat Belt System Components
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
21
06/08/12 18:20:37 31SJA620 0026
To unlock the belt, press the redPRESS button on the buckle. Guidethe belt across your body so that itretracts completely. After exiting thevehicle, be sure the belt is out of theway and will not get closed in thedoor.
All seat belts have an emergencylocking retractor. In normal driving,the retractor lets you move freely inyour seat while it keeps sometension on the belt. During a collisionor sudden stop, the retractorautomatically locks the belt to helprestrain your body.
The lap/shoulder belt goes overyour shoulder, across your chest,and across your hips.
To fasten the belt, insert the latchplate into the buckle, then tug on thebelt to make sure the buckle islatched (see page for how toproperly position the belt).
If the indicator comes on or thebeeper sounds when the driver’s seatbelt is latched and there is no frontseat passenger and no items on thefront seat, something may beinterfering with the monitoringsystem. Look for and remove:
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any objects hanging on the seat orin the seat-back pocket.
Any object touching the rear ofthe seat-back.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer.
17
Lap/Shoulder Belt
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
22
06/08/12 18:20:45 31SJA620 0027
For added protection, the front seatbelts are equipped with automaticseat belt tensioners. When activated,the tensioners immediately tightenthe belts to help hold the driver anda front passenger in position.
The seat belts in all positions exceptthe driver’s have an additionallockable retractor that must beactivated to secure a child seat (seepage ).
If the shoulder part of the belt ispulled all the way out, the lockableretractor will activate. The belt willretract, but it will not allow thepassenger to move freely.
To deactivate the lockable retractor,unlatch the buckle and let the seatbelt fully retract. To refasten theseat belt, pull it out only as far asneeded.
The tensioners are designed toactivate in any collision severeenough to cause front airbaginflation.
If a side airbag or side curtain airbagdeploys during a side impact, thetensioner on that side of the vehiclewill also deploy.
The tensioners can also be activatedduring a collision in which the frontairbags . In this case, theairbags would not be needed, but theadditional restraint could be helpful.
When the tensioners are activated,the seat belts will remain tight untilthey are unbuckled.
49
do not deploy
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
23
06/08/12 18:20:54 31SJA620 0028
The e-pretensioners do not activatewhen the seat belts are not worn orwhen the vehicle stability assist(VSA) off indicator on theinstrument panel is on.
For added safety, the front seat beltsare equipped with e-pretensionersthat work in combination with thecollision mitigation brake system(CMBS) (see page ) and thebrake pedal assist function (see page
).
If your vehicle gets too close to thevehicle ahead of it in your lane, thedriver’s e-pretensioner slightlyretracts the seat belt to alert thedriver of the approaching vehicle. Ifa collision with the vehicle in front ofyou is likely, the e-pretensioners onboth front seats retract the seat beltswith enough force to properlyrestrain you and your frontpassenger. After they activate, thee-pretensioners release the retractedseat belts.
To get the full benefit of thee-pretensioners, you and your frontpassenger must sit normally in yourseats and wear your seat beltsproperly (see page ).
In addition, the front passenger’se-pretensioner does not activatewhen the passenger’s airbag isautomatically turned off because theweight sensor detects a child in thefront passenger’s seat.
If the automatic seat belt tensionersare activated by a collision, bothfront seat belts and all relatedcomponents must bereplaced (see page ). If only thee-pretensioners were activated, nocomponents need to be replaced.
17
25
352
355
On models with Collision MitigationBrake System
Seat Belt E-pretensioners
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
24
06/08/12 18:21:01 31SJA620 0029
If a seat belt is worn during a crash,it must be replaced by the dealer. Abelt that has been worn during acrash may not provide the same levelof protection in a subsequent crash.
The dealer should also inspect theanchors for damage and replacethem if needed. If the automatic seatbelt tensioners activate during acrash, they must be replaced.
For safety, you should check thecondition of your seat belts regularly.
Pull each belt out fully, and look forfrays, cuts, burns, and wear. Checkthat the latches work smoothly andthe belts retract easily. If a belt doesnot retract easily, cleaning the beltmay correct the problem (see page
). Any belt that is not in goodcondition or working properly willnot provide good protection andshould be replaced as soon aspossible.
Acura provides a limited warranty onseat belts. See your
booklet for details.
411
Acura WarrantyInformation
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Seat Belt Maintenance
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
25
Not checking or maintainingseat belts can result in seriousinjury or death if the seat beltsdo not work properly whenneeded.
Check your seat belts regularlyand have any problemcorrected as soon as possible.
06/08/12 18:21:08 31SJA620 0030
*
*
: On models with CMBS
Airbag System Components
Additional Information About Your Airbags
26
(1) (2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(8)
(7)
(6)
(4)
(5)
(10)
(9)
(9)
(10) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors
(6) Driver’s Seat Position Sensor(7) Front Passenger’s Seat Weight Sensors(8) Passenger Airbag Off Indicator(9) Side Impact Sensors (First)
(1) Driver’s Airbag(2) Front Passenger’s Airbag(3) Control Unit(4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners/
Seat Belt E-pretensioners(5) Side Airbags
06/08/12 18:21:13 31SJA620 0031
*
Your airbag system includes:
Two side airbags, one for thedriver and one for a frontpassenger. The airbags are storedin the outer edges of the seat-backs. Both are marked ‘‘SIDEAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
Two side curtain airbags, one foreach side of the vehicle. Theairbags are stored in the ceiling,above the side windows. The frontand rear pillars are marked ‘‘SIDECURTAIN AIRBAG’’ (see page
).
Two SRS (supplemental restraintsystem) front airbags. The driver’sairbag is stored in the center ofthe steering wheel; the frontpassenger’s airbag is stored in thedashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRSAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
32
34
29
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
27
(12)
(15)
(14)
(13)
(11)
(13)
(13) Side Impact Sensors (Second)(14) Rear Safing Sensor(15) Side Curtain Airbags
(11) E-pretensioner Control Unit(12) Front Impact Sensors
06/08/12 18:21:21 31SJA620 0032
Automatic front seat belttensioners (see page ).
Sensors that can detect amoderate to severe front impact orside impact.
Sensors that can detect whether achild is in the passenger’s sideairbag path and signal the controlunit to turn the airbag off (seepage ).
On models with CMBS, front seatbelt e-pretensioners (see page ).
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you to a possibleproblem with your airbags,sensors, seat belt tensioners (seepage ), or, on models withCMBS, seat belt e-pretensioners(see page ).
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you that thepassenger’s side airbag has beenturned off (see page ).
An indicator on the dashboard thatalerts you that the passenger’sfront airbag has been turned off(see page ).
Emergency backup power in caseyour vehicle’s electrical system isdisconnected in a crash.
A driver’s seat position sensor thatmonitors the distance of the seatfrom the front airbag. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force (see page
).
Sensors that monitor the weighton the front passenger’s seat. Ifthe weight is about 65 lbs (29 kg)or less (the weight of an infant orsmall child), the passenger’s frontairbag will be turned off (see page
).
A sophisticated electronic systemthat continually monitors andrecords information about thesensors, the control unit, theairbag activators, the seat belttensioners, and driver and frontpassenger seat belt use when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position.
Sensors that can detect whetherthe driver’s seat belt and a frontpassenger’s seat belt is latched orunlatched (see page ).
23
33
24
34
24
35
35
21
31
31
Additional Information About Your Airbags
28
06/08/12 18:21:30 31SJA620 0033
CONTINUED
After inflating, the front airbags willimmediately deflate, so they won’tinterfere with the driver’s visibility,or the ability to steer or operateother controls.
The total time for inflation anddeflation is one-tenth of a second, sofast that most occupants are notaware that the airbags deployed untilthey see them lying in their laps.
During a frontal crash, your seat beltrestrains your lower body and torso,and the front airbag helps protectyour head and chest.
Although both airbags normallyinflate within a split second of eachother, it is possible for only oneairbag to deploy.
This can happen if the severity of acollision is at the margin, orthreshold, that determines whetheror not the airbags will deploy. Insuch cases, the seat belt will providesufficient protection, and thesupplemental protection offered bythe airbag would be minimal.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere frontal collision, sensors willdetect the vehicle’s rapiddeceleration.
If the rate of deceleration is highenough, the control unit will instantlyinflate the driver’s and frontpassenger’s airbags, at the time andwith the force needed.
Only the driver’s airbag will deploy ifthere is no passenger in the frontseat, or if the advanced airbagsystem has turned the passenger’sairbag off (see page ).31
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Front Airbags Work
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
29
06/08/12 18:21:40 31SJA620 0034
Your front airbags are also dual-threshold airbags. Airbags with thisfeature have two deploymentthresholds that depend on whethersensors detect the occupant iswearing a seat belt or not.
If the occupant’s belt is ,the airbag will deploy at a slightlylower threshold, because theoccupant would need extraprotection.
Your front airbags are dual-stageairbags. This means they have twoinflation stages that can be ignitedsequentially or simultaneously,depending on crash severity.
In a crash, both stageswill ignite simultaneously to providethe quickest and greatest protection.
In a crash, one stage willignite first, then the second stagewill ignite a split second later. Thisprovides longer airbag inflation timewith a little less force.
After a crash, you may see whatlooks like smoke. This is actuallypowder from the airbag’s surface.Although the powder is not harmful,people with respiratory problemsmay experience some temporarydiscomfort. If this occurs, get out ofthe vehicle as soon as it is safe to doso.
If the occupant’s belt is , theairbag will inflate at a slightly higherthreshold, when the airbag would beneeded to supplement the protectionprovided by the seat belt.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Dual-Threshold Airbags
not latched
Dual-Stage Airbags
more severe
less severe
latched
30
06/08/12 18:21:47 31SJA620 0035
CONTINUED
Your front airbags are also advancedairbags. The main purpose of thisfeature is to help prevent airbag-caused injuries to short drivers andchildren who ride in front.
For both advanced airbags to workproperly:
Occupants must sit upright andwear their seat belts properly.
Back-seat passengers should notput their feet under the front seats.
Failure to follow these instructionscould damage the sensors or preventthem from working properly.
The driver’s advanced front airbagsystem includes a seat positionsensor under the seat. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force, regardless ofthe severity of the impact.
If there is a problem with the sensor,the SRS indicator will come on, andthe airbag will inflate in the normalmanner regardless of the driver’sseating position.
The passenger’s advanced frontairbag system has weight sensorsunder the seat. Although Acura doesnot encourage carrying an infant orsmall child in front, if the sensorsdetect the weight of an infant orsmall child (up to about 65 lbs or 29kg), the system will automaticallyturn the passenger’s front airbag off.
Do not spill any liquids on orunder the seats, cover the sensors,or put any objects or metal itemsunder the front seats.
Be aware that objects placed on thepassenger’s seat can also cause theairbag to be turned off.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Advanced Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
31
DRIVER’SSEATPOSITIONSENSOR
PASSENGER’SSEAT WEIGHTSENSOR
06/08/12 18:21:57 31SJA620 0036
Moving the front seat forciblyback against cargo on the seat orfloor behind it.
Hanging heavy items on the frontpassenger seat, or placing heavyitems in the seat-back pocket.
When the airbag is turned off, a‘‘passenger airbag off’’ indicator inthe center of the dashboard comeson (see page ).
To ensure that the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system willwork properly,
This includes:
A rear passenger pushing orpulling on the back of the frontpassenger’s seat.
Also, make sure the floor mat behindthe front passenger’s seat is hookedto the floor mat anchor (see page
). If it is not, the mat mayinterfere with the proper operationof the sensors and operation of theseat.
If the weight sensors detect there isno passenger in the front seat, theairbag will be off. However, thepassenger airbag off indicator willnot come on.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere side impact, sensors willdetect rapid acceleration and signalthe control unit to instantly inflateeither the driver’s or the passenger’sside airbag and activate the seat belttensioner on the affected side.
35
412
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Side Airbags Work
do not do anythingthat would increase or decrease theweight on the front passenger’s seat.
32
06/08/12 18:22:05 31SJA620 0037
There will be some delay betweenthe moment the passenger movesinto or out of the airbag deploymentpath and when the indicator comeson or goes off.
A front seat passenger should notuse a cushion or other object as abackrest. It may prevent the cutoffsystem from working properly.
Only one airbag will deploy during aside impact. If the impact is on thepassenger’s side, the passenger’sside airbag will deploy even if thereis no passenger.
To get the best protection from theside airbags, front seat occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
If the side airbag off indicator comeson (see page ), have thepassenger sit upright. Once thepassenger is out of the airbag’sdeployment path, the system willturn the airbag back on, and theindicator will go out.
Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoffsystem designed primarily to protecta child riding in the front passenger’sseat.
Although Acura does not encouragechildren to ride in front, if thesensors in the seat detect a child hasleaned into the side airbag’sdeployment path, the airbag will shutoff.
The side airbag may also shut off if ashort adult leans sideways, or alarger adult slouches and leanssideways into the airbag’sdeployment path.
Objects placed on the frontpassenger seat can also cause theside airbag to be shut off.
35
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Side Airbag Cutoff System
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
33
06/08/12 18:22:13 31SJA620 0038
If the impact is on the passenger’sside, the passenger’s side curtainairbag will inflate even if there are nooccupants on that side of the vehicle.
To get the best protection from theside curtain airbags, occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
If the indicator comes on orflashes on and off while you drive.
If the indicator stays on after theengine starts.
If the SRS indicator does not comeon after you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
The SRS indicator alertsyou to a potential problem
with your airbags, seat belttensioners, and, on models withCMBS, seat belt e-pretensioners.
If the indicator comes on at anyother time, or does not come on at all,you should have the system checkedby your dealer. For example:
In a moderate to severe side impact,sensors will detect rapid accelerationand signal the control unit toinstantly inflate the side curtainairbag and activate the seat belttensioner on the driver’s or thepassenger’s side of the vehicle.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, this indicatorcomes on briefly then goes off. Thistells you the system is workingproperly.
How Your Side Curtain AirbagsWork
How the SRS Indicator Works
Additional Information About Your Airbags
34
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG
06/08/12 18:22:22 31SJA620 0039
CONTINUED
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKAIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
). This indicator alertsyou that the
passenger’s side airbag has beenautomatically shut off. It doesmean there is a problem with yourside airbags.
If you see any of these indications,the airbags and seat belt tensionersmay not work properly when youneed them.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the indicatorshould come on briefly and go out(see page ). If it does not come on,stays on, or comes on while drivingwithout a passenger in the front seat,you will also see a ‘‘PASSENGERSIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on themulti-information display. Have thesystem checked (see page ).
This indicator alerts you that thepassenger’s front airbag has beenshut off because weight sensorsdetect about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less(the weight of an infant or smallchild) on the front passenger’s seat.It does there is a problemwith the airbag.
78
63
79
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How the Passenger Airbag OffIndicator Works
How the Side Airbag OffIndicator Works
not
not mean
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
35
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR
CanadaU.S.
CanadaU.S.
Ignoring the SRS indicator canresult in serious injury or deathif the airbag systems ortensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by adealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS indicator alerts you toa possible problem.
06/08/12 18:22:33 31SJA620 0040
Be aware that objects placed on thefront seat can cause the indicator tocome on.
If no weight is detected on the frontseat, the airbag will be automaticallyshut off. However, the indicator willnot come on.
The passenger airbag off indicatormay come on and off repeatedly ifthe total weight on the seat is nearthe airbag cutoff threshold.
If an adult or teenage passenger isriding in front, move the seat as farto the rear as possible, and have thepassenger sit upright and wear theseat belt properly.
If the indicator comes on with nofront seat passenger and no objectson the seat, or with an adult ridingthere, something may be interferingwith the weight sensors. Look forand remove:
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any object hanging on the seat orin the seat-back pocket.
Any object touching the rear ofthe seat-back.
Your airbag systems are virtuallymaintenance free, and there are noparts you can safely service.However, you must have yourvehicle serviced if:
Any airbagthat has deployed must bereplaced along with the controlunit and other related parts. Anyseat belt tensioner that activatesmust also be replaced.
Do not try to remove or replaceany airbag by yourself. This mustbe done by an authorized dealer ora knowledgeable body shop.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer assoon as possible.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Airbag Service
An airbag ever inflates.
36
06/08/12 18:22:42 31SJA620 0041
Improperly replacingor covering front seat-back coverscan prevent your side airbags frominflating during a side impact.
If water oranother liquid soaks into the seat-back, it can prevent the side airbagcutoff system from workingproperly.
Together, airbags andseat belts provide the bestprotection.
Tampering could causethe airbags to deploy, possiblycausing very serious injury.
This could make thedriver’s seat position sensor or thefront passenger’s weight sensorsineffective. If it is necessary toremove or modify a front seat toaccommodate a person withdisabilities, first contact AcuraClient Services at 800-382-2238.
Take your vehicle to anauthorized dealer as soon aspossible. If you ignore thisindication, your airbags may notoperate properly.
Even if yourairbags do not inflate, your dealershould inspect the driver’s seatposition sensor, the frontpassenger’s weight sensors, thefront seat belt tensioners, and allseat belts worn during the crash tomake sure they are operatingproperly.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Do not cover or replace front seat-back covers without consultingyour dealer.
Do not expose the front passenger’sseat-back to liquid.
Do not attempt to deactivate yourairbags.
Do not tamper with airbagcomponents or wiring for anyreason.
Do not remove or modify a frontseat without consulting yourdealer.
The SRS indicator alerts you to aproblem.
If your vehicle has a moderate tosevere impact.
Additional Safety Precautions
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
37
06/08/12 18:22:49 31SJA620 0042
-
--
If you have children, or ever need todrive with a child in your vehicle, besure to read this section. It beginswith important general guidelines,then presents special information forinfants, small children, and largerchildren.
Each year, many children are injuredor killed in vehicle crashes becausethey are either unrestrained or notproperly restrained. In fact, vehicleaccidents are the number one causeof the death of children ages 12 andunder.
To reduce the number of childdeaths and injuries, every state andCanadian province requires thatinfants and children be properlyrestrained when they ride in avehicle.
(see pages ).(see pages ).
Children depend on adults to protectthem. However, despite their bestintentions, many adults do not knowhow to protect childpassengers.
55525143
properly
Protecting Children General Guidelines
All Children Must Be Restrained
Infants and small children must berestrained in an approved child seatthat is properly secured to thevehicle
Larger children must be restrainedwith a lap/shoulder belt and ride ona booster seat until the seat belt f itsthem properly
38
Children who are unrestrainedor improperly restrained can beseriously injured or killed in acrash.
Any child too small for a seatbelt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat. Alarger child should be properlyrestrained with a seat belt anduse a booster seat if necessary.
06/08/12 18:22:57 31SJA620 0043
-
Front airbags have been designed tohelp protect adults in a moderate tosevere frontal collision. To do this,the passenger’s front airbag is quitelarge, and it can inflate with enoughforce to cause very serious injuries.
If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to kill orvery seriously injure a small child.
According to accident statistics,children of all ages and sizes aresafer when they are restrained in aback seat.
Children who ride in back are lesslikely to be injured by strikinginterior vehicle parts during acollision or hard braking. Also,children cannot be injured by aninflating front airbag when they ridein the back.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenaged 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat. Somestates have laws restricting wherechildren may ride.
Even though your vehicle has anadvanced front airbag system thatautomatically turns the passenger’sfront airbag off (see page ),please follow these guidelines:
Ifthe airbag inflates, it can hit the backof the child seat with enough forceto kill or very seriously injure aninfant.
Whenever possible,larger children should sit in the backseat, on a booster seat if needed, andbe properly restrained with a seatbelt (see page for importantinformation about protecting largerchildren).
35
52
CONTINUED
Protecting Children General Guidelines
The Passenger’s Front AirbagCan Pose Serious Risks
All Children Should Sit in a BackSeat
Small ChildrenPlacing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.
Larger Children
InfantsNever put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag.
Children who have outgrown childseats are also at risk of being injuredor killed by an inflating passenger’sfront airbag.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
39
06/08/12 18:23:08 31SJA620 0044
-
To remind you of the passenger’sfront airbag hazards, and thatchildren must be properly restrainedin a back seat, your vehicle haswarning labels on the dashboard(U.S. models) and on the front visors.Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.
Protecting Children General Guidelines
U.S. Models
Canadian Models
40
DASHBOARD
SUN VISORS
SUN VISORS
06/08/12 18:23:19 31SJA620 0045
-
Many parents say they prefer to putan infant or a small child in the frontpassenger seat so they can watch thechild, or because the child requiresattention.
Placing a child in the front seatexposes the child to hazards in afrontal collision, and paying closeattention to a child distracts thedriver from the important tasks ofdriving, placing both of you at risk.
Your vehicle has a back seat wherechildren can be properly restrained.If you ever have to carry a group ofchildren, and a child must ride infront:
Move the vehicle seat as far to therear as possible (see page ).
Have the child sit upright and wellback in the seat (see page ).
Make sure the seat belt is properlypositioned and secured (see page
).
If a child requires close physicalattention or frequent visual contact,we strongly recommend that anotheradult ride with the child in a backseat. The back seat is far safer for achild than the front.
Place the largest child in the frontseat, provided the child is largeenough to wear the lap/shoulderbelt properly (see page ).
If you are not wearing aseat belt in crash, you could bethrown forward and crush thechild against the dashboard or aseat-back. If you are wearing aseat belt, the child can be tornfrom your arms and be seriouslyhurt or killed.
During a crash, thebelt could press deep into the childand cause serious or fatal injuries.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
17
52
155
18
Protecting Children General Guidelines
If You Must Drive with SeveralChildren
If a Child Requires CloseAttention
Additional Safety PrecautionsNever hold an infant or child onyour lap.
Never put a seat belt over yourselfand a child.
Never let two children use thesame seat belt.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
41
06/08/12 18:23:29 31SJA620 0046
-
Leaving children withoutadult supervision is illegal in moststates and Canadian provinces,and can be very hazardous.
For example, infants and smallchildren left in a vehicle on a hotday can die from heatstroke. Achild left alone with the key in theignition switch can accidentally setthe vehicle in motion, possiblyinjuring themselves or others.
Childrenwho play in vehicles canaccidentally get trapped inside.Teach your children not to play inor around vehicles. Know how tooperate the emergency trunkopener and decide if your childrenshould be shown how to use thisfeature (see page ).
Even very youngchildren learn how to unlockvehicle doors, turn on the ignitionswitch, and open the trunk, whichcan lead to accidental injury ordeath.
This can preventchildren from accidentally fallingout (see page ). If a child wraps a loose
seat belt around their neck, theycan be seriously or fatally injured.(See pages and for how toactivate and deactivate thelockable retractor.)
154
154
49 50Do not leave children alone in avehicle.
Lock all doors and the trunk whenyour vehicle is not in use.
Keep vehicle keys and remotetransmitters out of the reach ofchildren.
Use the childproof door locks toprevent children from opening therear doors.
Make sure any unused seat beltthat a child can reach is buckled,the lockable retractor is activated,and the belt is fully retracted andlocked.
Protecting Children General Guidelines
42
06/08/12 18:23:36 31SJA620 0047
A rear-facing child seat can be placedin any seating position in the backseat, but not in the front.
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates, it can hit the back of thechild seat with enough force to kill orseriously injure an infant.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent thedriver or a front passenger frommoving their seat as far back asrecommended, or from locking theirseat-back in the desired position.
It could also interfere with properoperation of the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system.
Two types of seats may be used: aseat designed exclusively for infants,or a convertible seat used in the rear-facing, reclining mode.
If placedfacing forward, an infant could bevery seriously injured during afrontal collision.
An infant must be properlyrestrained in a rear-facing, recliningchild seat until the child reaches theseat maker’s weight or height limitfor the seat, and the child is at leastone year old.
Only a rear-facing child seat providesproper support for a baby’s head,neck, and back.
CONTINUED
Protecting Infants and Small Children
Rear-facing Child Seat Placement
Never put arear-facing child seat in the frontseat.Do not put a rear-facing child seat in
a forward-facing position.
Child Seat Type
Protecting Infants
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
43
06/08/12 18:23:46 31SJA620 0048
Even with advanced front airbagsthat automatically turn thepassenger’s front airbag off (seepage ), a back seat is the safestplace for a small child.
We also recommend that a smallchild use the child seat until the childreaches the weight or height limitfor the seat.
We strongly recommend placing aforward-facing child seat in a backseat, not the front.
If the vehicle seat is toofar forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating airbag can strike the childwith enough force to cause veryserious or fatal injuries.
A child who is at least 1 year old, andwho fits within the child seat maker’sweight and height limits, should berestrained in a forward-facing,upright child seat.
Of the different seats available, werecommend those that have a five-point harness system as shown.
In any of these situations, westrongly recommend that you installthe child seat directly behind thefront passenger’s seat, move the seatas far forward as needed, and leave itunoccupied. Or, you may wish to geta smaller rear-facing child seat.
35
Protecting Infants and Small Children
Child Seat Placement
Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s airbag can behazardous.
Child Seat Type
Protecting Small Children
44
Placing a rear-facing child seatin the front seat can result inserious injury or death during acollision.
Always place a rear-facing childseat in the back seat, not thefront.
06/08/12 18:23:55 31SJA620 0049
Conventional child seats must besecured to a vehicle with a seat belt,whereas LATCH-compatible seatsare secured by attaching the seat tohardware built into the two outerseating positions in the back seat.
Since LATCH-compatible child seatsare easier to install and reduce thepossibility of improper installation,we recommend selecting this style.
In seating positions and vehicles notequipped with LATCH, a LATCH-compatible child seat can be installedusing a seat belt.
If it is necessary to put a forward-facing child seat in the front, movethe vehicle seat as far to the rear aspossible, and be sure the child seat isfirmly secured to the vehicle and thechild is properly strapped in the seat. Whatever type of seat you choose, to
provide proper protection, a childseat should meet threerequirements:
Look for FMVSS213 or CMVSS 213 on the box.
Rear-facing for infants, forward-facing for small children.
When buying a child seat, you needto choose either a conventional childseat, or one designed for use withthe lower anchors and tethers forchildren (LATCH) system.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Protecting Infants and Small Children, Selecting a Child Seat
Selecting a Child Seat
The child seat should meet U.S. orCanadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard 213.
The child seat should be of theproper type and size to fit the child.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
45
Placing a forward-facing childseat in the front seat can resultin serious injury or death if thefront airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child seat in front, movethe vehicle seat as far back aspossible, and properly restrainthe child.
06/08/12 18:24:03 31SJA620 0050
After selecting a proper child seatand a good place to install the seat,there are three main steps ininstalling the seat:
All child seats must besecured to the vehicle with the lappart of a lap/shoulder belt or withthe LATCH (lower anchors andtethers for children) system. Achild whose seat is not properlysecured to the vehicle can beendangered in a crash.
After installing a childseat, push and pull the seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
A child seat secured with a seat beltshould be installed as firmly aspossible. However, it does not needto be ‘‘rock solid.’’ Some side-to-side
movement can be expected andshould not reduce the child seat’seffectiveness.
If the child seat is not secure, tryinstalling it in a different seatingposition, or use a different style ofchild seat that can be firmly secured.
Before purchasing a conventionalchild seat, or using a previouslypurchased one, we recommend thatyou test the seat in the specificvehicle seating position or positionswhere the seat will be used.
Make sure the child is properlystrapped in the child seataccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions. A child who is notproperly secured in a child seatcan be seriously injured in a crash.
The following pages provideguidelines on how to properly installa child seat. A forward-facing childseat is used in all examples, but theinstructions are the same for rear-facing child seats.
3.
1.
2.
3.
Selecting a Child Seat, Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat
Properly secure the child seat tothe vehicle.
Make sure the child seat is firmlysecured.
The child seat should fit thevehicle seating position (orpositions) where it will be used.
Secure the child in the child seat.
46
06/08/12 18:24:11 31SJA620 0051
CONTINUED
To install a LATCH-compatible childseat:
Move the seat belt buckle ortongue away from the loweranchors.
Your vehicle is equipped withLATCH (lower anchors and tethersfor children) at the outer rear seats.
Make sure there are no objectsnear the anchors that couldprevent a secure connectionbetween the child seat and theanchors.
Push the rear head restraint tiltbutton on the ceiling console topivot the head restraints down.
The lower anchors are locatedbetween the seat-back and seatbottom, and are to be used only witha child seat designed for use withLATCH.
The location of each lower anchor isindicated by a small button above theanchor point.
1.
2.
3.
Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat withLATCH
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
47
LOWERANCHORS
REAR HEAD RESTRAINT TILT BUTTON
BUTTON
06/08/12 18:24:20 31SJA620 0052
Place the child seat on the vehicleseat, then attach the seat to thelower anchors according to thechild seat maker’s instructions.
Some LATCH-compatible seatshave a rigid-type connector asshown above.
Other LATCH-compatible seatshave a flexible-type connector asshown above.
Whatever type you have, followthe child seat maker’s instructionsfor adjusting or tightening the fit.
Route the tether strap over thehead restraint, then attach thetether strap hook to the anchor,making sure the strap is nottwisted.
Tighten the strap according to theseat maker’s instructions.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Installing a Child Seat
48
RIGID TYPE FLEXIBLE TYPE
TETHER STRAP HOOK
ANCHOR
06/08/12 18:24:29 31SJA620 0053
CONTINUED
When not using the LATCH system,all child seats must be secured to thevehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt.
With the child seat in the desiredseating position, route the beltthrough the child seat accordingto the seat maker’s instructions,then insert the latch plate into thebuckle.
To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor.
After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked, andyou will need to repeat these steps.
In addition, the lap/shoulder belts inall seating positions except thedriver’s have a lockable retractorthat must be activated to secure achild seat.
1. 2.
3.
Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Belt
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
49
06/08/12 18:24:36 31SJA620 0054
To deactivate the lockable retractorand remove a child seat, unlatch thebuckle, unroute the seat belt, and letthe belt fully retract.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.
After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle, and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure.
To remove slack, it may help toput weight on the child seat, orpush on the back of the seat whilepulling up on the belt.
5.4.
Installing a Child Seat
50
06/08/12 18:24:42 31SJA620 0055
A child seat with a tether can beinstalled in any seating position inthe back seat, using one of theanchorage points shown above.
Since a tether can provide additionalsecurity to the lap/shoulder beltinstallation, we recommend using atether whenever one is required oravailable.
Lift the anchor cover, then attachthe tether strap hook to theanchor, making sure the strap isnot twisted.
Tighten the strap according to theseat maker’s instructions.
After properly securing the childseat with the lap/shoulder belt(see page ), pivot the headrestraint down (see page ) androute the tether strap over thehead restraint.
1.
2.
3.
22156
Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat with aTether
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
51
COVER
TETHER STRAPHOOK
ANCHORANCHOR
TETHER ANCHORAGE POINTS
06/08/12 18:24:50 31SJA620 0056
To determine if a lap/shoulder beltproperly fits a child, have the childput on the seat belt, then askyourself:
Does the child sit all the way backagainst the seat?
Do the child’s knees bendcomfortably over the edge of theseat?
When a child reaches therecommended weight or height limitfor a forward-facing child seat, thechild should sit in a back seat on abooster seat and wear a lap/shoulderbelt.
The following pages giveinstructions on how to check properseat belt fit, what kind of boosterseat to use if one is needed, andimportant precautions for a childwho must sit in front.
1.
2.
Checking Seat Belt Fit
Protecting Larger Children
52
Allowing a child age 12 or underto sit in front can result in injuryor death if the passenger’s frontairbag inflates.
If a child must ride in front,move the vehicle seat as farback as possible, use a boosterseat if needed, have the childsit up properly and wear theseat belt properly.
06/08/12 18:24:57 31SJA620 0057
Does the shoulder belt crossbetween the child’s neck and arm?
Is the lap part of the belt as low aspossible, touching the child’sthighs?
Will the child be able to stayseated like this for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all thesequestions, the child is ready to wearthe lap/shoulder belt correctly. Ifyou answer no to any question, thechild needs to ride on a booster seat. A child who has outgrown a forward-
facing child seat should ride in aback seat and use a booster seatuntil the lap/shoulder belt fits themproperly without the booster.
If a child who uses a booster seatmust ride in front, move the vehicleseat as far back as possible and besure the child is wearing the seatbelt properly.
A child may continue using a boosterseat until the tops of their ears areeven with the top of the vehicle’s orbooster’s seat-back. A child of thisheight should be tall enough to usethe lap/shoulder belt without abooster seat.
Some states and Canadian provincesalso require children to use a boosterseat until they reach a given age orweight (e.g., 6 years or 60 lbs). Besure to check current laws in thestates or provinces where you intend
to drive.
Booster seats can be high-back orlow-back. Whichever style you select,make sure the booster seat meetsfederal safety standards (see page
) and that you follow the boosterseat maker’s instructions.
3.
4.
5.45
Using a Booster Seat
Protecting Larger Children
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
53
06/08/12 18:25:06 31SJA620 0058
If you decide that a child can safelyride up front, be sure to:
Carefully read the owner’s manual,and make sure you understand allseat belt instructions and all safetyinformation.
Move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position.
Have the child sit up straight, backagainst the seat, and feet on ornear the floor.
Check that the child’s seat belt isproperly and securely positioned.
Supervise the child. Even maturechildren sometimes need to bereminded to fasten the seat beltsor sit properly.
Of course, children vary widely. Andwhile age may be one indicator ofwhen a child can safely ride in front,there are other important factors youshould consider.
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates in a moderate to severefrontal collision, the airbag can causeserious injuries to a child who isunrestrained, improperly restrained,sitting too close to the airbag, or outof position.
A side airbag also poses risks. If anypart of a larger child’s body is in thepath of a deploying side airbag, thechild could receive possibly seriousinjuries.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenage 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat.
Physically, a child must be largeenough for the lap/shoulder belt toproperly fit (see pages and ). Ifthe seat belt does not fit properly,with or without the child sitting on abooster seat, the child should not sitin front.
To safely ride in front, a child mustbe able to follow the rules, includingsitting properly, and wearing the seatbelt properly throughout a ride.
5217
Protecting Larger Children
Physical Size
Maturity
When Can a Larger Child Sit inFront
54
06/08/12 18:25:17 31SJA620 0059
This could resultin serious neck injuries during acrash.
Devices intended toimprove a child’s comfort orreposition the shoulder part of aseat belt can make the belt lesseffective and increase the chanceof serious injury in a crash.
This couldcause very serious injuries duringa crash. It also increases thechance that the child will slideunder the belt in a crash and beinjured.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
Do not let a child wear a seat beltacross the neck.
Do not put any accessories on aseat belt.
Do not let a child put the shoulderpart of a seat belt behind the backor under the arm.
Two children should never use thesame seat belt.
Additional Safety Precautions
Protecting Larger Children
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
55
06/08/12 18:25:22 31SJA620 0060
Your vehicle’s exhaust containscarbon monoxide gas. Carbonmonoxide should not enter thevehicle in normal driving if youmaintain your vehicle properly andfollow the information on this page.
High levels of carbon monoxide cancollect rapidly in enclosed areas,such as a garage. Do not run theengine with the garage door closed.Even with the door open, run theengine only long enough to move thevehicle out of the garage.
Have the exhaust system inspectedfor leaks whenever:
With the trunk open, airflow can pullexhaust gas into your vehicle’sinterior and create a hazardouscondition. If you must drive with thetrunk open, open all the windows andset the climate control system asshown below.
If you must sit in your parked vehiclewith the engine running, even in anunconfined area, adjust the climatecontrol system as follows:
Select the fresh air mode.Select the mode.Turn the fan on high speed.Set the temperature control to acomfortable setting.
The vehicle is raised for an oilchange.
You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust.
The vehicle was in an accidentthat may have damaged theunderside.
1.2.3.4.
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
56
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.Breathing it can causeunconsciousness and even killyou.
Avoid any enclosed areas oractivities that expose you tocarbon monoxide.
06/08/12 18:25:29 31SJA620 0061
CONTINUED
These labels are in the locationsshown. They warn you of potentialhazards that could cause seriousinjury or death. Read these labelscarefully.
If a label comes off or becomes hardto read (except for the U.S.dashboard label which may beremoved by the owner), contact yourdealer for a replacement.
U.S. models
Canadian models
U.S. models only
Safety Labels
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
57
HOOD
DASHBOARD
RADIATOR CAP
06/08/12 18:25:48 31SJA620 0062
U.S. models
Canadian models U.S. models Canadian models
Safety Labels
58
DOORJAMBS
SUN VISORS
06/08/12 18:26:01 31SJA620 0063
This section gives information aboutthe controls and displays thatcontribute to the daily operation ofyour vehicle. All the essentialcontrols are within easy reach.
...........................Control Locations . 60............................Instrument Panel . 61
..........Instrument Panel Indicators . 62.............................................Gauges . 70
...................Temperature Gauge . 70..................................Fuel Gauge . 70
.............Multi-Information Display . 71Controls Near the Steering
.........................................Wheel . 136Windshield Wipers and
.....................................Washers . 137.......Turn Signals and Headlights . 140
.................................Fog Lights . 142.........Daytime Running Lights . 142
Automatic Lighting Off...................................Feature . 142
Adaptive Front Lighting System..........................................(AFS) . 143
...............Hazard Warning Button . 145......Instrument Panel Brightness . 145
...............Rear Window Defogger . 146......Steering Wheel Adjustments . 147
.............................Keys and Locks . 149......................Immobilizer System . 150
..............................Ignition Switch . 151....................................Door Locks . 152
..............................................Trunk . 153......Emergency Trunk Opener . 154
................Childproof Door Locks . 154...............................................Seats . 155
...........................................Mirrors . 159Driving Position Memory
........................................System . 160................Keyless Access System . 163
..................................Seat Heaters . 178Seat Heaters and Seat
.................................Ventilation . 179............................Power Windows . 181
.......................................Moonroof . 183...............................Parking Brake . 187
.........Interior Convenience Items . 188..................................Glove Box . 189
.....................Beverage Holders . 190.............Console Compartment . 191
..................................Sun Visors . 192........Accessory Power Sockets . 192
...........................Rear Ashtrays . 193..................Front Door Pockets . 193
..............Power Rear Sunshade . 194
..............Integrated Sunshades . 195...............................Interior Lights . 196
Instruments and Controls
Instruments
andC
ontrols
59
06/08/12 18:26:05 31SJA620 0064
*
*
*
*
Control Locations
60
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
INSTRUMENT PANELINDICATORSGAUGES CLIMATE CONTROL
SYSTEM
TRUNK RELEASE BUTTONHOOD RELEASE LEVER
DRIVING POSITIONMEMORY SYSTEM
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASEBUTTON
POWER DOOR LOCKMASTER SWITCH
HomeLink BUTTONSMOONROOF SWITCHPOWER REAR
TILT BUTTON
SUNSHADE BUTTON
MIRROR CONTROLAUTO BUTTON
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSION
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKETS
REAR HEAD RESTRAINT
(P.62)(P.70)
INTERFACE DIAL
1 :
2 :
CEILING CONSOLE
(P.158)
(P.160)
(P.152)
(P.181)
(P.293)
(P.194)
(P.156)
(P.153)
(P.327)
(P.329)
(P.192)
(P.343)
COMPASS SYSTEM(P.240)
(P.199)
(P.207)
(P.198)
(P.183)
RL models
1
2
06/08/12 18:26:13 31SJA620 0065
*
*
*
*The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.
If equipped.:
Instrument Panel
Instruments
andC
ontrols
61
SEAT BELT REMINDERINDICATOR
CHARGING SYSTEMINDICATOR
KEYLESS ACCESSSYSTEM INDICATOR
LOW OIL PRESSUREINDICATOR
MALFUNCTION INDICATORLAMP
SH-AWD INDICATOR
LOW FUEL INDICATOR
CRUISE MAIN INDICATOR
ELECTRONICALLYCONTROLLEDPOWER STEERINGSYSTEM (ECPS)INDICATOR
LIGHTS ON INDICATOR
FOG LIGHT INDICATOR
MULTI-INFORMATIONDISPLAY
MESSAGE INDICATOR
SECURITY SYSTEMINDICATOR
(P.64)
(P.68)
(P.66)
(P.68)
(P.69)
(P.71)
(P.66)
(P.64)
(P.21, 62)
(P.68)
ANTI-LOCK BRAKESYSTEM (ABS)INDICATOR
(P.66) /
(P.34, 63)
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEMINDICATOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM(SRS) INDICATOR
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA)SYSTEM INDICATOR
VSAACTIVATIONINDICATOR (P.66)
HIGH BEAMINDICATOR
LOW TIRE PRESSURE INDICATOR
(P.62, 443)
(P.62, 444)
(P.62, 443)
(P.67)(P.67, 365)
COLLISION MITIGATIONBRAKE SYSTEM (CMBS)INDICATOR
(P.64, 353)
ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC)INDICATOR
(P.65, 371)
(P.371)
ADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTINGSYSTEM (AFS) INDICATOR (P.69, 143)
(P.69)
(P.66, 278)
PARKING BRAKE ANDBRAKE SYSTEMINDICATOR (P.63, 445)
SIDE AIRBAG OFFINDICATOR (P.35, 63)
06/08/12 18:26:23 31SJA620 0066
The instrument panel has manyindicators to give you importantinformation about your vehicle.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKEMISSION SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display. Formore information, see page .
The engine can be severely damagedif this indicator flashes or stays onwhen the engine is running, or if a‘‘CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL’’message is on the multi-informationdisplay. For more information, seepage .
If this indicator comes on when theengine is running, the battery is notbeing charged, and you will also seea ‘‘CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay. For more information, seepage .
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. It reminds you and yourpassenger to fasten your seat belts.A beeper also sounds if you have notfastened your seat belt.
If you turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position before fasteningyour belt, the beeper sounds and theindicator flashes. If you do not fastenyour seat belt before the beeperstops, the indicator stops flashingbut remains on.
If your front passenger does notfasten their seat belt, the indicatorcomes on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
If either of you do not fasten yourseat belt while driving, the beeperwill sound and the indicator will flashagain at regular intervals. For moreinformation, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGERSEAT BELT’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
21
79
443
443
444
Instrument Panel Indicators
Low Oil PressureIndicator
Charging SystemIndicator
Malfunction IndicatorLamp
Seat Belt ReminderIndicator
62
06/08/12 18:26:33 31SJA620 0067
This indicator has two functions:
It comes on when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. It is a reminder to checkthe parking brake. Driving withthe parking brake not fullyreleased can damage the rearbrakes, axles, and tires.If you drive without releasing theparking brake, a beeper will sound,and you will also see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
If it stays on after you have fullyreleased the parking brake whilethe engine is running, or if itcomes on while driving, it canindicate a problem in the brake
system. You will also see a‘‘BRAKE FLUID LOW’’ or‘‘CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay. For more information, seepage .
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. If it comes on at anyother time, it indicates that thepassenger’s side airbag hasautomatically shut off. You will alsosee a ‘‘PASSENGER SIDE AIRBAGOFF’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).For more information, see page .
This indicator comes on briefly whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. If it comes on atany other time, it indicates apotential problem with your frontairbags. This indicator will also alertyou to a potential problem with yourside airbags, passenger’s side airbagautomatic cutoff system, side curtainairbags, automatic seat belttensioners driver’s seat positionsensor, the front passenger’s weightsensors, or, on models with ACC,seat belt e-pretensioners. You willalso see a ‘‘CHECK AIRBAGSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).For more information, see page .
1.
2.
7835
7835
445
79
Instrument Panel Indicators
Parking Brake and Brake SystemIndicator
Supplemental RestraintSystem Indicator
Side Airbag Off Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
63
U.S. Canada
U.S. Canada
06/08/12 18:26:43 31SJA620 0068
This indicator reminds you that theexterior lights are on. It comes onwhen the light switch is in either the
or position. This indicatorwill also come on when the lightswitch is in AUTO and the lightsturn on automatically. If you turn theignition switch to the ACCESSORY(I) or the LOCK (0) position withoutturning off the light switch, thisindicator will remain on. A reminderchime will also sound when you openthe driver’s door.
This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. It willthen go off if you have a properly-coded remote. If it is not a properly-coded remote, the indicator will blinkand the engine will not start (seepage ).
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, and when the ignitionswitch is turned to the START (III)position. If this indicator comes on atany other time, there is a problem inthe ABS. If this happens, take thevehicle to your dealer to have itchecked. With this indicator on, yourvehicle still has normal brakingability but no anti-lock function. Youwill also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).For more information, see page .If you use the built-in key, this
indicator blinks several times whenyou turn the ignition switch from ON(II) to the ACCESSORY (I) position.
If you use the remote, this indicatorblinks several times when you turnthe ignition switch fromACCESSORY (I) to the LOCK (0)position.
78
150
353
Instrument Panel Indicators
Lights On Indicator Immobilizer SystemIndicator
Anti-lock Brake System(ABS) Indicator
64
06/08/12 18:26:50 31SJA620 0069
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
This indicator has three functions:
It comes on as a reminder that youhave turned off the vehiclestability assist (VSA) system.
It flashes when VSA is active (seepage ).
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. For more information, seepage .
The left or right turn signal indicatorblinks when you signal a lane changeor turn. If the indicator does notblink or blinks rapidly, it usuallymeans one of the turn signal bulbs isburned out (see page ). Replacethe bulb as soon as possible, sinceother drivers cannot see that you aresignaling.
When you press the hazard warningbutton, both turn signals blink. Allturn signals on the outside of thevehicle should flash.
It comes on along with the VSAsystem indicator if there is aproblem with the VSA system.You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
If it comes on and stays on at anyother time, or it does not come onwhen you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, there is aproblem with the VSA system. Youwill also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).Take your vehicle to a dealer to haveit checked. Without VSA, yourvehicle still has normal driving ability,but will not have VSA traction andstability enhancement. For moreinformation, see page .
1.
2.
3.
78
78
371
371
371406
Instrument Panel Indicators
Vehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System Indicator
VSA Activation Indicator Turn Signal andHazard WarningIndicators
Instruments
andC
ontrols
65
06/08/12 18:27:01 31SJA620 0070
This indicator comes on when youturn on the fog lights. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator comes on with thehigh beam headlights. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator also comes on withreduced brightness when thedaytime running lights (DRL) are on(see page ).
This indicator comes on when youturn on the cruise control system bypressing the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel (see page ).
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
When you push the ACC button onthe steering wheel, this indicatorcomes on green. You will also see‘‘ACC’’ on the multi-informationdisplay.
If the indicator comes on orange,there is a problem with the ACCsystem. You will also see a ‘‘CHECKACC SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
). Take your vehicle to yourdealer to have it checked. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator is in the fuel gauge. Itcomes on as a reminder that youmust refuel soon. You will also see a‘‘FUEL LOW’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).When the indicator comes on, thereis about 2.69 U.S. gal (10.2 ) of fuelremaining in the tank before theneedle reaches E. There is a smallreserve of fuel remaining in the tankwhen the needle does reach E.
79
79
142
140
142
275
278
On models without adaptive cruisecontrol (ACC)
On models with adaptive cruise control(ACC)
Instrument Panel Indicators
Fog Light Indicator Low Fuel Indicator
High Beam Indicator
Cruise Main Indicator
Adaptive Cruise Control(ACC) Indicator
66
LOW FUEL INDICATOR
06/08/12 18:27:14 31SJA620 0071
Pull to the side of the road when it issafe, shift to Park, and let the engineidle until the indicator goes out.This indicator normally comes on for
a few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If this indicator comes on atany other time, there is a problem inthe SH-AWD system. You will alsosee a ‘‘CHECK SH-AWD SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay (see page ). Take yourvehicle to a dealer to have it checked.For more information, see page .
If it comes on while driving, itindicates the differentialtemperature is too high.You will also see a ‘‘SH-AWD DIFFTEMP. HIGH’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
If the indicator blinks while driving,pull to the side of the road when it issafe, shift to Park, and let the engineidle until the indicator goes out.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TIREPRESSURE’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
If it comes on while driving, itindicates that one or more of yourvehicle’s tires are extremely low onpressure.
Check the tire pressure monitor onthe multi-information display anddetermine the cause (see page ).
If this happens, pull to the side of theroad when it is safe, check which tirehas lost pressure on the multi-information display, and determinethe cause. If it is because of a flat tire,have the flat tire repaired as soon aspossible. If two or more tires areunderinflated, call a professionaltowing service. For moreinformation, see page .
Your vehicle has Michelin PAX tires.Repair or replacement of PAX tiresmust be done by an Acura dealer oran authorized Michelin PAX systemdealer. For more information, seepage .
78
7879
350455
422
367
If equipped
SH-AWD Indicator
Low Tire PressureIndicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
Instruments
andC
ontrols
67
Continuing to drive with the SH-AWDindicator blinking may cause seriousdamage to the system.
06/08/12 18:27:26 31SJA620 0072
This indicator normally comes onwhen you turn the ignition to the ON(II) position and goes off after theengine starts. If it comes on at anyother time, there is a problem withthe power steering system. You willalso see a ‘‘CHECK POWERSTEERING SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ). If this happens, stop thevehicle in a safe place, and turn offthe engine. Reset the system byrestarting the engine, and watch thisindicator. If it does not go off orcomes back on again while driving,take the vehicle to your dealer tohave it checked. With the indicatoron, the ECPS is turned off, whichcould make the vehicle harder tosteer.
This indicator comes on when thereis a system message on the multi-information display. Press the INFObutton on the steering wheel (seepage ) to see the message (seepage ).
Most of the time, this indicatorcomes on along with other indicatorsin the instrument panel such as theseat belt reminder indicator, SRSindicator, VSA system indicator, etc.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it comes on at any othertime, it indicates that there is aproblem with the system. You willalso see a ‘‘CHECK KEYLESSACCESS SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
). For more information, see page.
The indicator comes on when yourun the engine while the vehicle isnot moving. To turn the indicator off,
restart the engine.
7879
7178
176
Instrument Panel Indicators
Message IndicatorElectronically ControlledPower Steering System(ECPS) Indicator Keyless Access System
Indicator
68
06/08/12 18:27:35 31SJA620 0073
This indicator comes on when thesecurity system is set. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
It comes on as a reminder that youhave turned off the adaptive frontlighting system (AFS).
This indicator blinks when there is aproblem with the AFS system; youwill also see a ‘‘CHECK ADAPTIVEFRONT LIGHTING SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay (see page ). If thishappens, stop the vehicle in a safeplace, turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0)position, and restart the engine. Ifthe indicator does not go off orblinks again, take your vehicle to adealer to have it checked. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. It also comes on as a
reminder that you have turned offthe collision mitigation brake system(CMBS).
The CMBS indicator also comes onif dirt or other debris blocks theradar sensor in the front grille. Youwill also see a ‘‘CHECK CMBSRADAR SENSOR’’ message on themulti-information display. When youclean the radar sensor, the indicatorshould go off the next time you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position.
If the indicator comes on at anyother time, there is a problem withthe CMBS. You will also see a‘‘CHECK CMBS SYSTEM’’ messageon the multi-information display. Ifthis happens, take your vehicle to adealer, and have it checked. Formore information, see page .When this indicator is on, the CMBSis not working.
78
143
274
359
If equipped
If equipped
Adaptive Front LightingSystem (AFS) Indicator
Security System Indicator
Collision MitigationBrake System (CMBS)Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
Instruments
andC
ontrols
69
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
06/08/12 18:27:46 31SJA620 0074
This shows the temperature of theengine’s coolant. During normaloperation, the pointer should risefrom the bottom white mark to aboutthe middle of the gauge. In severedriving conditions, such as very hotweather or a long period of uphilldriving, the pointer may rise to the
upper end of the white section of thegauge. If it reaches the red (hot)mark, pull safely to the side of theroad. For more information, see page
.
This shows how much fuel youhave. It may show slightly moreor less than the actual amount.The needle returns to thebottom after you turn off theignition.
440
Gauges
Temperature Gauge
Fuel Gauge
70
U.S. model is shown.
TACHOMETER TEMPERATURE GAUGESPEEDOMETER
FUEL GAUGE
Avoid driving with an extremely lowf uel level. Running out of f uel couldcause the engine to misf ire, damagingthe catalytic converter.
06/08/12 18:27:53 31SJA620 0075
▲ ▼
The multi-information display in theinstrument panel displays variousinformation and messages when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position. Some of the messages helpyou operate your vehicle morecomfortably.Others help to keep you aware of theperiodic maintenance your vehicleneeds for continued trouble-freedriving.
You can change the display andcustomize your vehicle controlsettings by pressing the SEL/RESETor INFO buttons on the right side ofthe steering wheel.
With the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the lower part of themulti-information display changes asshown in the illustration, each timeyou press the SEL/RESET button.
When you open the driver’s door, a‘‘Welcome’’ message is shown on themulti-information display. When youturn the ignition switch from the ON(II) position to the ACCESSORY (I)position, a ‘‘Goodbye’’ message isshown on the display.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
71
SELRESETBUTTON
U.S. CANADA
INFO ( / )BUTTONS
06/08/12 18:28:00 31SJA620 0076
The odometer shows the totaldistance your vehicle has beendriven. It measures miles in U.S.models and kilometers in Canadianmodels. It is illegal under U.S.federal law and Canadian provincialregulations to disconnect, reset, oralter the odometer with the intent tochange the number of miles orkilometers indicated.
This meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it. Thereare two trip meters: Trip A and TripB. Each trip meter worksindependently, so you can keep trackof two different distances.
To reset a trip meter, display it, thenpress and hold the SEL/RESETbutton until the number resets to‘‘0.0’’.
When you reset Trip A, average fueleconomy A is reset at the same time.When you reset Trip B, average fueleconomy B is reset.
In the customizing mode, you can setTrip A and average fuel economy Ato reset at the same time when yourefuel your vehicle (see page ).100
Multi-Information Display
Odometer Trip Meter
72
ODOMETER
TRIP METER
06/08/12 18:28:06 31SJA620 0077
This shows the outside Fahrenheittemperature in U.S. models, andCentigrade temperature in Canadianmodels.
The temperature sensor is in thefront bumper. The temperaturereading can be affected by heatreflection from the road surface,engine heat, and the exhaust fromsurrounding traffic. This can causean incorrect temperature readingwhen your vehicle speed is under19 mph (30 km/h). When you startyour trip, the sensor is not fullyacclimatized, therefore it may takeseveral minutes until the propertemperature is displayed.
This shows the remaining life of theengine oil. It shows 100% after theengine oil is replaced and the displayis reset. The engine oil life iscalculated based on engine operatingconditions and accumulated enginerevolutions. For more information,see page .
You can adjust the outsidetemperature display (see page ).
In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.
381
97
Outside Temperature Engine Oil Life
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
73
OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE
U.S.
CANADA
ENGINE OIL LIFE
06/08/12 18:28:15 31SJA620 0078
▼ ▲
▼▲
With the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the upper part of thedisplay changes, as shown in theillustration, each time you press the
button. If you press the button,the display returns to the previousmessage.
Multi-Information Display
Normal Display Messages
74
U.S. CANADA If ON
Press buttonPress button
06/08/12 18:28:21 31SJA620 0079
This shows the estimated distanceyou can travel on the fuel remainingin the fuel tank. This distance isestimated from the fuel economyyou received over the last severalmiles(U.S.) or kilometers (Canada),so it will vary with changes in speed,traffic, etc.
This shows the time passed traveledsince you last reset it. When you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position, ELAPSED TIME is reset.
You can customize the ELAPSEDTIME reset condition in the multi-information display (see page ).
You can customize the Trip A andAVG. FUEL A reset condition in themulti-information display (see page
).
This shows your vehicle’s averagefuel economy in mpg (U.S. models)or liter/100 km (Canadian models)since you last reset the Trip A orTrip B.
When you reset Trip A, AVG.SPEED is also reset.
This shows the average speed youare traveling in miles per hour (mph)for U.S. models or kilometers perhour (km/h) for Canadian models.
When the battery is disconnected, oryou refuel, RANGE is also reset.
The average fuel mileage will bereset when you reset the trip meter,or if the vehicle’s battery goes deador is disconnected.
When you turn off the engine, INST.MPG or INST. L/100 km is alsoreset.
This shows your current fuelmileage.
Along with the trip meter, the tripcomputer calculates these values:
Instantaneous fuel mileageRangeElapsed Time
Average Fuel EconomyAverage Vehicle Speed
101
99
RANGE
ELAPSED TIME
AVG. FUEL A/B
AVG. SPEED
INST. MPG (U.S. models)/INST.L/100km (Canadian models)
Trip Computer
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
75
06/08/24 10:44:12 31SJA620 0080
This monitor shows how muchtorque is being delivered to eachwheel. For more information, seepage .
When the tire pressure monitor isshown on the multi-informationdisplay, press the SEL/RESETbutton. The display changes asshown.You can see the pressure of each tirein this monitor. If one or more tiresare low, inflate them to the correctpressure. For more information, seepage .
You can receive or make phone callsfrom your cell phone through yourvehicle’s HandsFreeLink (HFL)system without touching your cellphone.
365
350
Multi-Information Display
SH-AWD Torque DistributionMonitor
Tire Pressure Monitor HandsFreeLink
76
U.S.
Canada
TM
06/08/12 18:28:44 31SJA620 0081
When the engine oil life reaches 15 %,the display shows ‘‘SERVICE DUESOON’’ and the code for themaintenance items to be performed.
Have your dealer do the indicatedmaintenance as soon as you see thismessage, and have them reset thedisplay after completing the service.
If you do not perform the indicatedmaintenance or do not reset thedisplay, the message changes to‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’ when theengine oil life becomes 0 %.
These messages appear on the multi-information display each time youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
For details on engine oil life andmaintenance messages, refer to page
.
Also refer to page for importantmaintenance safety precautions.
When the engine oil life reaches 5 %,the display shows ‘‘SERVICE DUENOW’’ along with the samemaintenance items.
To use the system, your cell phoneand the HFL system must be linked.Not all cell phones are compatiblewith this system. Refer to page
for instructions on how to linkyour cell phone to the HFL and howto receive or make phone calls, orvisit the handsfreelink.com website.
381
380
306
Maintenance Messages
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
77
06/08/12 18:28:52 31SJA620 0082
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
When a problem is detected withyour vehicle, a message will beshown on the multi-informationdisplay.If this happens, refer to theapplicable pages of this owner’smanual, and follow the instructions.
When there are several messages tobe shown, the system switches themessages every 5 seconds.The message is shown until youpush the INFO ( or ) button.To see the message again, press theINFO ( or ) button, 5 secondsafter the display disappears.
Here is a list of messages shown onthe multi-information display:
See page68
See page34, 63
See page63, 445
See page445
See page62, 443
See page62, 444
See page62, 443
See page342
See page442
See page64, 353
See page65, 371
See page69, 143
See page67, 350
See page343
Multi-Information Display
Message Display
78
06/08/12 18:29:06 31SJA620 0083
CONTINUED
See page13
See page35, 63
See page62
See page66
See page142
See page176
See page174
See page175
See page400
See page278
See page62
See page329
See page381
See page369
See page367
See page67, 367
See page428
See page428
See page428
See page359
See page69, 356
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
79
U.S.
Canada
06/08/12 18:29:22 31SJA620 0084
See page151
See page151
Multi-Information Display
80
06/08/12 18:29:28 31SJA620 0085
▲ ▼▲ ▼With the multi-information display
and the INFO ( / ) and SEL/RESET buttons on the right side ofthe steering wheel, you cancustomize some vehicle controlsettings for ‘‘DRIVER 1’’ or‘‘DRIVER 2’’. If ‘‘DRIVER 1’’ or‘‘DRIVER 2’’ is not displayed,customizing is not possible.
To have the driver’s ID detected,make sure your remote is linked tothe system (see
on page ). Then use yourremote to unlock the doors (see
on page).
To enter the customizing mode,press and hold the INFO ( / )button for more than 3 seconds whilethe multi-information display is in itsnormal mode.
If you turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0)position, or move the shift lever outof Park, the display will change tothe normal screen.
When the multi-informationdisplay does not show the driver’sID.
The first customizing menu is:CHG SETTING (see page )
If you disconnect the battery, andthen do not unlock the door.
When the keyless memorysettings are off (see page ). DEFAULT ALL (see page )
You cannot customize the settingsunder these conditions:
To change the settings, the ignitionswitch must be in the ON (II)position, and the vehicle must bestopped with the transmission inPark.
Refer to the following table for abrief summary of each customizablesetting and its default. For moreinformation, refer to the pagenumber references in the table.
104
108
1708785
CONTINUED
Customized Settings
Memory PositionLink
Keyless Access Setup
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
81
06/08/12 18:29:39 31SJA620 0086
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
- ~± ~- ~± ~
*
*
***
CUSTOMIZE MENU DescriptionCauses the system to beep when avehicle ahead of you gets too close.Changes the ACC display speedunit.Changes the language used in thedisplay.
Changes the outside temperaturereading above or below its currentreading.Causes trip meter A and theaverage fuel economy to resetwhen you refuel.Resets the elapsed time of yourcurrent trip.
Changes the driver’s seat, thesteering wheel, and the outsidemirror positions to your storedsetting.Moves the steering wheel fully inand out when the key is removed.
Page90
92
95
97
99
101
104
106
PRE-RUNNING CARDETECT BEEPACC DISPLAY SPEEDUNITLANGUAGESELECTION
ADJUST OUTSIDETEMP. DISPLAY
TRIP A & AVG. FUELRESET with REFUEL
ELAPSED TIME RESET
MEMORY POSITIONLINK
AUTO TILT &TELESCOPIC
ACC SETUP(see page 89)
METER SETUP(see page 94)
POSITION SETUP(see page 103)
ONOFFMPHkm/hENGLISHFRENCHSPANISH
ONOFF
IGN OFFTRIP ATRIP BONOFF
ONOFF
CHG SETTING(see page 87)
1 :2 :3 :
Default settingDefault setting for U.S. modelsDefault setting for Canadian model
CUSTOMIZE GROUP
5°F 0°F 5°F3°C 0°C 3°C
CUSTOMIZE ENTRY CUSTOMIZE SET UP1
2
3
1
1
1
1
1
2
3
previoussetting
Multi-Information Display
82
06/08/12 18:29:45 31SJA620 0087
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
DOOR UNLOCK MODE
KEYLESS ACCESS LIGHTFLASH
KEYLESS ACCESS BEEP
INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME
HEADLIGHT AUTO OFFTIMER
AUTO LIGHTSENSITIVITY
AUTO DOOR LOCK
CUSTOMIZE MENUDRIVER DOORALL DOORS
ONOFF
ONOFF
60 SEC30 SEC15 SEC60 SEC30 SEC15 SECMAXHIGHMIDLOWSHIFT FROM PWITH VEH SPDOFF
DescriptionChanges which doors unlock whenyou use the remote or grab thedriver’s doorhandle.Causes some exterior loghts toblink twice when you unlock thedoors by grabbing the driver’sdoor handle.Cause the beeper to sound twicewhen you unlock the doors bygrabbing the driver’s door handle.Changes how long (in seconds)the interior lights stay on after youclose the doors.Changes how long (in seconds)the exterior lights stay on afteryou close the driver’s door.Changes the light level that causesthe headlights to come on. Theheadlight switch needs to be in theAUTO position.Changes when the doorsautomatically lock.
KEYLESS ACCESSSETUP(see page 108)
LIGHTING SETUP(see page 115)
DOOR/WINDOWSETUP(see page 122)
Page109
111
113
116
118
120
123
CHG SETTING(see page 87)
: Default setting
0 SEC
MIN
CONTINUED
CUSTOMIZE SET UPCUSTOMIZE GROUPCUSTOMIZE ENTRY
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
83
06/08/12 18:29:52 31SJA620 0088
*
*
*
*
*
*
CUSTOMIZE MENUDOOR/WINDOWSETUP(see page 122)
WIPER SETUP(see page 133)
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
DOOR LOCK MODE
KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT
SECURITY RELOCKTIMER
WIPER ACTION
SHIFT TO PIGN OFFOFFDRIVER DOORALL DOORS
ONOFF
90 SEC60 SEC30 SEC
INTERMITTENTWITH VEH SPD
SET
Page125
127
129
131
134
85
CHG SETTING(see page 87)
DEFAULT ALL(see page 85)
DescriptionChanges when the doorsautomatically unlock.
Changes which doors unlock with thefirst push of the remote’s unlockbutton.The exterior lights flash each timeyou press the LOCK or UNLOCKbutton.Changes how long it takes (inseconds) for the doors to relock andthe security system to set after youunlock the driver’s door withoutopening it.Changes the wiper operation amongtwo setting when the wiper switch isin the INT position.Changes all settings to the default.
: Default setting
CUSTOMIZE GROUP
CANCEL
CUSTOMIZE ENTRY CUSTOMIZE SET UP
Multi-Information Display
84
06/08/12 18:29:58 31SJA620 0089
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
Use the INFO ( / ) button on thesteering wheel to select the settingsand the SEL/RESET button to enteryour selections.
If you want the settings as they werewhen the vehicle left the factory,select DEFAULT ALL, as describedon this page.
If you want to set the default settings,press the INFO ( / ) button toselect DEFAULT ALL, then pressthe SEL/RESET button.
If you want to cancel DEFAULTALL, select CANCEL, then press theSEL/RESET button. The screengoes back to CUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If you want to change any vehiclecontrol settings, select CHGSETTING, then press the SEL/RESET button.
CONTINUED
DEFAULT ALL
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
85
06/08/12 18:30:05 31SJA620 0090
To set the default settings again,select DEFAULT ALL, and press theSEL/RESET button. Then selectSET, and press the SEL/RESETbutton.
When DEFAULT ALL is set, you willsee the above display for severalseconds, then the screen returns toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If DEFAULT ALL is not set, you willsee the above display for severalseconds, then the screen goes backto the normal message mode. Repeatthe procedure to select DEFAULTALL.
Multi-Information Display
86
06/08/12 18:30:11 31SJA620 0091
▲▼
▲ ▼
You can customize some of thevehicle control settings to yourpreference. Here are the settingsyou can customize:
METER SETUP
ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROLSETUP
POSITION SETUP
WIPER SETUPDOOR/WINDOW SETUPLIGHTING SETUPKEYLESS ACCESS SETUP
While CHG SETTING in theCUSTOMIZE ENTRY is shown onthe multi-information display, pressthe SEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to ACC SETUP in theCUSTOMIZE GROUP.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown on the next page. Press theINFO ( / ) button, until you seethe setup you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
CHG SETTING
Instruments
andC
ontrols
87
06/08/12 18:30:20 31SJA620 0092
▲ ▼
Multi-Information Display
88
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
ADAPTIVE CRUISECONTROL SETUPsee page 89
METER SETUPsee page 94
POSITIONSETUPsee page 103
KEYLESSACCESS SETUPsee page 108
LIGHTINGSETUPsee page 115
DOOR/WINDOWSETUPsee page 122
WIPER SETUPsee page 133
06/08/12 18:30:26 31SJA620 0093
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
If equippedHere are the two custom settings foradaptive cruise control (ACC):
PRE-RUNNING CAR DETECTBEEPACC DISPLAY SPEED UNIT
While the multi-information displayis in the CUSTOMIZE GROUPscreen, select ACC SETUP bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the display changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
CONTINUED
Adaptive Cruise Control Setup
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
89
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
see page 90
see page 92
06/08/12 18:30:34 31SJA620 0094
▲ ▼
While the multi-information displayis in the ACC SETUP of theCUSTOMIZE GROUP, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
When PRE-RUNNING CARDETECT BEEP is set to ON, onebeep sounds when the ACC detects avehicle in front of you. You also heara beep when that vehicle goes out ofthe range of your vehicle’s radarsensor.
Pre-Running Car Detect Beep
Multi-Information Display
90
06/08/12 18:30:40 31SJA620 0095
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, the displaychanges to the screen shown abovefor several seconds, and then goesback to CUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
To exit PRE-RUNNING CARDETECT BEEP without changingthe current setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If you choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the pre-running car detect beep setup.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
91
06/08/12 18:30:47 31SJA620 0096
▲ ▼▲ ▼
While the multi-information displayis in the ACC SETUP of theCUSTOMIZE GROUP, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above. Thehighlighted unit, mph or km/h, isthe current setting. To change thesetting, press the INFO ( / )button until the unit you want ishighlighted, then press the SEL/RESET button.
To change the unit of measurementfrom mph to km/h, do this:
Adaptive Cruise Control DisplaySpeed Unit
Multi-Information Display
92
06/08/12 18:30:53 31SJA620 0097
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
To exit ACC DISPLAY SPEEDUNIT without changing the currentsetting, select EXIT by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button. The screengoes back to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the ACCdisplay speed unit setup.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
93
06/08/12 18:30:58 31SJA620 0098
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
LANGUAGE SELECTIONADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP.DISPLAYTRIP A & AVG. FUEL RESETwith REFUEL
Here are the four custom settingsfor the meter setup:
ELAPSED TIME RESET
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
Meter Setup
Multi-Information Display
94
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
see page 95
see page 97
see page 99
see page 101
06/08/12 18:31:07 31SJA620 0099
▲ ▼
There are three language selectionsyou can make: English, French, andSpanish. To choose the language youwant, follow these instructions:
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. You will see theabove display.
Select the desired language bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
CONTINUED
Language Selection
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
95
06/08/12 18:31:13 31SJA620 0100
▲ ▼
To exit LANGUAGE SELECTIONwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
All messages in the multi-information display will be shown inthe language you selected.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat thelanguage selection setup.
Multi-Information Display
96
06/08/12 18:31:20 31SJA620 0101
▲ ▼▲
▼
While the multi-information displayis in the METER SETUP of theCUSTOMIZE GROUP, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above. Thehighlighted number is the currentsetting above or below the outsidetemperature. Press the INFO ( /
) button repeatedly until thenumber you want appears, thenpress the SEL/RESET button toenter your selection.
If you sometimes find that thetemperature reading is a fewdegrees above or below the actualtemperature, you can adjust it byfollowing these instructions:
CONTINUED
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
97
06/08/12 18:31:26 31SJA620 0102
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
To exit ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP.DISPLAY without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat theadjust outside air temperaturedisplay setup.
Multi-Information Display
98
06/08/12 18:31:32 31SJA620 0103
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
To cause trip A and average fueleconomy A to reset every time yourefuel your vehicle, follow theseinstructions:
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Trip A & Avg. Fuel Reset with Refuel
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
99
06/08/12 18:31:38 31SJA620 0104
▲ ▼
To exit TRIP A & AVG. FUELRESET with REFUEL withoutchanging the current setting, selectEXIT by pressing the INFO ( / )button, then press the SEL/RESETbutton. The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the tripA and average fuel reset with refuelsetup.
Multi-Information Display
100
06/08/12 18:31:44 31SJA620 0105
▲ ▼
-
-
-
▲ ▼
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
IGN OFF The elapsed time isreset when you turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position.
TRIP A The elapsed time is resetwhen the Trip A is reset.
TRIP B The elapsed time is resetwhen the Trip B is reset.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
There are three elapsed time resetchoices you can make:
CONTINUED
Elapsed Time Reset
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
101
06/08/12 18:31:52 31SJA620 0106
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
To exit ELAPSED TIME RESETwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat theelapsed time reset setup.
Multi-Information Display
102
06/08/12 18:31:58 31SJA620 0107
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
There are two position setups youcan make:
MEMORY POSITION LINKAUTO TILT & TELESCOPIC
While the multi-information displayis in the CUSTOMIZE GROUPscreen, select POSITION SETUP bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,and then press the SEL/RESETbutton.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
CONTINUED
Position Setup
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
103
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
see page 104
see page 106
06/08/12 18:32:06 31SJA620 0108
▲ ▼
When Memory Position Link is setto ON, the driver’s seat, the steeringwheel, and the outside mirrorpositions move to the positionsstored in memory. To cause thememory to activate, open the driver’sdoor with the remote, or grab thedoor handle while carrying theremote.
To set the seat memory position, seepage . For information on usingthe remote, see page . While the multi-information display
is in the POSITION SETUP screenof the CUSTOMIZE GROUP, pressthe SEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
160170
Memory Position Link
Multi-Information Display
104
06/08/12 18:32:12 31SJA620 0109
▲ ▼
To exit MEMORY POSITION LINKwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat thememory position link setup.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
105
06/08/12 18:32:19 31SJA620 0110
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
When AUTO TILT TELESCOPIC isset to ON, the steering wheelautomatically moves fully in and upwhen you turn the ignition switch tothe LOCK (0) position and release it,or when you remove the built-in keyfrom the ignition switch.
While the multi-information displayis in the POSITION SETUP screenof the CUSTOMIZE GROUP, pressthe SEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
Auto Tilt & Telescopic
Multi-Information Display
106
06/08/12 18:32:25 31SJA620 0111
▲ ▼
To exit AUTO TILT &TELESCOPIC without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the autotilt and telescopic setup.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
107
06/08/12 18:32:31 31SJA620 0112
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
DOOR UNLOCK MODEKEYLESS ACCESSLIGHT FLASHKEYLESS ACCESS BEEP
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button, until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
There are three settings in thekeyless access setup:
While the multi-information displayis in the CUSTOMIZE GROUPscreen, select KEYLESS ACCESSSETUP by pressing the INFO ( /
) button, then press the SEL/RESET button.
KEYLESS ACCESS Setup
Multi-Information Display
108
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
see page 109
see page 111
see page 113
06/08/12 18:32:39 31SJA620 0113
▲ ▼
To select whether the driver’s dooror all doors unlock when you openthe driver’s door with the remote orby grabbing the door handle (whilecarrying the remote), follow theseinstructions:
While the multi-information displayis in the KEYLESS ACCESS SETUPscreen of the CUSTOMIZE GROUP,press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes to the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select DRIVER DOOR ONLY orALL DOORS by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Door Unlock Mode
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
109
06/08/12 18:32:45 31SJA620 0114
▲ ▼
To exit DOOR UNLOCK MODEwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the doorunlock mode setup.
Multi-Information Display
110
06/08/12 18:32:51 31SJA620 0115
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
When KEYLESS ACCESS LIGHTFLASH is set to ON, some exteriorlights blink twice when you unlockthe doors by grabbing the driver’sdoor handle while carrying theremote.
While the multi-information displayis in the KEYLESS ACCESS SETUPscreen of the CUSTOMIZE GROUP,press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes to CUSTOMIZEMENU. Press the INFO ( / )button until you see the abovedisplay.
The same exterior lights blink oncewhen you lock the doors by touchingthe door lock sensor while carryingthe remote.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Keyless Access Light Flash
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
111
06/08/12 18:32:57 31SJA620 0116
▲ ▼
To exit KEYLESS ACCESS LIGHTFLASH without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat thekeyless access light flash setup.
Multi-Information Display
112
06/08/12 18:33:04 31SJA620 0117
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
When KEYLESS ACCESS BEEP isset to ON, the beeper sounds twicewhen you unlock the doors bygrabbing the drivers door handlewhile carrying the remote.
When you lock the doors bytouching the door lock sensor whilecarrying the remote, the beepersounds once.
While the multi-information displayis in the KEYLESS ACCESS SETUPscreen of the CUSTOMIZE GROUP,press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes to CUSTOMIZEMENU. Press the INFO ( / )button until you see the abovedisplay.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Keyless Access Beep
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
113
06/08/12 18:33:11 31SJA620 0118
▲ ▼
To exit KEYLESS ACCESS BEEPwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat thekeyless access beep setup.
Multi-Information Display
114
06/08/12 18:33:16 31SJA620 0119
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
There are three settings in thelighting setup:
INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME
While CUSTOMIZE GROUP isshown on the multi-informationdisplay, select LIGHTING SETUP bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.
AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITYHEADLIGHT AUTO OFF TIMER
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button, until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
CONTINUED
Lighting Setup
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
115
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
see page 116
see page 118
see page 120
06/08/12 18:33:25 31SJA620 0120
▲ ▼
While LIGHTING SETUP is shownin the CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. You will see theabove display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select how long you want the lightsto stay on before they fade out (60,30, or 15 seconds) by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
The interior lights fade out when youclose all doors and the trunk. Tochange how long the lights stay onbefore they fade out, follow theseinstructions:
Interior Light Dimming Time
Multi-Information Display
116
06/08/12 18:33:31 31SJA620 0121
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
To exit INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME without changingthe current setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat theinterior light dimming time setup.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
117
06/08/12 18:33:37 31SJA620 0122
▲ ▼ ▲ ▼
The headlights, parking lights, sidemarker lights, taillights, and licenseplate lights go off after the selectedtime when you close the driver’sdoor and take the remote with you.To change how long the lights stayon before they go off, follow theseinstructions:
While the multi-information displayis in the LIGHTING SETUP screenof the CUSTOMIZE GROUP, pressthe SEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select how long you want the lightsto stay on before they go off (0, 15,30, or 60 seconds) by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Multi-Information Display
118
06/08/12 18:33:43 31SJA620 0123
▲ ▼
To exit HEADLIGHT AUTO OFFTIMER without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat theheadlight auto off timer setup.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
119
06/08/12 18:33:49 31SJA620 0124
-
-
-
-
-
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
MAXThe headlights come on when it isbright.HIGHThe headlights come on when it issomewhat bright.MIDThe headlights come on when it is asbright as sunset or sunrise.LOWThe headlights come on when it issomewhat dark.MINThe headlights come on when it isdark.
While LIGHTING SETUP is shownin the CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select from five levels of sensitivityby pressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
The headlights automatically comeon when the headlight switch is inthe AUTO position and the ambientlight reaches a changeable level. Youcan select the auto light sensitivityfrom the following five levels:
Auto Light Sensitivity
Multi-Information Display
120
06/08/12 18:33:57 31SJA620 0125
▲ ▼
To exit AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITYwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat theheadlight auto light sensitivity setup.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
121
06/08/12 18:34:03 31SJA620 0126
▲▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
AUTO DOOR LOCKAUTO DOOR UNLOCK
There are five settings to choosefrom in the door/window setup:
While CUSTOMIZE GROUP isshown on the multi-informationdisplay, select DOOR/WINDOWSETUP by pressing the INFO ( /
) button, and then press the SEL/RESET button.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button, until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
SECURITY RELOCK TIMER
KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT
DOOR LOCK MODE
Door/Window Setup
Multi-Information Display
122
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
see page 123
see page 125
see page 127
see page 129
see page 131
06/08/12 18:34:13 31SJA620 0127
-
-
-
▲ ▼
There are three settings you canchoose from:
SHIFT FROM PThe doors lock whenever you movethe shift lever out of Park.
WITH VEH SPDThe doors lock when the vehiclespeed reaches about 10 mph (about15 km/h).
OFFThe auto door lock is deactivated allthe time.
While DOOR/WINDOW SETUP isshown in the CUSTOMIZE GROUPof the multi-information display,press the SEL/RESET button. Youwill see the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
CONTINUED
Auto Door Lock
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
123
06/08/12 18:34:21 31SJA620 0128
▲ ▼
To exit AUTO DOOR LOCK withoutchanging the current setting, selectEXIT by pressing the INFO ( / )button, then press the SEL/RESETbutton. The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the autodoor lock setup.
Multi-Information Display
124
06/08/12 18:34:27 31SJA620 0129
▲ ▼
-
-
▲ ▼-
There are three settings you canchoose from:
While DOOR/WINDOW SETUP isshown in the CUSTOMIZE GROUPof the multi-information display,press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes to CUSTOMIZEMENU. Press the INFO ( / )button until you see the abovedisplay.
SHIFT TO P The driver’s door orall the doors, depending on the doorlock mode setting ( see page ),unlock when you move the shiftlever to Park.
IGN OFF The driver’s door or allthe doors, depending on the doorlock mode setting ( see page ),unlock when you turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
OFF The auto door unlock isdeactivated all the time. This is thefactory default setting.
127
127
CONTINUED
Auto Door Unlock
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
125
06/08/12 18:34:35 31SJA620 0130
▲ ▼
To exit AUTO DOOR UNLOCKwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the autodoor unlock setup.
Multi-Information Display
126
06/08/12 18:34:40 31SJA620 0131
▲ ▼
▲▼
While the multi-information displayis in the DOOR/WINDOW SETUPscreen of the CUSTOMIZE GROUP,press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes to CUSTOMIZEMENU. Press the INFO ( / )button until you see above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select DRIVER DOOR or ALLDOORS by pressing the INFO ( /
) button, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
To select whether the driver’s doorunlocks or all the doors unlock whenyou unlock the doors with theremote, follow these instructions.
CONTINUED
Door Lock Mode
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
127
06/08/12 18:34:47 31SJA620 0132
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
To exit DOOR LOCK MODEwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, and then press theSEL/RESET button. The screengoes back to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat the doorlock mode setup.
Multi-Information Display
128
06/08/12 18:34:52 31SJA620 0133
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
When you press the LOCK buttonon the remote to lock the doors andthe trunk, and then press the buttonagain within 5 seconds, a beepersounds once and the exterior lightsblink once to verify that the doorsare locked and the security system isset.
When you press the UNLOCKbutton on the remote to unlock thedoors, and then press the buttonagain within 5 seconds, a beepersounds twice and the exterior lightsblink twice to verify that the doorsare unlocked and the securitysystem is turned off.
To turn this feature on or off, followthese instructions.
While the multi-information displayis in the DOOR/WINDOW SETUPscreen of the CUSTOMIZE GROUP,press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes to CUSTOMIZEMENU. Press the INFO ( / )button until you see the abovedisplay.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Keyless Lock Acknowledgment
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
129
06/08/12 18:35:00 31SJA620 0134
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat thekeyless lock acknowledgment setup.
To exit KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT withoutchanging the current setting, selectEXIT by pressing the INFO ( / )button, then press the SEL/RESETbutton. The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
Multi-Information Display
130
06/08/12 18:35:06 31SJA620 0135
▲ ▼▲ ▼
When you unlock the doors bypressing the UNLOCK button on theremote or by grabbing the driver’sdoor handle while carrying theremote, but do not open any door thedoors relock and the security systemsets within 30 seconds. To changethe relock time, follow theseinstructions:
While the multi-information displayis in the DOOR/WINDOW SETUPscreen of the CUSTOMIZE GROUP,press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes to CUSTOMIZEMENU. Press the INFO ( / )button until you see the abovedisplay.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the relock time you want (90,60, or 30 seconds) by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Security Relock Timer
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
131
06/08/12 18:35:11 31SJA620 0136
▲ ▼
To exit SECURITY RELOCKTIMER without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesecurity relock timer setup.
Multi-Information Display
132
06/08/12 18:35:17 31SJA620 0137
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
While the multi-information displayis in the CUSTOMIZE GROUPscreen, select WIPER SETUP bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.
The changeable setting underWIPER SETUP is called WIPERACTION. To get into WIPERACTION, do this:
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seeWIPER ACTION, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Wiper Setup
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
133
Press the or button.Press the SEL/RESET button.
see page 134
06/08/12 18:35:24 31SJA620 0138
▲▼
-
-
You can select from these twosettings when the wiper switch is inthe INT (intermittent) position:
While the multi-information displayis in the WIPER SETUP screen ofthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select INTERMITTENT or WITHVEH SPD by pressing the INFO ( /
) button, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
INTERMITTENT Theintermittent operation variesaccording to the selection you makeon the wiper lever’s intermittentcontrol ring.
WITH VEH SPD The intermittentoperation varies according to vehiclespeed.
Wiper Action
Multi-Information Display
134
06/08/12 18:35:31 31SJA620 0139
▲ ▼
To exit WIPER ACTION withoutchanging the current setting, selectEXIT by pressing the INFO ( / )button, then press the SEL/RESETbutton. The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE SETUP. If thishappens, you need to repeat thewiper action setup.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
135
06/08/12 18:35:36 31SJA620 0140
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
****
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.
On models with navigation system, refer to the navigation system manual.If equipped.
Canadian models only1 :2 :3 :4 :
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
136
MIRROR CONTROLS
PASSENGER AIRBAGOFF INDICATOR
HANDSFREELINKBUTTONS
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA)SYSTEM OFF SWITCH
PADDLE SHIFTERS
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON
HEATED MIRRORBUTTON
HAZARD WARNINGBUTTON
DISTANCE BUTTON
CRUISE CONTROLBUTTONS
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES
STEERING WHEELAUDIO CONTROLS
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENTS
(P.35)
INSTRUMENTPANEL BRIGHTNESS
WINDSHIELDWIPER/WASHER
HEADLIGHT WASHERSWITCH
COLLISION MITIGATIONBRAKE SYSTEM (CMBS)OFF SWITCH
ADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTINGSYSTEM (AFS) OFF SWITCH
VOICE CONTROLBUTTONS
HORN
ADAPTIVE CRUISECONTROL (ACC)BUTTONS
SEAT HEATER ANDSEAT VENTILATION BUTTONS
(P.138)
(P.158)
(P.147) (P.237)
(P.287)
(P.263)
(P.178)/
(P.179)
(P.145) (P.137) (P.145)
(P.146)/
(P.159)
(P.277)/
(P.358)
(P.307)
(P.278, 283)
MULTI INFORMATIONDISPLAY BUTTONS (P.71)
(P.372)
(P.144)
(P.345)
HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNAL/FOGLIGHTS(P.140, 142)
TM
2
4
4
3
1
4
4
06/08/12 18:35:46 31SJA620 0141
---
-
-
-
-
-
MISTOFFINT IntermittentLO Low speedHI High speedWindshield washers
Push the right lever up or down toselect a position.
The wipers run at highspeed until you release the lever.
The wipers are not activated.
The wipers run at low speed.
The wipers run at high speed.
The length of the wipeinterval is varied automaticallyaccording to vehicle speed.
If you turn it to the shortest delay,the wipers change to low speedoperation when the vehicle speedexceeds 12 mph (20 km/h).
To change the ‘‘WIPER ACTION’’setting, see page .1.
2.3.4.5.6.
134
CONTINUED
MIST
OFF
LO
HI
INT
Windshield Wipers and Washers
Instruments
andC
ontrols
137
06/08/12 18:35:55 31SJA620 0142
- Pull backand hold the wiper control lever.The washers spray until yourelease the lever. The wipers runat low speed, then complete onemore sweep after you release thelever.
When you activate the windshieldwasher with the headlight turned on,the headlight washer will beactivated under certain conditions.For more information, see
section in the next column.
The headlight washers can beoperated at any time by pressing theheadlight washer button located nextto the steering wheel column. Theheadlights must be turned on to usethis button. In addition, the headlightwasher operates when thewindshield washers are first turnedon.
The headlight washers use the samefluid reservoir as the windshieldwashers.
Windshield Wipers and Washers
Windshield Washer Headlight WashersCanadian models only
HeadlightWashers
138
HEADLIGHT WASHER SWITCH
06/08/12 18:36:02 31SJA620 0143
The windshield wiper arms have twoparked positions: winter and summer.In the winter position, the arms sitslightly above the edge of the hood.This reduces the possibility ofdamage to the wiper arms orwindshield wiper motor by a build-upof snow and ice.
A heavy build-up of snow or ice onthe wiper arms will cause them toautomatically park in the winterposition.
Adjust the wiper arms to the winterposition by holding both arms asshown in the illustration at the sametime. Pull on the arm, parallel to thewindshield, until it locks in thehigher position.
To return to the summer position,push the same area of both arms theother direction.
Windshield Wipers and Washers
Wiper Arm Positions
Instruments
andC
ontrols
139
WIPER ARMS
Winter position
WIPER ARMS
Summer positionHOLDINGLOCATIONS
HOLDINGLOCATIONS
06/08/12 18:36:08 31SJA620 0144
-
--
Push down on thelever to signal a left turn and up tosignal a right turn. To signal a lanechange, push lightly on the lever,and hold it. The lever will return tocenter when you release it orcomplete a turn.
Turn signalOffParking and indicator lightsAUTOHeadlights onHigh beamsFlash high beamsFog lights offFog lights on
The rotating switchon the left lever controls the lights.Turning this switch to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the parking lights,taillights, instrument panel lights,side-marker lights, and rear licenseplate lights.
Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the headlights. Ifyou leave the lights on with theignition switch released after turnedto the LOCK (0) position or whenthe built-in key is removed from theignition switch, you will hear areminder chime when you open thedriver’s door.
When the light switch is in the‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’ position, thelights on indicator comes on as areminder. This indicator stays on ifyou leave the light switch on andturn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0)position.
To switch from lowbeams to high beams, push the leftlever forward until you hear a click.The blue high beam indicator willcome on (see page ). Pull it backto return to low beams. To flash thehigh beams, pull the lever backlightly, then release it. The highbeams stay on as long as you holdthe lever back.
1.2.3.4.5.6.7.8.9.
66
Turn Signal
HeadlightsHigh Beams
Turn Signals and Headlights
140
06/08/12 18:36:16 31SJA620 0145
-
The automatic lighting feature iscontrolled by a sensor located on topof the dashboard. Do not cover thissensor or spill liquids on it.
Even with the automatic lightingfeature turned on, we recommendthat you turn on the lights manuallywhen driving at night or in a densefog, or when you enter dark areassuch as long tunnels or parkingfacilities.To turn on automatic lighting, turn
the light switch to AUTO at any time.The lights will come on automaticallywhen the outside light level becomeslow (at dusk, for example). Thelights on indicator comes on as areminder. The lights and indicatorwill turn off automatically when thesystem senses high ambient light.
To change the ‘‘AUTO LIGHTSENSITIVITY’’ setting, see page
.
The automatic lightingfeature turns on the headlights, allother exterior lights, and theinstrument panel lights when itsenses low ambient light.
The lights will remain on when youturn off the ignition switch. They willturn off automatically when you openand close the driver’s door. To turnthem on again, either turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position or turn the light switch to
.
Do not leave the light switch inAUTO if you will not be driving thevehicle for an extended period (aweek or more). You should also turnoff the lights if you plan to leave theengine idling or off for a long time.
120
AUTO
Turn Signals and Headlights
Instruments
andC
ontrols
141
LIGHTSENSOR
06/08/12 18:36:23 31SJA620 0146
Turn the fog lights on and off byturning the switch next to theheadlight switch.
You can use the fog lights only whenthe headlights are on low beam.
The headlights revert to normaloperation when you turn them onwith the switch.
With the light switch in the AUTOposition, you can also use the foglights when the headlights turn onautomatically. They will go off whenthe headlights turn off.
With the headlight switch off, thehigh beam headlights come on withreduced brightness when you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position and release the parkingbrake. They remain on until you turnthe ignition switch off, even if youset the parking brake.
This feature turns off the headlights,all other exterior lights, and theinstrument panel lights within 15seconds after you turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position andclose the driver’s door.
To change the ‘‘HEADLIGHT AUTOOFF TIMER’’ setting, see page .
If you see a ‘‘CHECK DRLSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display, there is aproblem with the daytime runninglight system. Take your vehicle to adealer to have it checked.
When the multi-information displayshows a ‘‘DRL OFF’’ message, thedaytime running lights are off.Follow the procedure in the leftcolumn to turn them on.
The automatic lighting off featureactivates if you leave the headlightswitch in the ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’position or if the lights are turned onby setting the switch in the ‘‘AUTO’’position, turn the ignition switch tothe LOCK (0) position, then openand close the driver’s door.
If you turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position with theheadlight switch on, but do not openthe door and get out, the lights turnoff after 10 minutes (3 minutes, ifthe switch is in the ‘‘AUTO’’position).
If you unlock the door, but do notopen it within 15 seconds, the lightsgo off. With the driver’s door open,you will hear a lights-on reminderchime.
The lights turn on again when youunlock or open the driver’s door.
118
Fog Lights
Daytime Running Lights Automatic Lighting Off Feature
Turn Signals and Headlights
142
06/08/12 18:36:34 31SJA620 0147
If the AFS indicator comes on andstarts blinking while driving, pull tothe side of the road when it is safe,and turn off the engine. If the AFSindicator keeps blinking, or startsblinking again while driving afterturning the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, the AFS is not workingproperly (see page ). Have theAFS inspected by your dealer.
When the AFS indicator comes on,you will also see a ‘‘CHECKADAPTIVE FRONT LIGHTINGSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
Without AFS, your vehicle still hasnormal lighting ability to continuedriving.
The adaptive front lighting system(AFS) helps to improve visibilityduring nighttime driving. The AFScontrols the aiming direction andlighting distribution of the lowbeams according to the amount ofturn applied to the steering wheelduring cornering or turning. To turnthe AFS on, turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position, and turn theheadlights on.
69
78
If equipped
Adaptive Front Lighting System (AFS)
AFS Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
143
06/08/12 18:36:41 31SJA620 0148
This switch is at the right side of theleft vent. Press it to turn the AFS onand off. When AFS is off, the AFSindicator comes on as a reminderwhen you turn on the headlights.
Here are some operatingcharacteristics of the AFS:
The system requires aninitialization period. It does notbegin to operate until you havedriven the vehicle a short distance.
At a stop, the right headlight turnsright when you turn the steeringwheel to the right. But the leftheadlight does not turn left whenyou turn the steering wheel to theleft. This prevents the leftheadlight from pointing atoncoming traffic.
AFS is turned off when the shiftlever is in the R position.
The AFS works with the automaticheadlight adjusting system to sensechanges in vehicle height due todriving and loading conditions ofpassengers and luggage, and adjuststhe vertical aim of the low beamheadlights automatically tocompensate for load.
If the headlights do not seem to beproperly aimed, have the automaticheadlight adjusting system inspectedby your dealer.
Adaptive Front Lighting System (AFS)
AFS Off Switch Automatic Headlight AdjustingSystem
144
AFS OFF SWITCH
06/08/12 18:36:49 31SJA620 0149
+- +
-
Push the button between the centervents to turn on the hazard warninglights (four-way flashers). Thiscauses all four outside turn signalsand both indicators in the instrumentpanel to flash. Use the hazardwarning lights if you need to park ina dangerous area near heavy traffic,or if your vehicle is disabled.
Adjust the brightness of theinstrument panel by pressing theor button. Press the button toincrease the brightness and thebutton to decrease it. You can adjustthe brightness with the headlightswitch on or off.
The level of brightness is shown onthe multi-information display whileyou adjust it. It goes out 5 secondsafter you finish adjusting.
CONTINUED
Instrument Panel BrightnessHazard Warning Button
Hazard Warning Button, Instrument Panel Brightness
Instruments
andC
ontrols
145
ADJUSTMENT BUTTONU.S. CANADA
06/08/12 18:36:56 31SJA620 0150
+
The rear window defogger clears fog,frost, and thin ice from the window.Push the defogger button to turn iton and off. Pushing this button alsoturns the mirror heaters on and off.The indicator in the button comes onto show the defogger is on. If you donot turn it off, the defogger will shutitself off after 5 to 40 minutes(depending on the ambienttemperature). It also shuts off whenyou turn off the ignition switch. You
have to turn it on again when yourestart the vehicle.
Make sure the rear window is clearand you have good visibility beforestarting to drive.
The defogger and antenna wires onthe inside of the rear window can beaccidentally damaged. Whencleaning the glass, always wipe sideto side.
To reduce glare at night, theinstrument panel illumination dimswhen you turn the light switch to
or . To cancel the glarereduction function, set thebrightness to the highest level, thenpress the button. You will hear abeep when it is canceled.
Rear Window Defogger
Instrument Panel Brightness, Rear Window Defogger
146
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER BUTTON
06/08/12 18:37:02 31SJA620 0151
Make any steering wheel adjustmentbefore you start driving.
Move the steering wheel in, out, up,or down by pushing and holding theadjustment switch in that direction.
Release the switch when thesteering wheel reaches the desiredposition. Make sure the steeringwheel points towards your chest, nottoward your face, and that you cansee the instrument panel gauges andindicators.
CONTINUED
Steering Wheel Adjustments
Instruments
andC
ontrols
147
Adjusting the steering wheelposition while driving maycause you to lose control of thevehicle and be seriously injuredin a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel onlywhen the vehicle is stopped.
06/08/12 18:37:08 31SJA620 0152
When you turn the ignition switch tothe LOCK (0) position and release it,or remove the built-in key from theignition switch, the steering wheelautomatically moves fully in and up.
Steering wheel movement is alsocontrolled by the driving positionmemory system (see page ).
To change the ‘‘AUTO TILT &TELESCOPIC’’ setting, see page
.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, or thefuse for the power tilt and telescopicsteering wheel is removed, thepower tilt and telescopic steeringwheel system needs to be resetwhen you reconnect the battery orinstall the fuse.
The steering wheel returns to itsoriginal position when you push theignition switch or insert the built-inkey back in the ignition switch. Push the ignition switch for more
than 1 second and release it, orinsert the built-in key into theignition switch, and remove it. Thesteering wheel automatically movesfully in and up to let you know thesystem is reset.
160
106
Steering Wheel Adjustments
148
06/08/12 18:37:14 31SJA620 0153
You should have received a keynumber tag with your keys. You willneed this key number if you everhave to get a lost key replaced. Useonly Acura-approved key blanks.
Protect the keys from directsunlight, high temperature, andhigh humidity.
Do not drop the keys or set heavyobjects on them.
Keep the keys away from liquids.If they get wet, dry themimmediately with a soft cloth.
The keys do not contain batteries.Do not try to take them apart.
The built-in key (see page ) fitsall the locks on your vehicle.
These keys contain electroniccircuits that are activated by theimmobilizer system. They will notwork to start the engine if thecircuits are damaged.
177
Keys and Locks
Instruments
andC
ontrols
149
KEY NUMBER TAGBUILT-IN KEYS
06/08/12 18:37:21 31SJA620 0154
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the immobilizersystem indicator should come on fora few seconds, then go out. If theindicator starts to blink, it means thesystem does not recognize thecoding of the remote or built-in key.Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position, release theignition switch and push it, orremove the built-in key, and reinsertit. Then turn the switch to the ON(II) position again.
The system may not recognize yourkey’s coding if another immobilizerkey or other metal object (i.e. keyfob) is near the ignition switch whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position.
If the system repeatedly does notrecognize the coding of your remoteor built-in key, contact your dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it. Electricalproblems could result that may makeyour vehicle undrivable.
If you have lost your remote orbuilt-in key and cannot start theengine, contact your dealer.
The immobilizer system protectsyour vehicle from theft. If animproperly-coded key (or otherdevice) is used, the engine will notstart.
Immobilizer System
150
06/08/12 18:37:28 31SJA620 0155
-
--
-
The ignition switch has fourpositions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY(I), ON (II), and START (III).
Use this positiononly to start the engine. The switchreturns to the ON (II) position whenyou let go of the ignition switch.
To use the built-in key, you have toremove the cover (see page ).
This is the normalignition switch position when driving.Several of the indicators on theinstrument panel come on as a testwhen you turn the ignition switchfrom the ACCESSORY (I) to the ON(II) position.
If the front wheels are turned, theanti-theft lock may make it difficultto turn the ignition switch. Firmlyturn the steering wheel to the left orright as you turn the ignition switch.
You can insert orremove the built-in key only in thisposition. To turn the ignition switchto the LOCK (0) position, the shiftlever must be in Park, and you mustpush the knob or built-in key in
slightly.
The shift lever must be in Parkbefore you turn the ignition switchknob to the LOCK (0) position orremove the built-in key from theignition switch.
You canoperate the audio system and theaccessory power sockets in thisposition.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ACCESSORY (I) position, an‘‘ACCESSORY (I) POSITION’’message is shown on the multi-information display.
If you open the driver’s door andleave the key in the ignition switch,you will hear a reminder beeper, anda message appears on the multi-information display according to theignition switch position. When theignition switch is in the ACC (I)position, a ‘‘RETURN IGNITIONSWITCH TO LOCK (0) POSITION’’message is shown on the multi-information display. When theignition switch is in the LOCK (0)position, a ‘‘REMOVE KEY’’message is shown on the multi-information display.
174
Ignition Switch
START (III)
ON (II)LOCK (0)
ACCESSORY (I)
Instruments
andC
ontrols
151
IGNITION SWITCH
COVER
BUILT-IN KEY
06/08/12 18:37:37 31SJA620 0156
Each door has a lock tab above theinside door handle. Pull the tab tolock the door and push it to unlock.When you pull the tab on the driver’sdoor, all the doors lock.
To lock any door when getting out ofthe vehicle, pull the lock tab andclose the door.
All doors can be locked from theoutside by using the built-in key inthe driver’s door. To unlock only thedriver’s door, insert the built-in key,turn it clockwise, and release it. Theremaining doors unlock when youturn the built-in key a second timewithin a few seconds.
Each front door has a power doorlock master switch. Either switchlocks and unlocks all doors. Push theswitch down to lock all doors and upto unlock them.
To change the ‘‘DOOR UNLOCKMODE’’ setting, see page .
When the vehicle speed reachesabout 10 mph (about 15 km/h) ormore, all the doors lockautomatically.
To change the ‘‘AUTO DOORLOCK’’ setting, see page .
When you shift to P after driving, thedriver’s door unlocks.
To change the ‘‘AUTO DOORUNLOCK’’ setting, see page .
With the driver’s door open and thebuilt-in key in the ignition, bothmaster door lock switches aredisabled. They are not disabled if thedriver’s door is closed. Pushing theswitch down on the open frontpassenger’s door will lock all doors.If you try to lock an open driver’sdoor by pulling the lock tab rearwardwith the remote inside the vehicleand closing the driver’s door, thedriver’s door will unlock.
109
123
125
Door Locks
Lockout Prevention
152
POWER DOOR LOCK MASTERSWITCH
06/08/12 18:37:46 31SJA620 0157
If your vehicle’s battery goes dead oris disconnected, you can open thetrunk from the rear seat by pullingthe trunk release handle. Reach thehandle through the trunk pass-through.
Keep the trunk lid closed at all timeswhile driving to avoid damaging thelid, and to prevent exhaust gas fromgetting into the interior. See
on page .
You can open the trunk in any offour ways:
If the doors are locked, press thetrunk release switch on the trunklid with the remote in keylessaccess operating range.
To close the trunk, press down onthe trunk lid.
Press the trunk release button onthe driver’s door.
Press and hold the trunk releasebutton on the remote.
If the doors are unlocked, pressthe trunk release switch on thetrunk lid. 56
CONTINUED
Trunk
CarbonMonoxide Hazard
Instruments
andC
ontrols
153
TRUNK RELEASE BUTTON TRUNK RELEASE HANDLE
06/08/12 18:37:56 31SJA620 0158
As a safety feature, your vehicle hasa release lever on the right corner inthe trunk so the trunk can be openedfrom the inside. To open the trunk,push the release lever to the left.
Parents should decide if theirchildren should be shown how to usethis feature.
For more information about childsafety, see page .
To protect items in the trunk, youcan disable the trunk-release buttonon the driver’s door, the trunk lid,and the remote. To do this, turn offthe trunk main switch in the glovebox, lock the glove box, and lock thetrunk pass-through cover with thebuilt-in key.
The childproof door locks aredesigned to prevent children seatedin the rear from accidentally openingthe rear doors. Each rear door has alock lever near the edge. With thelever in the LOCK position, the doorcannot be opened from the insideregardless of the position of the locktab. To open the door, push the locktab in, and use the outside doorhandle.
42
Trunk, Childproof Door Locks
Childproof Door LocksEmergency Trunk Opener
154
LEVER
TRUNK MAIN SWITCH
RELEASELEVER
lock
unlock
06/08/12 18:38:04 31SJA620 0159
-
Moves the seat forwardand backward.
The controls for the poweradjustable front seats are on theoutside edge of each seat bottom.You can adjust the seats with theignition switch in any position. Makeall seat adjustments before you startdriving.
Moves the whole seat upand forward, or downand backward. The frontof the seat also tilts up ordown at the same time.(Driver’s seat only)
Adjusts the seat-backangle forward orbackward.
Increases or decreasesthe lumbar support.
Moves the front of theseat up or down. (Driver’sseat only)
Raises or lowers the seat.(Driver’s seat only)
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position the seats and seat-backs.
14 17Front Seat Power Adjustments
Seats
Instruments
andC
ontrols
155
PASSENGER’S SEATDRIVER’S SEAT
06/08/12 18:38:16 31SJA620 0160
See page for important safetyinformation and a warning about how toproperly position the head restraints.
16
Your vehicle has adjustable headrestraints on the front seats.
The head restraints help protect youand your passengers from whiplashand other injuries.
They are most effective when youadjust them so the back of theoccupant’s head rests against thecenter of the restraint.
The head restraints adjust for height.The tilt of the front head restraints isalso adjustable. You need both handsto adjust the restraint. Do notattempt to adjust it while driving. Toraise it, pull upward. To lower therestraint, push the release buttonsideways, and push the restraintdown. To adjust the tilt, pivot thefront head restraint to the desiredposition.
You can raise the rear headrestraints by hand.
To lower the rear head restraints forbetter visibility, press the rear headrestraint tilt button on the ceilingconsole with the ignition switch inthe ON (II) position.
Head Restraints
Seats
156
FRONT
RELEASE BUTTON
REAR
REAR HEAD RESTRAINTTILT BUTTON
06/08/12 18:38:24 31SJA620 0161
The rear seat armrest is in thecenter of the rear seat. Pivot it downto use it.
Open the cover by pushing the knoband pulling the cover down. To closethe cover, swing it up, and pushfirmly on the top. Make sure itlatches properly.
Make sure all items in the trunk andthose extending through the pass-through are secured.
For security, this cover can belocked and unlocked only with thebuilt-in key. To lock the cover, insertthe key, and turn it clockwise.
Never drive with this cover open andthe trunk lid open.See onpage .56
Rear Seat Armrest Trunk Pass-through Cover
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
Seats
Instruments
andC
ontrols
157
COVER
KNOB
06/08/12 18:38:32 31SJA620 0162
The inside mirror can automaticallydarken to reduce glare. To turn onthis feature, press the button on thebottom of the mirror. The AUTOindicator comes on as a reminder.When it is on, the mirror darkenswhen it senses the headlights of avehicle behind you, then returns tonormal visibility when the lights aregone. Press the button again to turnoff this sensing.
Keep the inside and outside mirrorsclean and adjusted for best visibility.Be sure to adjust the mirrors beforeyou start driving.
Move the selector switch to L(driver’s side) or R (passenger’sside).
Push the appropriate edge of theadjustment switch to move themirror right, left, up, or down.
1.
2.
Mirrors
Adjusting the Power Mirrors
158
INDICATOR
AUTO BUTTON
SENSOR
ADJUSTMENT SWITCHSELECTORSWITCH
06/08/12 18:38:38 31SJA620 0163
The outside mirrors are heated toremove fog and frost. With theignition switch in the ON (II)position, turn on the heaters bypressing the button. The indicator inthe button comes on as a reminder.Press the button again to turn theheaters off. Pressing this button alsoturns the rear window defogger onand off.
When you finish, move theselector switch to the center (off)position. This turns off theadjustment switch so you can’tmove a mirror out of position byaccidentally bumping the switch.
Outside mirror positions can bestored in the driving positionmemory system (see page ).
Depending on the position of theselector switch, the left or right sidemirror will pivot downward slightlywhen you shift the transmission intoreverse. In the left position, the leftmirror pivots. In the right position,the right mirror pivots. This givesyou a better view of that side of thevehicle while parallel parking. Themirror returns to its original positionwhen you take the transmission outof reverse. To turn this feature off,leave the switch in the centerposition.
3.
160
Mirrors
Power Mirror HeatersReverse Tilt Door Mirror
Instruments
andC
ontrols
159
HEATED MIRROR BUTTON
06/08/12 18:38:45 31SJA620 0164
Store a driving position only whenthe vehicle is parked.
Adjust the steering wheel to acomfortable position (see page
).Adjust the outside mirrors for bestvisibility (see page ).
Adjust the seat to a comfortableposition (see page ).
Your vehicle has a memory featurefor the steering wheel, driver’s seat,and outside mirror positions.
Two seat, steering wheel, andoutside mirror positions can bestored in separate memories. Youselect a memorized position bypushing the appropriate button.
Press the MEMO button on thedriver’s door. You will hear a beep.The indicator in the memorybuttons (1 and 2) will blink.Immediately press one of thememory buttons (1 or 2) until youhear two beeps. The indicator inthe memory button will stay on.The current positions of thedriver’s seat, steering wheel, andoutside mirrors are now stored.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. You cannot add anew driving position to thememory unless the ignition switchis in the ON (II) position. You canrecall a memorized position withthe ignition switch in any position.
3.
1.
2.155
147
159
Storing a Driving Position inMemory
Driving Position Memory System
160
MEMORYBUTTONS
MEMO BUTTON
06/08/12 18:38:54 31SJA620 0165
To select a memorized position, dothis:
Press the desired memory button(1 or 2) until you hear a beep.
The system will move the seat,steering wheel, and outside mirrorsto the memorized positions. Theindicator in the selected memorybutton will flash during movement.When the adjustments are complete,you will hear two beeps, and theindicator will remain on.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark.
To change the ‘‘MEMORYPOSITION LINK’’ setting, see page
.
To cancel the storing procedureafter pressing the MEMO button:
Do not press a memory buttonwithin 5 seconds.
Readjust the outside mirrorposition.
Each memory button stores only onedriving position. Storing a newposition erases the previous settingstored in that button’s memory.
All stored driving positions will belost if your vehicle’s battery goesdead or is disconnected.
Readjust the seat or steeringposition.
1.
2.
104
CONTINUED
Selecting a Memorized Position
Driving Position Memory System
Instruments
andC
ontrols
161
MEMORY BUTTONS
06/08/12 18:39:05 31SJA620 0166
Press any button on the controlpanel: MEMO, 1, or 2.
Adjust the outside mirrors.
Shift out of Park.
Push any of the adjustmentswitches for the seat or steeringwheel.
If you select a memorized positionwithout pushing the ignition switchknob or inserting the built-in key inthe ignition switch, only the seat andoutside mirrors will adjust. To getthe system to also adjust the steeringwheel, push and turn the ignitionswitch or insert the built-in key inthe ignition switch. You will hear twobeeps when it is complete.
You can use the adjustment switchesto change the positions of the seat,steering wheel, or outside mirrorsafter they are in their memorizedposition. If you change thememorized position, the indicator inthe memory button will go out. Tokeep this driving position for lateruse, you must store it in the drivingposition memory.
To stop the system’s automaticadjustment, do any of the following:
Driving Position Memory System
162
06/08/12 18:39:11 31SJA620 0167
Your vehicle has a keyless accesssystem. When you carry the remotewith you, you can lock/unlock thedoor(s), unlock the trunk, and startthe engine without using the built-inkey.
The system may not work if:The battery of the remote is weak.
You carry a cell phone, a laptopcomputer, or other electricaldevice near the remote.
There is strong electrical currentnearby.
The remote is covered by metal.A vehicle is being operated with atransmitter nearby.When the remote battery is dead.
Protect the remote and the built-inkey from direct sunlight, hightemperature, and high humidity.
Always keep the remote and thebuilt-in key away from any magneticmaterial.
You should have received a keynumber tag with your built-in key.You will need this key number if youever have to get a lost key replaced.Use only Acura-approved key blanks.
When the vehicle battery is dead.
Make sure the driver always carriesthe remote/built-in key set.
Do not drop the remote or thebuilt-in key, and do not set heavyobjects on them.
The built-in keys do not containbatteries.
Keep the remote and the built-in keyaway from liquids. If they get wet,dry them immediately with a softcloth.
Keyless Access System
Instruments
andC
ontrols
163
06/08/12 18:39:22 31SJA620 0168
This remote is used to lock/unlock
the doors and unlock the trunk.When you carry the remote, you canlock/unlock the doors, unlock thetrunk, and start the engine without akey.
You can lock/unlock the doorswithin about 32 inches (about 80 cm)radius from the outside door handle.
The following keys come with yourvehicle. Refer to page for how toseparate the keys.
This key is used to lock/unlock thedoors, glove box, trunk pass-throughcover, and to start the engine (afteryou remove the ignition switch cover,see page ). You can open the trunk within about
32 inches (about 80 cm) radius fromthe trunk release switch.
Anyone can lock/unlock a door oropen the trunk if the remote iswithin the operating range of thedoor or the trunk.
The remote may not work if:It is too close to the vehicle.It is above or below the vehicle,even when it is within its operatingrange.174
177
Keys
Keyless Access System
Built-in Key
Keyless Access Remote
164
BUILT-IN KEYS
OPERATINGRANGE
KEY NUMBER TAG
KEYLESS ACCESSREMOTES
06/08/12 18:39:33 31SJA620 0169
The handle of each front door has asensor. That sensor works with theremote so you can automaticallyunlock/lock the door(s).
To change the ‘‘DOOR UNLOCKMODE’’ setting, see page .
When you unlock the door(s), someexterior lights blink twice and thesystem beeps twice.
To change the ‘‘KEYLESS ACCESSLIGHT FLASH’’ setting, see page
.
To change the ‘‘KEYLESS ACCESSBEEP’’ setting, see page .
By default, only the driver’s doorunlocks when you grab its handle.
All the doors unlock when you grabthe handle of the front passenger’sdoor.
If you wear a glove while grabbing afront door handle, the door sensormay be slow to respond or may notrespond by unlocking the doors.
If you do not open any of the doorswithin 30 seconds, they willautomatically relock.
To change the ‘‘SECURITYRELOCK TIMER’’ setting, see page
.
If a remote is within operating rangewhile you wash your vehicle or whenit is raining heavily, the door sensorsmay respond by unlocking the doors.
The unlock sensors do not operatewhen:
The remote is not within theoperating range.
The remote is too close to thevehicle.
When the doors are unlocked.
The remote battery is dead.
The vehicle battery is dead.
109
111
113
131Unlocking the Door(s)
Keyless Access System
Instruments
andC
ontrols
165
06/08/12 18:39:46 31SJA620 0170
Each front door has a LOCK/UNLOCK feature.
When you touch the door locksensor of the front door by hand, allthe doors and the trunk will lock.
The lock sensors do not operate if:
When you lock the doors, someexterior lights blink once and the
system beeps once. When youcannot set the security systembecause the trunk or hood is open,no exterior light blinks and/or nobeeper sounds.
Before locking the doors, make surethe remote is not inside the vehicle.
If a remote is within operating rangewhile you wash your vehicle or whenit is raining heavily, the door sensorsmay respond by locking the doors.
Within 2 seconds of touching thehandle to lock the doors or lockingthe doors with remote, pull thehandle to make sure the doors areactually locked. The door unlocksensors do not operate for about 2seconds after the doors are locked.
To change the ‘‘KEYLESS ACCESSBEEP’’ setting, see page .
To change the ‘‘KEYLESS ACCESSLIGHT FLASH’’ setting, see page
.
If you touch the door lock sensor ofthe front door with your handwearing a glove, the door sensor maydelay to respond or not respond bylocking the doors.
The remote is not within theoperating range.
The doors are open.
The ignition switch is not in theLOCK (0) position.
The built-in key is in the ignitionswitch.
The remote is too close to thevehicle.
The remote battery is dead.
The vehicle battery is dead.
111
113
Locking the Doors
Keyless Access System
166
DOOR LOCK SENSOR
06/08/12 18:39:58 31SJA620 0171
Before closing the trunk, make surethe remote is not in the trunk.
If you close the trunk when theremote is in it, the system beeps, andthe trunk reopens.
When you close the trunk with alldoors locked, the trunk will lock.
When you unlock all the doors withthe remote, built-in key or powerdoor lock master switch, the trunkwill unlock.
Use the pull handle when you closethe trunk.
If you open a door, pull its lock tab,and shut it when the remote is insidethe vehicle, the driver’s door unlock.Make sure you carry the remotewith you when you lock the doors.
Keyless Access System
Locking the TrunkDoor Lock Prevention
Instruments
andC
ontrols
167
PULL HANDLE
06/08/12 18:40:06 31SJA620 0172
-
The trunk cannot be locked if:
When the trunk is locked, you canopen it in any of these ways:
Press this button once tolock all doors. Some exterior lightswill flash. When you push the LOCKbutton twice within 5 seconds, youwill hear a beep to verify that thedoors are locked and the securitysystem is set.
Pull the trunk release switch whencarrying the remote (the systembeeps once).
Press the trunk button on theremote.
Press the trunk release buttoninside the vehicle.
Keep the trunk lid closed at all timeswhile driving to avoid damaging thelid, and to prevent exhaust gas fromgetting into the interior. See
on page .
The remote is too close to theseatback of the rear seat or theseat cushion.
The remote is on the interior rearpanel.
The remote is too close to thetrunk lid.
56
Keyless Access System
Locking and Unlocking the Trunk Keyless Access Remote
LOCKCarbon
Monoxide Hazard
168
LED
UNLOCKBUTTON
PANICBUTTON
TRUNKRELEASEBUTTON
LOCKBUTTON
TRUNK RELEASE SWITCH
06/08/12 18:40:16 31SJA620 0173
-
-
- To change the ‘‘SECURITYRELOCK TIMER’’ setting, see page
.
Press this button forabout 1 second to open the trunk.You cannot open the trunk if thebuilt-in key is in the ignition or theignition switch is in any positionexcept the LOCK (0) position. Youcannot open the trunk with theremote if the trunk main switch isturned off.
To change the ‘‘KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT’’ setting, seepage .
Press this button forabout 2 seconds to attract attention:the horn will sound and the exteriorlights will flash for about 30 seconds.To cancel panic mode, press anyother button on the remote.
You cannot lock the doors if anydoor, the trunk, or the hood is notfully closed if the built-in key is inthe ignition switch, or if the ignitionswitch is in any position except theLOCK (0) position.
Press this button onceto unlock the driver’s door. Press ittwice to unlock the other doors.Some exterior lights will flash twiceeach time you press the button. Theceiling light (if the ceiling lightswitch is in the DOOR position) willcome on when you press theUNLOCK button. If you do not openany doors within 30 seconds, theceiling light fades out. If you relockthe doors with the remote before 30seconds have elapsed, the ceilinglight will go off immediately.
If you unlock the doors with theremote, but do not open any doorswithin 30 seconds, the doorsautomatically relock and the securitysystem sets.
To change the ‘‘INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME,’’ see page .
To change the ‘‘DOOR LOCKMODE’’ setting, see page .
When you cannot set the securitysystem because the trunk or hood isopen, no exterior light blinks and/orno beeper sounds.
129
131
127
116
Keyless Access System
TRUNK
PANIC
UNLOCK
Instruments
andC
ontrols
169
06/08/12 18:40:25 31SJA620 0174
Here are the settings activated withthe remote;
Driving position memory(see page ).
Audio system settings(see page ).
Customized settings(see page ).
Climate control settings(see page ).
When you unlock the door with yourremote, each remote activates thekeyless memory settings related tothat remote. The driver’s ID (Driver1 or Driver 2) is shown on the backof each remote.
Compass system preferences(see page ).
To turn off this feature, press andhold the LOCK and UNLOCKbuttons at the same time. The LED
in the remote will blink once. Thenrelease the buttons. Doing thiscancels the keyless memory settingsfor that remote and restores thedefault settings.
Navigation system preferences(see the navigation systemmanual).
Some of them keep the samesettings as they were set previously.
To turn the keyless memory settingsback on, repeat this procedure. TheLED will blink twice to indicate thefeature has been turned on.
If you lose a transmitter, thereplacement needs to bereprogrammed by your dealer.
Do not immerse the transmitter inany liquid.
Protect the transmitter fromextreme temperature.
Avoid dropping or throwing thetransmitter.
81
160
207
199
240
RL model
Except RL model
Keyless Access System
Keyless Memory Settings
Remote Transmitter Care
170
DRIVER’S ID
TM
06/08/12 18:40:38 31SJA620 0175
+
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Replace the batteries if necessary.Battery type: CR2025
Remove the built-in key.
Remove the upper half by carefullyprying on the edge with a coin.
Replace the old batteries with newbatteries. Place the batteries so the
side is facing up. Snap the twohalves of the remote case backtogether.
An improperly disposed of batterycan hurt the environment.Always confirm local regulations forbattery disposal.
Keyless Access System
Replacing the Remote Battery
Instruments
andC
ontrols
171
06/08/22 16:12:32 31SJA620 0176
The engine may not run, and somemalfunctions may occur, if theremote is:
The engine may not start if theremote is subjected to strong radiowaves.
Also, the engine may not start if theremote is too close to the windows.
Outside the vehicle.On the dashboard.On the rear interior panel.In the glove box.In the door pockets.In the trunk, etc.
Keyless Access System
Ignition Switch Operating Range
172
Make sure you know where the remoteis when you are inside the vehicle.
Remember that you can start the enginewithout using the built-in key when theremote is inside the vehicle.
Make sure you always carry the remotewith you.
06/08/12 18:40:53 31SJA620 0177
When you push the ignition switch,the remote and the vehicle recognizeeach other. After the recognition,the remote indicator flashes, and abeeper sounds once. After the beep,turn the ignition switch.When the remote is out of theoperating range, the ignition switchis locked.If the ignition switch cannot beturned from the LOCK (0) positionto the ACCESSORY (I) position after
the beep, the steering wheel islocked. To unlock the steering wheel,turn it right and left while turningthe ignition switch at the same time.If the remote and the vehicle do notrecognize each other, turn theignition switch to the LOCK (0)position, remove the ignition switchcover, insert the built-in key, andturn the switch (see pages and
).Before leaving the vehicle, makesure the ignition switch is in theLOCK (0) position.
You will also see a ‘‘RETURNIGNITION SWITCH TO LOCK (0)POSITION’’ message on the multi-information display.
To turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position, put thetransmission in Park, press theswitch in, and turn it to the LOCK(0) position. When the transmissionis not in Park, you cannot turn theignition switch to the LOCK (0)position.
If you open the driver’s door with theignition switch in the ACCESSORY(I) position, a beeper will sound.
151174
CONTINUED
Ignition Switch
Keyless Access System
Instruments
andC
ontrols
173
06/08/12 18:41:02 31SJA620 0178
When you are pressing the ignitionswitch, or when the ignition switch isin the ON (II) position, the beepersounds if you take the remote out ofthe vehicle and close the door.
To remove the ignition switch cover,insert the built-in key (see page ),then pull the cover out by pulling thebuilt-in key while pushing it.
Also, if you close the door when theignition switch is not in the LOCK(0) position and the remote is notinside the vehicle, the keyless accessalarm sounds outside the vehicle, amessage appears on the multi-information display, and the beepersounds if the ignition switch is in theON (II) position.
When the beeper sounds after youclose the driver’s door outside thevehicle, check the position of theignition switch and the location ofthe remote.
If the engine is running and youremove the remote from the vehicle,it will continue to run. But onceturned to the LOCK (0) position, theengine will not restart until a remoteis brought back into the vehicle.
177
Keyless Access System
Beeper and MessageRemoving the Ignition SwitchCover Keyless Remote Not Detected
174
BUILT-IN KEY
IGNITION SWITCH COVER
push
pull
06/08/12 18:41:10 31SJA620 0179
The batteries in the remote normallylasts about 2 years. To ensuremaximum battery life, do not storethe remote close to electrical devicessuch as computers or TVs. When themulti-information display shows‘‘KEYLESS REMOTE LOWBATTERY,’’ replace the batteries assoon as possible (see page ).
The engine does not restart if youturn the ignition switch to the LOCK(0) position when the remote isoutside the vehicle. Check where theremote is. Make sure that you carrythe remote or built-in key with youwhen you operate the ignition switch.
When the ignition switch is in theON (II) position, the multi-information display shows‘‘KEYLESS REMOTE NOTDETECTED,’’ and the inside andoutside beepers sound.The multi-information displaymessage goes away when youbring the remote back inside thevehicle, and close the door orapply the parking brake.
The outside beeper sounds whenthe ignition switch is in theACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II)position.
If the engine is running and youremove the remote from thevehicle, it will continue to run.Once turned to the LOCK (0)position, the engine will not restartuntil a remote is brought back intothe vehicle.
If you pass the remote through anopen window, the system does notrespond. Also, even when the remoteis inside the vehicle, the beeper maysound when the location of theremote is not detected due tosurrounding conditions. It is not afailure. Make sure that you carry theremote with you.
171
CONTINUED
Keyless Access System
Keyless Remote Low Battery
Instruments
andC
ontrols
175
06/08/12 18:41:18 31SJA620 0180
The indicator stays on while youare driving.
The indicator comes on with theignition switch in the ON (II)position.
The indicator comes on for severalseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. Haveyour vehicle checked by your dealerif:
The multi-information displayshows ‘‘CHECK KEYLESSACCESS SYSTEM.’’
In this case, use the built-in key tolock/unlock the doors and start theengine.
Keyless Access System
Check Keyless Access System
176
KEYLESS ACCESS SYSTEMINDICATOR
06/08/12 18:41:24 31SJA620 0181
The built-in key can be inserted intothe remote.As shown above, keep inserting thebuilt-in key until it is locked. Toremove the built-in key, pull it outwhile you press the release button.To avoid damaging the remote andthe built-in key, never pull on thebuilt-in key unless you are pressingthe release button.
The trunk and glove box cannot beopened when you turn the trunkmain switch off and lock the glovebox and trunk pass-through coverwith the built-in key. Also, the trunkcannot be opened by using theremote.
The keyless access system useselectric current to identify theremote with the vehicle.
If you use medical equipment suchas a cardiac pacemaker, ask yourdoctor if the electric current used bythe remote will affect it.
Keyless Access System
Valet FunctionBuilt-in key and Remote
Instruments
andC
ontrols
177
RELEASE BUTTON
BUILT-IN KEY
06/08/12 18:41:31 31SJA620 0182
In the LO setting, the heater runscontinuously. It does not cycle withtemperature changes.
Follow these precautions wheneveryou use the seat heaters:
Use the HI setting only to heat theseats quickly, because it drawslarge amounts of current from thebattery.
If the engine is left idling for anextended period, do not use theseat heaters, even on the LOsetting. It can weaken the battery,causing hard starting.
Both front seats are equipped withseat heaters. The passenger seat isonly has heaters in the seat bottombecause of the side airbag cut offsystem.
The ignition switch must be in theON (II) position to use the heaters.Push the top of the switch, HI, torapidly heat up the seat. After theseat reaches a comfortabletemperature, select LO by pushingthe bottom of the switch. This willkeep the seat warm.
In the HI setting, the heater turns offwhen the seat gets warm, and turnsback on after the seat’s temperaturedrops.
If equipped
Seat Heaters
178
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES
Passenger’sseat
Driver’sseat
HEATERS
06/08/12 18:41:40 31SJA620 0183
▲
▼
▼
----
▲
▲
▼
CONTINUED
When you press the button once,the heater is set to HI. After the seatreaches a comfortable temperature,select MID or LOW by pressing the
button. This will keep the seatwarm. To shut down the heater,press the button until theindicators go off.
In HI, when the seat gets warm, theheater will change to MID afterabout 5 minutes.
In MID, the heater will change toLOW after about 60 minutes.
In LOW, the heater runscontinuously.
Both front seats are equipped withseat heaters and an air ventilationsystem. The passenger seat only hasheaters in the seat bottom becauseof the side airbag system.
The ignition switch must be in theON (II) position to use the heatersand the air ventilation system.
HI Three indicators on.MID Two indicators on.LO One indicator on.OFF All indicators off.
To use the heaters, press thebutton. The indicator (red) next tothe button will come on. There arethree settings in the heaters:
If equipped
Seat Heaters and Seat Ventilation (Canadian models)
Instruments
andC
ontrols
179
BUTTON
BUTTON
INDICATORS
passenger’sseat
Driver’sseatHEATERS
06/08/12 18:41:49 31SJA620 0184
▼
▲
▲
▼
----
Follow these precautions wheneveryou use the seat heaters and the seatventilation:
Use the HI setting only to heat orto ventilate the seats quickly,because it draws large amounts ofcurrent from the battery.
If the engine is left idling for anextended period, do not use theseat heaters or the seat ventilation,even on the LO setting. It canweaken the battery, causing hardstarting.
When you press the button once,the system is set to HI. To change tothe lower mode, press the button.To turn the air ventilation off, pressthe button until the indicators gooff.
To ventilate the seat, press thebutton. The indicator (green) next tothe button will come on. The airventilation system has four settings:
HI Three indicators on.MID Two indicators on.LO One indicator on.OFF All indicators off.
Seat Heaters and Seat Ventilation (Canadian models)
180
06/08/12 18:41:55 31SJA620 0185
If the MAIN switch is pushed down(OFF), the passenger windowscannot be raised or lowered. Keepthe MAIN switch off when you havechildren in the vehicle so they do notinjure themselves by operating thewindows unintentionally.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position before operating any ofthe window switches. To open awindow, push the switch down andhold it. To close the window, pull theswitch up and hold it. Release theswitch to stop the window.
CONTINUED
Power Windows
Instruments
andC
ontrols
181
DRIVER’S WINDOW SWITCH
MAIN SWITCH
Closing a power window onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers areaway from the windows beforeclosing them.
06/08/12 18:42:00 31SJA620 0186
-
Auto reverse stops sensing when thewindow is almost closed. You shouldalways check that all passengers andobjects are away from the windowbefore closing it.
To open the window fully,push the window switch firmly downto the second detent, then release it.The window automatically goesdown all the way. To stop thewindow from going all the way down,pull back on the window switchbriefly.
To close the window fully, pull backthe window switch firmly to thesecond detent, then release it. Thewindow automatically goes all theway up. To stop the window fromgoing all the way up, push down onthe window switch briefly.
To open or close the windowpartially, push down or pull back onthe window switch lightly to the firstdetent, and hold it. The window willstop when you release the switch.
All window switches also have theAUTO feature.
If the window runs into any obstaclewhile it is closing automatically, itwill reverse direction, and then stop.To close the window, remove theobstacle, then use the window switchagain.
The indicators in the switches comeon when you turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position.
The power windows have a key-offdelay. You can still open and closethe windows for up to 10 minutesafter you turn off the ignition switch.The key-off delay cancels as soon asyou open either front door. You mustthen turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position for the powerwindows to operate.
Auto Reverse
AUTO
Power Windows
182
06/08/12 18:42:07 31SJA620 0187
You can open all of the windows andthe moonroof from outside with theremote.
Press the UNLOCK button onceto unlock the driver’s door.
To open the windows andmoonroof further, press thebutton again and hold it. If thewindows and the moonroof stopbefore the desired position, repeatsteps 1 and 2.
You cannot close the windows or themoonroof with the remote.
You can open and close the windowsand moonroof with the built-in key inthe driver’s door lock.
Insert the built-in key in the driver’sdoor lock.
To open:
Turn the key clockwise, thenrelease it.
Turn the built-in key clockwiseagain, and hold it. All fourwindows and the moonroof start toopen. To stop the windows andmoonroof, release the built-in key.
Press the UNLOCK button asecond time, and hold it. All thedoors unlock, and all four windowsand moonroof start to open. Tostop the windows and moonroof,release the button.
When the windows or moonroofstops before opening fully, to openthe windows and moonroof further,turn and hold the key again(within 10 seconds).
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
CONTINUED
Opening the Windows andMoonroof with the Remote
Opening/Closing the Windowsand Moonroof with the Built-inKey
Power Windows, Moonroof
Instruments
andC
ontrols
183
Open
Close
UNLOCK BUTTON
06/08/12 18:42:19 31SJA620 0188
To close:Insert the built-in key in the driver’sdoor lock.
NOTE: If the windows and moonroofstop before the desired position,repeat steps 2 and 3.
Turn the key counterclockwiseagain, and hold it. All fourwindows and the moonroof start toclose. To stop the windows andthe moonroof, release the key.
Turn the key counterclockwise,then release it.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position before operating themoonroof switch on the ceilingconsole. To open the moonroof, pullback the moonroof switch. To closethe moonroof, push the moonroofswitch forward. Release the switchto stop the moonroof.
To open the moonroof fully, pullback the moonroof switch firmly.The moonroof opens all the way. Tostop the moonroof from openingfully, push the switch briefly.
To close the windows andmoonroof further, turn and holdthe key again (within 10 seconds).
1.
2.
3.
4.
Power Windows, Moonroof
Opening/Closing the Moonroofwith the Ceiling Console Switch
184
MOONROOF SWITCH
06/08/12 18:42:28 31SJA620 0189
To open or close the moonroofpartially, pull back or push forwardon the moonroof switch lightly to thefirst detent, and hold it. Themoonroof will stop when you releasethe switch.
To tilt the moonroof, push the centerof the moonroof switch straight up.To stop the moonroof from tiltingfully open, push the moonroof switchforward.
To close the moonroof fully, pushthe moonroof switch forward to thesecond detent, then release it. Themoonroof closes all the way. To stopthe moonroof from closing all theway, push the switch briefly.
Moonroof
Instruments
andC
ontrols
185
Opening or closing themoonroof on someone’s handsor fingers can cause seriousinjury.
Make sure all hands and fingersare clear of the moonroofbefore opening or closing it.
06/08/12 18:42:33 31SJA620 0190
You can use the remote transmitteror the key to operate the moonrooffrom the outside. Refer to page
for details.
The moonroof has a key-off delay.You can still open and close themoonroof for up to 10 minutes afteryou turn off the ignition switch. Thekey-off delay cancels as soon as youopen either front door. You mustthen turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position for the moonroof tooperate.
If the moonroof runs into anyobstacle while it is closingautomatically, it will reversedirection, and then stop. To close themoonroof, remove the obstacle, thenuse the moonroof switch again.
Auto reverse stops sensing when themoonroof is almost closed. Youshould always check that allpassengers and objects are awayfrom the moonroof before closing it.
183
Moonroof
Operating the Moonroof with theRemote Transmitter or the Key
Auto Reverse
186
If you try to open the moonroof inbelow-f reezing temperatures, or whenit is covered with snow or ice, you candamage the moonroof panel or itsmotor.
06/08/12 18:42:39 31SJA620 0191
To apply the parking brake, push theparking brake pedal down with yourfoot. To release the parking brake,push on the pedal again. The parkingbrake indicator on the instrumentpanel should go out when theparking brake is fully released withthe engine running (see page ).63
Parking Brake
Instruments
andC
ontrols
187
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
Driving the vehicle with the parkingbrake applied can damage the rearbrakes, axles, and tires. A beeper willsound if the vehicle is put into gearwith the parking brake on.
06/08/12 18:42:43 31SJA620 0192
Interior Convenience Items
188
ASHTRAY
FRONT DOOR POCKET ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS
GLOVE BOX/OWNER’S MANUAL TRAY
UTILITY POCKET
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT
SEAT-BACK POCKET
BEVERAGE HOLDER
SEAT-BACK POCKET
BEVERAGE HOLDER
06/08/12 18:42:47 31SJA620 0193
Your vehicle has an owner’s manualtray inside the glove box. To openthe tray, push the release button up.
Open the glove box by pulling thehandle. Close it with a firm push.Lock or unlock the glove box withthe built-in key.
To close the tray, push it up.
The glove box light comes on onlywhen the parking lights are on.
Interior Convenience Items
Glove Box
Instruments
andC
ontrols
189
RELEASE BUTTON
An open glove box can causeserious injury to your passengerin a crash, even if thepassenger is wearing the seatbelt.
Always keep the glove boxclosed while driving.
06/08/12 18:42:55 31SJA620 0194
For a short container, put the bottomplate down, and pull up the knob touse the separator.
For a long container, press thebutton in the beverage holder toraise the bottom plate. Stand theseparator up.
Be careful when you are using thebeverage holders. A spilled liquidthat is very hot can scald you or yourpassengers. Spilled liquids candamage the upholstery, carpeting,and electrical components in theinterior.
To use the beverage holder, pushthe lid.
Beverage Holders
Interior Convenience Items
190
LID Press
BUTTON
Pull up
SEPARATOR
KNOB
BOTTOM PLATEBOTTOM PLATE
06/08/12 18:43:02 31SJA620 0195
The rear beverage holder is in therear seat armrest. Open thebeverage holder by pushing the frontof it.
To open the console compartment,pull up on the lever and lift thearmrest.
To close, lower the armrest, andpush it down until it latches.
You can put small items in the traylocated in the console compartmentlid. To use the tray, pull up on thelever, and lift the armrest pad.
The console compartment light is onwhen the light switch is in the
or position.
Console Compartment
Interior Convenience Items
Instruments
andC
ontrols
191
LEVER
LEVER
06/08/12 18:43:09 31SJA620 0196
You can extend the sun visor furtherby pulling it back.
To use a sun visor, pull it down. Youcan also use a sun visor at the sidewindow. Remove the support rodfrom the clip, and swing the sunvisor toward the side window.
There are two accessory powersockets. One is located in the frontof the center console. To use thepower socket, push and release thelid, then push it forward until thesocket comes to the proper positionto use.
Do not use the sun visor extensionfeature over the rear view mirror.
Make sure to slide a sun visorforward to set it to the normal lengthbefore flipping it back in place.
Make sure you put the sun visorback in place when you are gettinginto or out of the vehicle.
Interior Convenience Items
Sun Visors Accessory Power Sockets
192
06/08/12 18:43:17 31SJA620 0197
Small, rear ashtrays are located inthe armrests of both rear doors. Toopen an ashtray, pivot the lid up.
The other socket is under thearmrest in the console compartmentstorage area. To use the powersocket, pull up the cover.
These sockets are intended to supplypower for 12 volt DC accessoriesthat are rated 120 watts or less (10amps).
They will not power an automotivetype cigarette lighter element.
The rear ashtray light is on when thelight switch is in the or
position.
The interior of each front door hasan extendable pocket for maps andother small, lightweight items. Forsafety, be sure both front doorpockets are closed while driving.
When the light switch is in theor position, the front door
pocket light is on.
To remove an ashtray for emptying,open the lid, then carefully pull thetab inside the ashtray straight up andout of the armrest.
Interior Convenience Items
Rear Ashtrays Front Door Pockets
Instruments
andC
ontrols
193
TAB LID
06/08/12 18:43:26 31SJA620 0198
When you shift to reverse, thesunshade goes down automatically.To use it again, shift to anotherposition, and push the button to raiseit.If the sunshade stops while moving,check for and clear any obstacles,then push the button again.
With the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, push the power rearsunshade button on the ceilingconsole to raise the rear sunshade.Push the button again to lower it.
Power Rear Sunshade
Interior Convenience Items
194
POWER REARSUNSHADE BUTTON
06/08/12 18:43:31 31SJA620 0199
Each rear door has an integratedsunshade. To use a sunshade, holdthe tab on the top, insert thesunshade into the holder, and pullthe sunshade all the way up. Insertthe holes on the sunshade into thehooks on the window frame.
To prevent the integrated sunshadesfrom being unhooked due to winds,leave the rear windows closed whiledriving.
The hooks are intended for use onlyby the sunshades. Do not hang anyother items on the hooks, as thatcould interfere with proper operationof the side curtain airbags.
Integrated Sunshades
Interior Convenience Items
Instruments
andC
ontrols
195
TAB
HOLE
HOOK HOLDER
06/08/12 18:43:37 31SJA620 0200
After pushing the DOOR button, allthe lights come on when you openany door, unlock the doors with theremote or built-in key, or turn theignition switch from the ON (II) orthe ACCESSORY (I) position to theLOCK (0) position. The indicator inthe button comes on as a reminder.
The front and rear of the ceilinghave ceiling lights.
To change the ‘‘INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME’’ setting, see page
.
Push each ceiling light button to turnits light on and off.
Push the ON button to turn on all theceiling lights. Push the OFF buttonto turn them off. 116
Ceiling Lights
Interior Lights
196
ONBUTTON
OFFBUTTON
DOORBUTTON
FRONT
REAR
CEILING LIGHTBUTTONS
CEILING LIGHTBUTTONS
06/08/12 18:43:45 31SJA620 0201
The standard audio system hasmany features. This sectiondescribes those features and how touse them.
The climate control system in yourvehicle provides a comfortabledriving environment in all weatherconditions.
The climate control system and theaudio system have a voice controlfeature.
Your vehicle has an anti-theft audiosystem that requires a code numberto enable it.
The security system helps todiscourage vandalism and theft ofyour vehicle.
...............Climate Control System . 198................................Audio System . 207
Playing Play the AM/FM......................................Radio . 208
....AM/FM Radio Frequencies . 212........AM/FM Radio Reception . 212
.................Adjusting the Sound . 214Playing the XM Satellite
......................................Radio . 217...Operating the Disc Changer . 223
..................Protecting Your Discs . 234...Disc Changer Error Messages . 235
......................Auxiliary Input Jack . 236................Remote Audio Controls . 237.................Radio Theft Protection . 239
...........................Compass System . 240................Voice Control Basics . 263
......................Setting the Clock . 272............................Security System . 274
...............................Cruise Control . 275..Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) . 278
HomeLink Universal................................Transceiver . 293
......................................AcuraLink . 297..........................HandsFreeLink . 306
...Rearview Camera and Monitor . 324
Features
Features
197
TM
06/08/12 18:43:51 31SJA620 0202
Climate Control System
198
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
RECIRCULATIONBUTTON
AUTOBUTTON
OFFBUTTON
DUAL BUTTON
TEMPERATURE CONTROL BARS
REARWINDOWDEFOGGER/MIRRORHEATERBUTTON
INTERFACE DIAL
WINDSHIELDDEFROSTER BUTTON
A/CBUTTON
U.S. models(Technology package model is shown)
06/08/12 18:43:56 31SJA620 0203
Many climate control functions canstill be controlled by standardbuttons, dials, and knobs, but somefunctions can only be accessed usingthe interface dial. The interface dialhas two parts, a knob and a selector.
The knob turns left and right. Use itto make selections or adjustments toa list or menu on the screen.
The selector can be pushed left,right, up, down, and in. Use theselector to scroll through lists, toselect menus, and to highlight menuitems. When you make a selection,push the center of the selector(ENTER) to go to that selection.
When you unlock the doors withyour remote, the driver’s ID (Driver1 or Driver 2) is detected, and theclimate control settings are turned tothe respective mode automaticallywhen the ignition is turned to theON (II) position.
The climate control system can alsobe operated by voice control.
See the Navi section in your quickstart guide for an overview of thissystem, and the navigation systemmanual for complete details.
Refer to Voice Control Basics forcomplete details (see page ).263
On models with navigation system
On models without navigation system
Interface Dial Personalization Setting
Voice Control System
Climate Control System
Features
199
ENTER
SELECTOR
KNOB
06/08/12 18:44:06 31SJA620 0204
To select the desired temperature,push the temperature control bar upor down.
To set the driver’s and passenger’stemperature separately, press theDUAL button. The indicator in thebutton will come on. The driver andpassenger can each set thetemperature to the desired setting.
Press the A/C button to view theclimate control display, then turn theinterface knob to increase ordecrease the fan speed and airflow.
To make the driver’s and passenger’stemperature the same, push theDUAL button again. The indicator inthe button goes out, and thepassenger’s temperature is set to thedriver’s temperature.
Press the A/C button to view theclimate control display. PushingENTER on the interface selectorturns the air conditioning on and off.You will see A/C ON or A/C OFF inthe display.
When you turn the A/C off, thesystem cannot regulate the insidetemperature if you set thetemperature control below theoutside temperature.
Fan Control Temperature Control Bars Air Conditioning (A/C)
Climate Control System
200
06/08/12 18:44:15 31SJA620 0205
The outside air intakes for theclimate control system are at thebase of the windshield. Keep thisarea clear of leaves and other debris.
The system should be left in freshair mode under almost all conditions.Keeping the system in recirculationmode, particularly with the A/C off,can cause the windows to fog up.
Switch to recirculation mode whendriving through dusty or smokyconditions, then return to fresh airmode.
This button turns the windshielddefrost on and off.
You can select the vents air flowsfrom. Some air will flow from thedashboard corner and side vents inall modes.
When you push this button, air flowsfrom the defroster vents at the baseof the windshield, and the systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C. Whenthe indicator in the button is on, thepassenger’s temperature cannot beset separately from the driver’s.
This button turns the rear windowdefogger on and off (see page ).Pushing this button also turns thepower mirror heaters on and off.
Press the A/C button to view theclimate control display, then pushthe interface selector down. Selectany of the modes by turning theinterface knob.
When the indicator in the button ison, air from the vehicle’s interior issent throughout the system again.When the indicator is off, air isbrought in from the outside of thevehicle (fresh air mode).
146
CONTINUED
Recirculation Button Mode ControlWindshield Defroster Button
Rear Window DefoggerButton
Climate Control System
Features
201
06/08/12 18:44:28 31SJA620 0206
Air flows from the centerand corner vents in the dashboard.
Airflow is divided betweenthe vents in the dashboard and thefloor vents.
Air flows from the floorvents.
Airflow is divided betweenthe floor vents and defroster vents atthe base of the windshield.
When is selected, you canincrease or decrease thetemperature of airflow from thedashboard vent for the driver’s sideand the passenger’s side withoutchanging the temperature of airflowfrom the floor vent.
Push the interface selector right orleft, then turn the interface knob toselect the desired temperature.
Climate Control System
202
06/08/12 18:44:38 31SJA620 0207
The heater uses engine coolant towarm the air. If the engine is cold, itwill be several minutes before youfeel warm air coming from thesystem.
The flow-through ventilation systemdraws in outside air, circulates itthrough the interior, then exhausts itthrough vents near the rear window.
Set the temperature to the lowerlimit.Make sure the A/C is off.Select and fresh air mode.Set the fan to the desired speed.
Press the A/C button to viewthe climate control display.Turn on the A/C by pushingENTER on the interface selector.You will see A/C ON in the display.Make sure the temperature is setto maximum cool.Push the interface selector down,then select by turning theinterface knob.If the outside air is humid, selectrecirculation mode. If the outsideair is dry, select fresh air mode.Push the interface selector down,then set the fan to the desiredspeed by turning the interfaceknob.
Press the A/C button to viewthe climate control display.Turn the interface knob to set thefan to the desired speed.Push the interface selector down,then select and fresh airmode.Adjust the warmth of the air withthe temperature control bars.
You can set the temperature for thedriver’s side and the passenger’s sideseparately when this button ispressed (indicator on). When theindicator in the DUAL button is off,you can adjust both sides to thesame temperature with the driver’sside temperature control bar.
Air conditioning places an extra loadon the engine. Watch the enginecoolant temperature gauge (see page
). If it moves near the red zone,turn off the A/C until the gaugereading returns to normal.
you cancool it down more rapidly by partiallyopening the windows, turning on theair conditioning, and setting the fanto maximum speed in fresh air mode.
1.
2.3.4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
70
If the interior is very warm,
Using the HeaterDual Button
Ventilation
Using the A/C
Climate Control System
Features
203
06/08/12 18:44:49 31SJA620 0208
Air conditioning, as it cools, removesmoisture from the air. When used incombination with the heater, itmakes the interior warm and dry.
This setting is suitable for all drivingconditions whenever the outsidetemperature is above 32°F (0°C).
To remove fog from the inside of thewindows: Select . The system
automatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C.Select .Set the fan and temperaturecontrols to maximum level.
For your safety, make sure you havea clear view through all the windowsbefore driving.
Set the fan to the desired speed, orhigh for faster defrosting.Select . The systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C.Adjust the temperature so theairflow feels warm.Select to help clear therear window.To increase airflow to thewindshield, close the corner vents.
When you switch to another modefrom , the A/C settingreturns to the previous setting (on oroff). Select A/C, then press ENTERon the interface selector to turn theA/C off if it is on.
Switch the fan on.Turn on the air conditioning.Select and fresh air mode.Adjust the temperature to yourpreference.
To clear the windshield faster, youcan close the dashboard corner ventsby rotating the wheel next to it. Thissends more warm air to thewindshield defroster vents. Once thewindshield is clear, select the freshair mode to avoid fogging thewindows.
1.2.3.4.
1.
2.3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Dehumidify the Interior To Defog and Defrost To Remove Exterior Frost or IceFrom the Windows
Climate Control System
204
06/08/12 18:45:00 31SJA620 0209
The automatic climate controlsystem adjusts the fan speed andairflow levels to maintain the interiortemperature you select.
In AUTO mode, the vehicle’s interiortemperature is independentlyregulated for the driver andpassenger. If the driver’s side of thevehicle is getting too much sun, thesystem will adjust to a lowertemperature.
Press the AUTO button.Set the desired temperature withthe temperature control bars.You will see AUTO in the displayif the climate mode is selected.
The system automatically selects theproper mix of conditioned and/orheated air that will, as quickly aspossible, raise or lower the interiortemperature to your preference.
When you set the temperature to itslower or its upper limit, the systemruns at full cooling or heating only. Itdoes not regulate the interiortemperature.
When you change the fan speed, thefan is taken out of AUTO mode andstarts to run at the selected speed.
You can manually select variousfunctions of the climate controlsystem when it is in fully automaticmode. All other features remainautomatically controlled. Making anymanual selection causes the wordAUTO in the display to go out.
Press the OFF button. However, alack of airflow can cause thewindows to fog up. You should keepthe fan on at all times so stale air andmoisture do not build up in theinterior and cause fogging.
1.2.
Automatic Climate Control Semi-automatic Operation
To Turn Everything Off
Climate Control System
Features
205
06/08/12 18:45:09 31SJA620 0210
The climate control system has twosensors. A sunlight sensor is in thetop of the dashboard, and atemperature sensor is next to thesteering column. Do not cover thesensors or spill any liquid on them.
Sunlight and TemperatureSensors
Climate Control Sensors
206
SUNLIGHT SENSOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
06/08/12 18:45:14 31SJA620 0211
Most audio system functions can stillbe controlled by standard buttons,dials, and knobs, but some functionscan only be accessed using theinterface dial. The interface dial hastwo parts, a knob and a selector.
The selector can be pushed left,right, up, down, and in. Use theselector to scroll through lists, toselect menus, and to highlight menuitems. When you make a selection,push the center of the selector(ENTER) to go to that selection.
The knob turns left and right. Use itto make selections or adjustments toa list or menu on the screen.
When you unlock the doors withyour remote and turn the audiosystem on, the driver’s ID (Driver 1or Driver 2) is detected, and theradio preset memory (see page ),the auto select preset memory (seepage ), and the volume andsound level settings (see page )are turned to the respectivememorized mode automatically.
The audio system can also beoperated by voice control.
See the Navi section in your quickstart guide for an overview of thissystem, and the navigation systemmanual for complete details.
Refer to Voice Control Basics forcomplete details (see page ).
210
211214
263
On models without navigation system
On models with navigation system
Interface Dial Personalization Setting
Voice Control System
Audio System
Features
207
KNOB
ENTER
SELECTOR
06/08/12 18:45:24 31SJA620 0212
Audio System
Playing the AM/FM Radio
208
PRESET BUTTONS
AM/FMBUTTON
TUNEBUTTONS
TUNEBUTTONS
AUTOSELECTBUTTON
AM BUTTON
FM BUTTON
AUDIODISPLAYBUTTON
SEEKBUTTONS
AUDIODISPLAYBUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
UPPER DISPLAY
SCANBUTTON
SEEKBUTTONS
SCANBUTTON
INTERFACE DIAL INTERFACE DIAL
POWER/VOLUMEKNOB
POWER/VOLUMEKNOB
U.S. models (Technology package model is shown) Canadian and Hawaiian models
06/08/12 18:45:32 31SJA620 0213
- Use the TUNE button totune the radio to a desired frequency.Press the button to tune to ahigher frequency, or the buttonto tune to a lower frequency. To tunewith the interface dial, push theselector down, and turn the knob toTUNE. Then press ENTER on theselector, and turn the knob to thedesired frequency. To exit theTUNE mode, press ENTER on theselector.
You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: thepreset buttons, and .
The ignition switch must be in theACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II)position. Press the AUDIO button toview the audio control display. Turnthe system on by pressing thepower/volume knob or the AM/FMbutton (AM or FM button onCanadian and Hawaiian models).Adjust the volume by turning thepower/volume knob.
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to are shown onthe display. To change bands, pressthe AM/FM button (AM or FMbutton on Canadian and Hawaiianmodels). You can also change bandsby pushing the interface selector up.Each time you push it up, the bandwill change to FM1, FM2, or AM. Onthe FM bands, STEREO will beshown on the navigation screen andST on the upper display, if thestation is broadcasting in stereo.Stereo reproduction on AM is notavailable.
CONTINUED
TUNE
To Select a Station
TUNE, SEEK, SCAN,AUTO SELECT
Audio System
Features
209
STEREO ICON
TUNE ICON
BAND
06/08/12 18:45:40 31SJA620 0214
-
-
-The SEEK functionsearches up and down from thecurrent frequency to find a stationwith a strong signal. To activate it,press the or SEEK button,then release it. You can also activateSEEK by pushing the interfaceselector to the right or left.
The SCAN functionsamples all stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it.
Each preset button orpreset icon can store one frequencyon AM and two frequencies on FM.
Use the tune, seek, or scanfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.
To scan with the interface dial, pushthe selector down, and then push itto the right. You will see SCANflashing on the screen and the upperdisplay.
The system will scan for a stationwith a strong signal. When it findsone, it will stop and play that stationfor about 10 seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and play itfor 10 seconds. When it plays astation that you want to listen to,press the scan button again, or pushthe interface selector to the rightagain.
Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo sets of FM frequencies withthe preset buttons (on-screenicons).
Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store atotal of six stations on AM andtwelve stations on FM.
Press the preset button, and holdit until you hear a beep. You canalso store frequencies with theinterface dial. Select the preseticon you want to store thefrequency on, then press ENTERon the interface selector, and holdit for more than 2 seconds.
4.
1.
2.
3.
To store a preset memory location:
SEEK
SCAN
Preset
Audio System
210
SCAN ICON
06/08/12 18:45:50 31SJA620 0215
- If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive your preset stations,you can use the auto select feature tofind stations in the local area.
You will see ‘‘0’’ displayed if autoselect cannot find a strong station forevery preset button.If you do not like the stations autoselect has stored, you can storeother frequencies on the presetbuttons (icons) as previouslydescribed.
To turn off auto select, pressENTER on the interface selector(press the A.SEL button) again. Thisrestores the presets you originallyset.
Push the interface selector down toscroll down the screen, highlightA.SEL, then press ENTER on theinterface selector. You will seeA.SEL on the upper display andAUTO SEL on the screen, and thesystem goes into scan mode forseveral seconds.
Press the A.SEL button. You will seeA.SEL on the upper display AUTOSEL on the screen, and the systemgoes into scan mode for severalseconds. The system stores thefrequencies of six AM and twelveFM stations in the preset buttons.
U.S. models (except Hawaiian)
Canadian and Hawaiian models
AUTO SELECT
Audio System
Features
211
AUTO SEL ICON
06/08/12 18:45:57 31SJA620 0216
Those bands cover these frequen-cies:
AM band: 530 to 1,710 kHzFM band: 87.7 to 107.9 MHz
Driving very near the transmitter ofa station that is broadcasting on afrequency close to the frequency ofthe station you are listening to canalso affect your radio’s reception.You may temporarily hear bothstations, or hear only the station youare close to.
The radio can receive the completeAM and FM bands.
How well the radio receives stationsis dependent on many factors, suchas the distance from the station’stransmitter, nearby large objects,and atmospheric conditions.
A radio station’s signal gets weakeras you get farther away from itstransmitter. If you are listening to anAM station, you will notice the soundvolume becoming weaker, and thestation drifting in and out. If you arelistening to an FM station, you willsee the stereo indicator flickering offand on as the signal weakens.Eventually, the stereo indicator willgo off and the sound will fadecompletely as you get out of range ofthe station’s signal.
Radio stations on the AM band areassigned frequencies at least 10 kHzapart (530, 540, 550). Stations on theFM band are assigned frequencies atleast 0.2 MHz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3).
Stations must use these exactfrequencies. It is fairly common forstations to round-off the frequency intheir advertising, so your radio coulddisplay a frequency of 100.9 eventhough the announcer may identifythe station as ‘‘FM101.’’
Audio System
AM/FM Radio Frequencies AM/FM Radio Reception
212
06/08/12 18:46:06 31SJA620 0217
Radio signals, especially on the FMband, are deflected by large objectssuch as buildings and hills. Yourradio then receives both the directsignal from the station’s transmitter,and the deflected signal. This causesthe sound to distort or flutter. This isa main cause of poor radio receptionin city driving.
Radio reception can be affected byatmospheric conditions such asthunderstorms, high humidity, andeven sunspots. You may be able toreceive a distant radio station oneday and not receive it the next daybecause of a change in conditions.
Electrical interference from passingvehicles and stationary sources cancause temporary reception problems.
As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
Audio System
Features
213
06/08/12 18:46:12 31SJA620 0218
Select the mode you want to adjustby pushing the interface selector upor down, or by turning the interfaceknob.
To adjust them, press the AUDIObutton, push the interface selectordown, and turn the interface knob toSOUND. Then press ENTER on theselector.
BASS, TREBLE, BALANCE, andFADER are each adjustable. You canalso adjust the strength of the soundcoming from the center andsubwoofer speakers. In addition, youcan set the AudioPilot andCenterpoint features (when playinga CD-DA) to on or off.
Audio System
Adjusting the Sound
214
SOUND ICON
06/08/12 18:46:18 31SJA620 0219
- - -To adjust bassand treble, select BASS or TREBLE,and press ENTER on the interfaceselector. The current setting isshown on the display. Turn theinterface knob to the desired level,and enter your selection by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
Thesemodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.Fader adjusts the front-to-backstrength, while balance adjusts theside-to-side strength. To adjust faderand balance, select FADER orBALANCE, then press ENTER onthe interface selector. The currentsetting is shown on the screen. Turnthe interface knob to the desiredlevel, and enter your selection bypressing ENTER on the interfaceselector. To equalize the fader orbalance, turn the interface knob untilthe marks on the sound grid come tothe center of the adjustment bar.
Toadjust the strength of the soundfrom the center or subwooferspeaker, select it and press ENTERon the interface selector. Turn theinterface knob to the desired level,and enter your selection by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
CONTINUED
BASS/TREBLE FADER/BALANCE CENTER/SUBWOOFER
Audio System
Features
215
06/08/12 18:46:23 31SJA620 0220
- -
To set this feature on or off, selectAudioPilot, and press ENTER on theinterface selector. Turn the interfaceknob to ON or OFF, and pressENTER on the interface selector.The ON or OFF indicator is shownon the screen.
Bose AudioPilotdigital processing monitors soundwithin the cabin, and helpscompensate for unwanted ambientnoise with no perceived change inaudio volume.
Bose Centerpointsignal processing processes stereoand matrix surround recordings tofive independent channels, deliveringa multi-channel surround soundexperience, even from conventionalstereo discs.
To set this feature on or off, selectCenterpoint, and press ENTER onthe interface selector. Turn theinterface knob to ON or OFF, andpress ENTER on the interfaceselector. The ON or OFF indicator isshown on the display.
Centerpoint is only availablewhen listening to a CD (CD-DA).
AudioPilot and Centerpoint areregistered trade marks of the Bosecorporation.
AudioPilot Centerpoint
Audio System
216
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:46:29 31SJA620 0221
Audio System
Playing the XM Satellite Radio
Features
217
PRESET BUTTON
SCANBUTTON
DISPLAY/MODEBUTTON
SATELLITE RADIO BUTTON
AUDIODISPLAYBUTTON
UPPER DISPLAY
INTERFACE DIAL
POWER/VOLUMEKNOB
CATEGORYBUTTONS
TUNEBUTTONS
U.S. models(Technology package model is shown)
06/08/12 18:46:35 31SJA620 0222
-
Your vehicle is capable of receivingXM Satellite Radio anywhere in theUnited States, except Hawaii andAlaska.XM is a registered trade mark ofXM Satellite Radio, Inc.
XM Satellite Radio receives signalsfrom two satellites to produce clear,high-quality digital reception. Itoffers many channels in severalcategories. Along with a largeselection of different types of music,XM Satellite Radio also allows you toview channel and category selectionsin the audio display.
To listen to XM Satellite Radio, turnthe ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II)position. Push the power/volumeknob to turn on the audio system,and press the button. Thelast channel you listened to will showin the display. Adjust the volume byturning the power/volume knob.
Push the AUDIO button to displayXM information on the screen.
You may experience periods whenXM Satellite Radio does not transmitthe artist’s name and or the song titleinformation. If this happens, there isnothing wrong with your system.
In the category mode, such as Jazz,Rock, Classical, etc., you cannavigate through all of the channelswithin that category. In the channelmode, you can select all of theavailable channels.
To change categories, press theCATEGORY button, or push theinterface selector left or right.
To switch between thecategory mode and channel mode,press and hold the DISP/MODEbutton until the mode changes. TheCATEGORY or CHANNEL mode isdisplayed on the screen. To switchthe mode with the interface dial,scroll down, select MODE, and pressENTER on the selector.
MODE
Audio System
218
06/08/12 18:46:43 31SJA620 0223
-To change channels, press theTUNE button, or scroll down withthe interface selector, select TUNE,and press ENTER on the selector.Then turn the interface knob to thedesired channel. In the categorymode, you can only select channelswithin that category.
The scan function givesyou a sampling of all channels whilein the channel mode. In the categorymode, only the channels within thatcategory are scanned. To activateSCAN, press the SCAN button. Toscan with the interface dial, scrolldown, and push interface selector tothe right. You will see SCAN on thescreen.
The system plays each channel innumerical order for a few seconds,then selects the next channel. Whenyou hear a channel you want tocontinue listening to, press theSCAN button or push the interfaceselector to the right again.
CONTINUED
SCAN
Audio System
Features
219
TUNE ICON
06/08/12 18:46:50 31SJA620 0224
- You can store up to 12preset channels using the six presetbuttons. Each button stores onechannel from the XM1 band and onechannel from the XM2 band.
To store a channel:Press the button or scrollup by pushing the interfaceselector up. Either XM1 or XM2will be shown on the display.
Use the TUNE or SCAN functionto tune to a desired channel.
In category mode, only channelswithin that category can be selected.In channel mode, all channels can beselected.
Pick the preset button you wantfor that channel. Press and holdthe button until you hear a beep.
Press the button or scrollup again. The other XM band willbe shown. Store the next sixchannels using steps 2 and 3.
Once a channel is stored, press andrelease the proper preset button totune to it.
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store thefirst six channels.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Preset
Audio System
220
XMBAND
06/08/12 18:46:59 31SJA620 0225
The XM satellites are in orbit overthe equator; therefore, objects southof the vehicle may cause satellitereception interruptions. To helpcompensate for this, ground-basedrepeaters are placed in majormetropolitan areas.Satellite signals are more likely to beblocked by tall buildings andmountains the farther north youtravel from the equator.
Because XM is unavailable in Alaska,the XM hardware equipped withyour vehicle cannot be operated.
CONTINUED
Audio System
Operation of RL model in Alaska
Features
221
Signal may be blocked bymountains or large obstacles tothe south.
Signal weaker inthese areas.
SATELLITE
GROUNDREPEATER
06/08/12 18:47:05 31SJA620 0226
Depending on where you drive, youmay experience reception problems.Interference can be caused by any ofthese conditions:
Driving on the north side of alarge commercial truck on aneast/west road.Driving in tunnels.Driving on a road beside a verticalwall, steep cliff, or hill to the southof you.Driving on the lower level of amulti-tiered road.Driving on a single lane roadalongside dense trees taller than50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you.
There may be other geographicsituations that could affect satelliteradio reception.
If your XM Radio service has expiredor you purchased your vehicle froma previous owner, you can listen to asampling of the broadcasts availableon XM Satellite Radio. With theignition switch in the ACCESSORY(I) or the ON (II) position, push thepower/volume knob to turn on theaudio system, and press the
button. A variety of musictypes and styles will play.
While waiting for activation, makesure your vehicle remains in an openarea with good reception. Once youraudio system is activated, ‘‘category’’or ‘‘CH’’ will appear in the display,and you’ll be able to listen to XMRadio broadcasts. XM Radio willcontinue to send an activation signalto your vehicle for at least 12 hoursfrom the activation request. If theservice has not been activated after36 hours, contact XM Radio.
After you’ve registered with XMRadio, keep your audio system in theSatellite Radio mode while you waitfor activation. This should take about30 minutes.
Driving on the north side of aneast/west mountain road.
If you decide to purchase XMSatellite Radio service, contact XMRadio at , or at1-800-852-9696. You will need to givethem your radio I.D. number andyour credit card number. To get your
radio I.D. number, press the TUNEbar until ‘‘0’’ appears in the display.Your I.D. will appear in the display.
As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
www.xmradio.com
Receiving XM Satellite RadioService
Audio System
222
06/08/12 18:47:15 31SJA620 0227
CONTINUED
Audio System
Operating the Disc Changer
Features
223
EJECTBUTTON
EJECTBUTTON
UPPER DISPLAY
INTERFACE DIAL INTERFACE DIAL
SKIPBUTTONS
AUDIODISPLAYBUTTON
SKIPBUTTONS
DISCBUTTON
LOADBUTTON
SCANBUTTON
POWER/VOLUMEKNOB
TUNEBUTTONS
DISCBUTTON
LOADBUTTON
SCANBUTTON
AUDIODISPLAYBUTTON
TUNEBUTTONS
POWER/VOLUMEKNOB
U.S. models (Technology package model is shown) Canadian and Hawaiian models
06/08/12 18:47:24 31SJA620 0228
Your vehicle’s audio system has anin-dash disc changer with the samecontrols used for the radio. Tooperate the disc changer, the ignitionswitch must be in the ACCESSORY(I) or the ON (II) position.
The disc changer can play these discformats:
CD (CD-DA)CD-R/RWDVD-ADTS
The disc packages or jackets shouldhave one of these marks.
DVD-A discs not meeting DVDverification standards may not beplayable.
The changer cannot play DVD-V orDVD-R/RW formats.
Some CD-DA and CD-ROM mixeddiscs are not playable.
‘‘DTS’’ and ‘‘DTS Digital Surround’’are registered trademarks of DigitalTheater Systems, Inc.
The changer can also play MP3 orWMA format (see page ).
You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.
230
Audio System
224
TM
Do not use discs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause thedisc to jam in the unit.
06/08/12 18:47:36 31SJA620 0229
To load multiple discs in oneoperation:
Press and hold the LOAD buttonon the changer unit until you heara beep. You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ onthe upper display, and the discload indicator turns red and startsblinking.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
Insert the disc into the disc slotwhen the disc load indicator turnsgreen and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears in theupper display at the same time.Insert it only halfway; the drivewill pull it in the rest of the way.You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ on the upperdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red again and blinks as thedisc is loaded.
When the disc load indicator turnsgreen and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears on theupper display again, insert thenext disc in the slot.
Repeat steps 1 through 3 until allsix positions are loaded. If you arenot loading all six positions, pressthe LOAD button again after thelast disc has loaded.
Insert a disc into the disc slotwhen the disc load indicator turnsgreen, and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears onthe upper display at the same time.Insert the disc only about halfway;the drive will pull it in the rest ofthe way. You will see the discnumber blinking on the upperdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red again and blinks as thedisc is loaded.
You will see ‘‘DISC READ’’ on theupper display, then the systembegins to play the disc.
If you stop loading discs before allsix positions are filled, the systemwill wait for 10 seconds, stop the loadoperation, and begin playing the lastdisc loaded.
To load a single disc:Press and release the LOADbutton on the changer unit. Youwill see ‘‘BUSY’’ on the upperdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red and starts blinking.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.3.
2.
CONTINUED
Audio System
Loading Discs in the Changer
Features
225
06/08/12 18:47:47 31SJA620 0230
You can also select the emptyposition by pressing the appropriatepreset button.
You can load a disc(s) in any mode(AM, FM, XM radio, or AUX) if youdo not select an empty position.
You cannot select the empty positionif there is no disc in the changer.
You can load a disc into an emptyposition while a disc is playing. Pressthe AUDIO button to view the audiocontrol display. Select the emptyposition (‘‘No Disc’’ is shown on theaudio control display) by rotating theinterface dial. Then press ENTER onthe selector to enter your selection.The current disc stops playing andstarts the loading sequence. The discjust loaded will play.
Audio System
226
EMPTY POSITION
06/08/12 18:47:53 31SJA620 0231
To select a different disc, press thecorresponding number on the presetbuttons, or turn the interface knob tohighlight the desired disc, then pressENTER on the interface selector.
You can also choose a track directlyfrom a track list. Press ENTER onthe interface selector, and the tracklist screen will be shown. If there areno track names, track numbers aredisplayed. You will see the currenttrack is highlighted. Turn theinterface knob to select the desiredtrack, then press ENTER on theinterface selector.
Select the changer by pressing theDISC/AUX button. The system willbegin playing the last selected disc inthe disc changer. You will see thecurrent disc position highlighted.
When playing a CD (CD-DA) withCD-TEXT, the audio control displayshows the disc number, album name,track number, and elapsed time.When playing a CD without thisinformation, the number of the discand track playing and the elapsedtime are shown on the audio controldisplay.
Each time you press and release thebutton or push the interface
selector to the right, the player skipsforward to the beginning of the nexttrack. Press and release the
button or push the interfaceselector to the left to skip backwardto the beginning of the current track.Press the button or push theinterface selector to the left again toskip to the previous track.To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the / or /
button.CONTINUED
To Play a Disc To Choose a Track
To Change Tracks
Audio System
Features
227
CURRENT DISC
CURRENT TRACK
06/08/12 18:48:03 31SJA620 0232
To exit the track list display, pressthe AUDIO button, or push theinterface selector to the left.
When you press the SCAN button orscroll down and push the interfaceselector to the left, the next track ofthe current track plays for about 10seconds. You will see SCAN next toTRACK on the screen and SCAN onthe upper display. To hear the rest ofthe track, press the SCAN button or
push the interface selector to the leftagain within 10 seconds.
If you don’t, the system advances tothe next disc, plays about 10 secondsof it, and continues through the restof the discs the same way. When thesystem reaches the last disc, DISCSCAN is canceled, and the disc playsnormally.
When you press and hold the SCANbutton until you hear a beep or scrolldown and push the interface selectorto the right, the first track of the
current disc plays for about 10seconds. You will see SCAN next toDISC on the screen and SCAN onthe upper display. To hear the rest ofthe disc, press the SCAN button orpush the interface selector to theright again within 10 seconds.
If you don’t, the system advances tothe next track, plays about 10seconds of it, and continues throughthe rest of the tracks the same way.
Track Scan
Disc Scan
Audio System
228
SCAN ICON
SCAN ICON
06/08/12 18:48:11 31SJA620 0233
To replay the current trackcontinuously, use the interfaceselector to scroll down, selectTRACK REPEAT, and press ENTERon the interface selector. As areminder, you will see REPEAT nextto TRACK on the screen. To turnthis feature off, highlight TRACKREPEAT (if not already highlighted),and press ENTER on the interfaceselector again.
To replay the current disccontinuously, use the interfaceselector to scroll down, select DISCREPEAT, and press ENTER on theinterface selector. As a reminder,you will see REPEAT next to DISCon the screen. To turn this featureoff, highlight DISC REPEAT (if notalready highlighted), and pressENTER on the interface selectoragain.
To play the tracks of the current discin random order, use the interfaceselector to scroll down, selectTRACK RANDOM, and pressENTER on the interface selector. Asa reminder, you will see RANDOMnext to TRACK on the screen. Toturn this feature off, highlightTRACK RANDOM (if not alreadyhighlighted), and press ENTER onthe interface selector again.
Track Repeat Disc Repeat Random Play
Audio System
Features
229
REPEAT ICON REPEAT ICON RANDOM ICON
TRACK REPEAT ICON DISC REPEAT ICON TRACK RANDOM ICON
06/08/12 18:48:21 31SJA620 0234
To take the system out of disc mode,press the AM/FM (AM or FM onCanadian, and Hawaiian models), orDISC/AUX, or button toswitch to the radio, or satellite radio(U.S. models only), or auxiliary inputwhile a disc is playing. When youreturn to disc mode by pressing theDISC/AUX button, play will continueat the same point that it left off.
The specifications of the compatibleMP3 file are:
You can play a DVD-A disc in thedisc changer. The disc controls aresame as previously described.
The changer plays MP3/WMA discsin recorded order. Maximumplayable file layers are 8, and totalplayable tracks are 255. If your dischas a complex structure, the changertakes some time to read the discbefore beginning play.
Compatible with variable bit rate andmulti-session
Bit rate: 32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160/192/224/256/320 kbps(MPEG1)8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2)
Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz(MPEG1)24/22.05/16 kHz (MPEG2)
To play an MP3/WMA disc, use thedisc controls previously described,along with the following information.
Compatible with variable bit rate andmulti-session
Bit rate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192kbps
Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHz
The specifications of the compatibleWMA file are:
To pause a disc, press thecorresponding number of thecurrent disc on the preset buttons.To play the disc again, press thepreset button again.
If you turn the system off while adisc is playing, either with thepower/volume knob or by turningoff the ignition switch, the disc willstay in the drive. When you turn thesystem back on, the disc will beginplaying where it left off.
You can also pause a disc on theaudio control display. Press theAUDIO button to view the display,select the corresponding number ofthe current disc on the preset iconsby turning the interface knob, thenpress ENTER on the interfaceselector. To play the disc again,select the preset icon, then pressENTER again.
To Pause a Disc
Playing an MP3/WMA Disc
Playing a DVD-A Disc
To Stop Playing a Disc
Audio System
230
06/08/12 18:48:34 31SJA620 0235
Each time you press the DISP/MODE button while playing a CD(CD-DA), the center display changesfrom album name, to track name, toartist name, and then to normaldisplay. If the disc was not recordedwith CD-TEXT, ‘‘NO INFO’’ will beshown on the center display.
If the title is too long, it will not showall at once. Press and hold the DISP/MODE button, and the rest of thetitle will show on the center display.
When playing a CD compressed inMP3/WMA format, the displaychanges from folder name, to filename, to track tag, to artist tag, toalbum tag, and then to normaldisplay each time you press theDISP/MODE button. If the disc wasnot recorded with this information,‘‘NO INFO’’ will be shown on thecenter display.
You will also see the album and trackname (CD-TEXT), or the folder andfile name (MP3/WMA) under theseconditions:
When you insert a disc, and thesystem begins to play.
Each time a new track, file, orfolder plays.
CONTINUED
U.S. models except HawaiianName Display Function
Audio System
Features
231
06/08/12 18:48:41 31SJA620 0236
To play the tracks of the currentfolder in random order, use theinterface selector to scroll down,select FOLDER RANDOM with theinterface knob, and press ENTER onthe interface selector. As a reminder,you will see FOLDER RANDOMnext to the disc number on thescreen. To turn this feature off,highlight FOLDER RANDOM (if notalready highlighted), and pressENTER on the selector again.
To replay the current foldercontinuously, use the interfaceselector to scroll down, selectFOLDER REPEAT with theinterface knob, and press ENTER onthe interface selector. As a reminder,you will see FOLDER REPEAT nextto the disc number on the screen. Toturn this feature off, highlightFOLDER REPEAT (if not alreadyhighlighted), and press ENTER onthe selector again.
To enter the FOLDER LIST, pressENTER on the selector, select afolder by turning the interface knob,then press ENTER on the selector. Ifyou want to move to the parentfolder, push the selector up. If thereare no folder names, ‘‘No Title’’ isdisplayed. You will see the currentfolder highlighted.
Audio System
Folder Repeat (MP3/WMAMode)
Folder Random (MP3/WMAMode)
232
FOLDER RANDOM ICON
FOLDER RANDOM ICON
CURRENT FOLDER
FOLDER REPEAT ICON
FOLDER REPEAT ICON
06/08/12 18:48:51 31SJA620 0237
To remove a different disc from thechanger, first select it by pressingthe corresponding number on thepreset button or turning theinterface knob, and pressing ENTERon the interface selector. When thatdisc begins playing, press the ejectbutton.
To eject all discs, press and hold theeject button.
To eject one disc, press and releasethe eject button.
You can also eject discs when theignition switch is off:
When you press the eject buttonwhile listening to the radio, or withthe audio system turned off, the discthat was last selected is ejected.After that disc is ejected, pressingthe eject button again will eject thenext disc in numerical order. Bydoing this six times, you can removeall the discs from the changer.
To remove the disc that is currentlyplaying, press and release the eject( ) button. You will see‘‘EJECT’’ on the upper display. Whenyou remove the disc from the slot,the system begins the load sequenceso you can load another disc in thatposition. If you do not load anotherdisc within 10 seconds, the systemselects the previous mode [AM, FM1,FM2, or XM Radio (U.S. modelsexcept Hawaiian)].
If you do not remove the disc fromthe slot, the system will reload thedisc after 10 seconds and put thedisc changer in pause mode. Tobegin playing the disc, press theDISC/AUX button.
Removing Discs from theChanger
Audio System
Features
233
06/08/12 18:48:58 31SJA620 0238
When using CD-R or CD-RW discs,use only high quality discs labeledfor audio use.
When recording a CD-R orCD-RW, the recording must beclosed for it to be used by the discchanger.
When a disc is not being played,store it in its case to protect it fromdust and other contamination. Toprevent warpage, keep discs out ofdirect sunlight and extreme heat.
A new disc may be rough on theinner and outer edges. The smallplastic pieces causing this roughnesscan flake off and fall on therecording surface of the disc,causing skipping or other problems.Remove these pieces by rubbing theinner and outer edges with the sideof a pencil or pen.
Never try to insert foreign objects inthe disc changer.
Handle a disc by its edges; nevertouch either surface. Do not placestabilizer rings or labels on the disc.These, along with contaminationfrom finger prints, liquids, and felt-tip pens, can cause the disc to notplay properly, or possibly jam in thedrive.
To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth.Wipe across the disc from the centerto the outside edge.
Play only standard, round, 5-inch(12 cm) discs. Smaller or odd-shaped discs may jam in the driveor cause other problems.
Handle your discs properly toprevent damage and skipping.
General Information Protecting Discs
Protecting Your Discs
234
06/08/12 18:49:07 31SJA620 0239
Error Message Cause Solution
FOCUS Error
Mechanical Error
High Temperature
Press the disc eject button, and remove thedisc(s). Check for an error indication. Insertthe disc(s) again. If the code does not disappearor the disc(s) cannot be removed, consult yourdealer.Press the disc eject button, and remove thedisc(s). Check for an error indication. Insertthe disc(s) again. If the code does not disappearor the disc(s) cannot be removed, consult yourdealer.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.
The chart on the right explains theerror messages you may see in thedisplay while playing a disc.
If you see an error message in thedisplay while playing a disc, pressthe eject button. After ejecting thedisc, check it for damage ordeformation. If there is no damage,insert the disc again.
The audio system will try to play thedisc. If there is still a problem, theerror message will reappear. Pressthe eject button, and pull out the disc.
Insert a different disc. If the newdisc plays, there is a problem withthe first disc. If the error messagecycle repeats and you cannot clear it,take your vehicle to a dealer.
Disc Changer Error Messages
Features
235
06/08/12 18:49:15 31SJA620 0240
The auxiliary input jack is in theconsole compartment (see page
). The system will acceptauxiliary input from standard audioaccessories using a standard 1/8-inch miniplug.
Connect a compatible audio unit tothe jack, then select it by pressingDISC/AUX button.
When a compatible audio unit isselected, you will see ‘‘AUX’’ on thedisplay.
191
Auxiliary Input Jack
236
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
06/08/12 18:49:20 31SJA620 0241
▲ ▼
+
-
+ -
+
-
+ -
Three controls for the audio systemare mounted in the steering wheelhub. These let you control basicfunctions without removing yourhand from the wheel.
The VOL button adjusts the volumeup ( ) or down ( ). Press the topor bottom of the button, hold it untilthe desired volume is reached, thenrelease it.
The MODE button changes themode. Pressing the buttonrepeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM,XM Satellite Radio (U.S. modelsexcept Hawaiian), or a disc (if a discis loaded).
If you are listening to the radio, usethe CH button to change stations.Each time you press the top ( ) ofthe button, the system goes to thenext preset station on the band youare listening to. Press the bottom( ) to go back to the previousstation.
To activate the seek function, pressand hold the top ( ) or bottom ( )of the CH button until you hear abeep. The system searches up ordown from the current frequency tofind a station with a strong signal.
If you are playing a disc, the systemskips to the beginning of the nexttrack/file (in MP3/WMA mode)each time you press the top ( ) ofthe CH button. Press the bottom( ) to return to the beginning of thecurrent track/file. Press it again toreturn to the previous track/file.
To select a different disc (folder inMP3/WMA mode), press and holdthe top ( ) or bottom ( ) of theCH button until you hear a beep.
CONTINUED
Remote Audio Controls
Features
237
MODEBUTTON
CHBUTTON
VOLBUTTON
06/08/12 18:49:28 31SJA620 0242
+
-
+ -
If you are listening to XM SatelliteRadio, use the CH button to changechannels. Each time you press thetop ( ) of the button, the systemgoes to the next preset channel.Press the bottom ( ) to go back tothe previous preset channel.
To select a different channel of thecategory you are listening to, pressand hold the top ( ) or bottom ( )of the CH button until you hear abeep.
On U.S. models except Hawaiian
Remote Audio Controls
238
06/08/12 18:49:32 31SJA620 0243
Your vehicle’s audio system willdisable itself if it is disconnectedfrom electrical power for any reason.To make it work again, you mustenter a specific five-digit code withthe preset buttons. Because thereare hundreds of numbercombinations possible from the fivedigits, making the system workwithout knowing the exact code isnearly impossible.
You should have received a card thatlists your audio system code numberand serial number. It is best to storethis card in a safe place at home. Inaddition, you should write the audiosystem’s serial number in this owner’smanual.
If you lose the card, you must obtainthe code number from your dealer.To do this, you will need the audiosystem’s serial number.
If your vehicle’s battery is discon-nected or goes dead, or the radiofuse is removed, the audio systemwill disable itself. If this happens,you will see ‘‘ ’’ in the upperdisplay the next time you turn on thesystem. Use the preset buttons toenter the five-digit code. The code islocated on the radio code cardincluded in your owner’s manual kit.When it is entered correctly, theradio will start playing.
If you make a mistake entering thecode, do not start over; complete thefive-digit sequence, then enter thecorrect code. You have 10 tries toenter the correct code.
If the code card is lost, your dealercan access your code with yourradio’s serial number. To access theserial number, turn the radio on. Itmust display ‘‘ ’’, then turnthe radio off. Push and hold thepreset 1 and preset 6 buttons, then
push the power/volume knob. Theserial number will appear in two setsof four digits.
The system will retain your AM andFM presets even if power isdisconnected.
Radio Theft Protection
Features
239
06/08/12 18:49:39 31SJA620 0244
Press this button to display thescreen (see page ).
The compass system in your vehiclecontains several convenient features,including a direction and elevationfinder, a calendar reminder forimportant events, a calculator, and atrip computer to help you track yourmileage and fuel economy.
The controls for the compass systemare on the center console panel.These controls are also used tooperate the climate control system(see page ) and the audio system(see page ).
Press this button to display thescreen (see page ) for the
trip computer, calendar, calculator,and voice command Help.
198
246
245
208
Menu Button
Compass Button
Compass
System Controls
MainMenu
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
240
UPPERDISPLAY
SCREEN
MENUBUTTON
SET UPBUTTON
CANCELBUTTON
INTERFACEDIAL
COMPASSBUTTON
TRIPBUTTON
(Display mode)BUTTON
06/08/12 18:49:48 31SJA620 0245
Press this button to cancel thecurrent screen and return to theprevious screen.
This button switches the displaybetween day mode, night mode, andoff (see page ).
Press the button to display the set upscreen (see page ) to change andupdate information in the system.
Press this button to display thescreen (see page ).
Most functions of the compasssystem can be accessed with theinterface dial. The interface dial hastwo parts: a knob and a selector.
The knob turns left and right. Use itto make selections or adjustments toa list or menu on the screen.
The selector can be pushed left,right, up, down, and in. Use theselector to scroll through lists, to
select menus, and to highlight menuitems. When you make a selection,push the center of the selector in(ENTER) to go to that selection.
All selections and instructions aredisplayed on the screen.
In almost all cases, you can enter aselection into the system by pushingin on the interface selector.
Clean the screen with a soft dampcloth. You may use a mild cleanserintended for use on liquid crystaldisplays (LCDs). Harsher chemicalsmay damage the screen.
Shows the radio band, frequency,volume, the climate control status,and the time.
247
256
252
Interface Dial
Cancel Button
(Display Mode) Button
Set Up Button
Trip Button
Screen
Upper Display
TripComputer
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
241
KNOB
ENTER
SELECTOR
06/08/12 18:50:03 31SJA620 0246
Please read the disclaimer carefullybefore you continue. To go to thecompass screen, select OK bypushing in the interface selector.
The first screen to appear is thecompass system globe screen. Thescreen then changes to thedisclaimer screen:
The button does not appearimmediately. It appears after thesystem is loaded. The OKcommand cannot be activated byvoice.
Throughout the compass systemsection, the icon ‘‘ ’’ is used toindicate features that are dependenton the ‘‘Driver number’’ as displayedon the multi-information display‘‘Welcome’’ display.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the compasssystem to boots up within a fewseconds.
System Start-up
OK
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
242
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:50:12 31SJA620 0247
If you select , the reminder willnot show up again. If you wish tohave the reminder show up againlater in the day, select
and push in on the interfaceselector.
If you press the CANCEL button, themessage will be displayed the nexttime you start the vehicle.
The system will display thecurrent message and any older orpreviously unread messages, withthe newest message listed first.
If you do not push in on the, the screen will
go dark after 30 seconds. To returnto the disclaimer screen, press anycompass or voice control button.
If you do not select , andthen enter the Set up or Tripcomputer screens, some items arenot available, and will show up asdarkened buttons (grayed out).
If any calendar reminders werepreviously entered, the calendarreminder screen is displayed next.
The calendar reminder screenremains displayed until you select
, or press theCANCEL button.
OK
RemindLater
interface selector
OK
OK Remind Later
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
243
NOTE:
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:50:19 31SJA620 0248
The vehicle ‘‘senses’’ the drivernumber, based on which keylessremote is used to unlock the vehicle.If two drivers with remotes approachthe vehicle at the same time, thewelcome display and related settingsare based on which remote thevehicle sensed first ‘‘senses.’’
If both remotes come withinrange simultaneously, the‘‘Welcome’’ display may beunpredictable.
The compass system uses the drivernumber (as recognized by the multi-information display) to personalizethe compass system. For example, ifDriver 1 unlocks the vehicle, the‘‘Driver 1’’ personal address bookand other navigation settings areautomatically loaded when thevehicle is started. There is no way tochange from one driver’s settings toanother while driving.
For information on ‘‘linking’’ and‘‘unlinking’’ the keyless accessremotes, see page .
When the keyless access remote isdeliberately ‘‘unlinked,’’ (as whengiving the key to a valet) the multi-information display will display‘‘Welcome.’’ Then the followingoccurs:
The calendar feature is notselectable (buttons grayed out).
Setup values (like volume,brightness, etc.) can be changedbut are not remembered the nexttime you restart the vehicle.
170
Keyless Memory Settings
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
244
NOTE:
TM
06/08/12 18:50:26 31SJA620 0249
You can see the current latitude,longitude, and elevation at any timewhen you press the COMPASSbutton or say ‘‘Display map guide.’’The date and time is also displayed.
If the battery is disconnectedor the fuse for the compass systemis removed, the system may requireGPS initialization (see page ).
If the system does not receive theelevation information, the displayshows only current latitude andlongitude.
If the GPS reception is low, thedisplay shows a ‘‘Low GPSreception’’ message.
258
The Compass Screen
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
245
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:50:33 31SJA620 0250
The voice command help screendisplays several topics that help youto understand your vehicle’s voicecontrol system. To go to the voicecommand help screen, say or select‘‘Voice command help.’’ Then selecta topic by saying either the topicname or its line number.
To use the voice command tutorial,say or select ‘‘Getting started.’’ Thedisplay changes to the Gettingstarted screen.
When you say ‘‘Display menu’’ orpress the MENU button, the displaychanges to the screen.To select a menu item, turn theinterface knob to highlight the item,then press the interface selector.
If some items appear grayedout and cannot be selected, thevehicle does not sense the driver’sID of the remote (see page ).
Select the line number of the tutorialyou want to view, and the tutorial willautomatically be read out. To stopthe system from reading the tutorial,move the interface knob to the right.
170
Main Menu
Main menu
Voice Command Help
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
246
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:50:42 31SJA620 0251
When you make a selection (such asNavigation general command help),you will see the help commands thatcan be used with the voice control.To have the system read the list, say‘‘Read list,’’ or select bymoving the interface selector to theright, and the system will read thelist to you.
The screens displaythe trip information from the multi-information display in the gaugeassembly.
For a listing of all voice commands,see on page
.
To go to the trip computer, say ‘‘TripComputer,’’ select Trip computerfrom the main menu, or press theTRIP button on the center consolepanel.
266
CONTINUED
Voice Command IndexTrip Computer
trip computer
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
247
06/08/12 18:50:50 31SJA620 0252
The calendar feature allows you toenter events and be reminded ofthem in the future.When you say ‘‘Calendar’’ or selectthe on thescreen, the display changes to the
screen.
Dates with an icon indicate there is aschedule entry for that date.
Shows the estimated distance youcan travel on the fuel remaining inthe tank. This distance is estimatedfrom the average fuel economy overthe last several miles, so it will varywith changes in speed, traffic, etc
The average fuel, average speed, andelapsed time meters can be resetautomatically.
The ‘‘Range’’ value is approximate,and may vary from actual range.
The ‘‘Average Fuel’’ and ‘‘MPG’’may vary from actual fuelconsumed. These values areestimates only.
Shows the instantaneous fueleconomy in miles per gallon.
Shows you the current fuel economyin miles per gallon.
Shows you the average fuel economyin miles per gallon since the displaywas last reset.
Shows the elapsed time that theignition has been on since the displaywas last reset.
Shows you the average speed inmiles per hour since the display waslast reset.
RangeMPG
Instant Fuel
Average Fuel
Elapsed Time
Average Speed
Calendar
Resetting the Display
Calendar Main Menu
calendar
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
248
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:51:06 31SJA620 0253
You can scroll through the calendarday by day by turning the interfaceknob, or select the day by voice.When you push the interfaceselector up or down, you can alsoscroll through the calendar week byweek. When you say ‘‘Next month’’or ‘‘Previous month,’’ or when youpush the interface selector to theright or left, the system displays thenext or previous month.
Set your schedule by selecting theday on the calendar, and the displaychanges to thescreen.
The default for the reminder is .This allows the system to remindyou of the calendar item the nexttime you start the vehicle. See
on page .
Say or select ‘‘ ,’’ then enterthe name of your title using theinterface selector. Once you enterthe title, say or select ‘‘ .’’ Thetitle will be displayed on thespecified date of the Calendar screen.
Say or select ‘‘ ,’’ andthe system will show the EnterMessage screen. You can enter amessage on two lines. Use tochange the line. Once you haveentered the message, say or select‘‘Done.’’ The message will bedisplayed on the specified date of thecalendar screen.
242
Reminder
System Start-up
Title
Message
CONTINUED
Entering Your Schedule
Edit schedule
ON
Edit title
Done
Edit message
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
249
06/08/12 18:51:15 31SJA620 0254
Message Icon
Delete
Done
Say or select ‘‘ ,’’ andthe system displays a list of iconsyou can select to help identify thetype of message you entered. Themessage icon you choose will bedisplayed alongside the specifieddate on the calendar screen.
From the screen, selectthe date of the schedule you wish toremove. To remove the schedule,say or select ‘‘ .’’
Once you have finished entering theschedule, say or select ‘‘ .’’ The
screen is redisplayed and acategory icon appears.
You can only enter one messageper day.To re-activate a previous message,turn the reminder setting from
to . If it is not turned on,the reminder will not be displayedwhen you start vehicle.For more information, refer toSystem Start-up on page .
This allows you to move yourcalendar entry to a different date. Ifyou say or select ‘‘ ,’’ the
screen is displayed withexisting entries grayed out. Select anew day and thescreen is redisplayed with the newdate.
242
Message icon
calendar
Delete
Donecalendar
OFF ON
Edit datecalendar
edit schedule
Edit Date
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
250
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:51:25 31SJA620 0255
When you say or select ‘‘Calculator,’’the display changes to the
screen.
Enter the digits and operationsymbols with the interface selector.
Use the interface selector to controlthe calculator, and calculator‘‘conversion’’ feature.To convert a unit of measurement,do this:
Enter a numeric value to beconverted (for example, 100).
Push the interface selector downto select Unit conversion. Thescreen above appears.
Turn the interface knob until theconversion you want is highlighted(weight, for example), then pushthe selector in to select it. Thescreen for that conversion typeappears (see illustration in step 4).
1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
Calculator Convert
Calculator
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
251
06/08/12 18:51:34 31SJA620 0256
Turn the interface knob until theunit you want to convert from ishighlighted (kilogram, forexample), then push the selectorin to select it as it the exampleabove.
The set-up functions consist of threedifferent screens that allow you tochange and update information inthe system. To display the
, say ‘‘Set up’’ or press theSET UP button, and then select anitem. To select more setup items, say‘‘More,’’ or select MORE at the topright corner of the screen.
The first setup screen allows you tochange the system’s brightness,contrast, black level, volume, andinterface dial feedback. To select asetup item, turn the interface knobuntil it is highlighted, then push theinterface selector in to select it.
4.
System Set-up
set upscreen
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
First Set up Screen
252
06/08/12 18:51:41 31SJA620 0257
-
-
CONTINUED
Brightness Black Level Volume
If you are having trouble viewingthe screen in bright lighting conditions,try increasing the brightness.
Contrast
There are 11 possible brightnesssettings. To change the brightness,say ‘‘Brightness up’’ or ‘‘Brightnessdown.’’ You can also select
and change the settingby turning the interface knob.
There are 11 possible black levelsettings. To change the black level,say ‘‘Black level up’’ or ‘‘Black leveldown’’ You can also select
and change the setting byturning the Interface knob. Changesto the display are very subtle thisis normal.
Say ‘‘Volume up’’ or ‘‘Volume down.’’
There are 11 possible contrastsettings. To adjust the contrast, say‘‘Contrast up’’ or ‘‘Contrast down.’’You can also select andchange the setting by turning theinterface knob. Changes to thedisplay are very subtle this isnormal.
You can have separatedaytime and nighttime settings forbrightness, contrast, and black level.Adjust each setting when the displayis in either daytime or nighttimemode. Use the Display mode button(see page ) to select daytime ornighttime mode.
To adjust the volume of the systemvoice, do one of these actions:
Select volume off.
If you turn the volume off,you will not hear voice commandconfirmations.
Select , then change thesetting by turning the interfaceknob.
241
BrightnessBlack
Level
Contrast
Volume
Tip:
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
253
NOTE:
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:51:53 31SJA620 0258
Interface Dial Feedback
On
Auto(default)
No
The system alwaysreads what you select.
The system reads yourselection only whilethe vehicle is moving.
The system does notread your selection.
Changing this setting allows you tocontrol when (and if) the system willread the current selection youchoose with the interface dial. Thisfeature can minimize the need tolook at the screen while operatingthe dial. The three settings areexplained in the following table. Thefactory default setting is .
The second setup screen allows youto change the system’s voicerecognition feedback, voice gender,and clock settings. To select a setupitem, turn the interface knob until itis highlighted, then push theinterface selector in to select it.
To view the second setup screen, say‘‘More,’’ or move the interfaceselector to the right to select MORE.To go back to the first setup screen,
say ‘‘Backward,’’ or move theinterface selector to the left to selectBACK.
AUTO
Setting
Second Set up Screen
Feedback Level
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
254
06/08/12 18:52:01 31SJA620 0259
CONTINUED
ColorVoice Recognition Feedback
Voice
Clock Adjustment
To view the Select a color screen,say ‘‘Color,’’ or select COLOR on thescreen. You can choose from one offive colors for the day and nightdisplay modes.
The third setup screen allows you tochange the system’s screen colorand verbal reminders. To select asetup item, turn the interface knobuntil it is highlighted, then push theinterface selector in to select it.
To view the third setup screen, movethe interface selector down. Toreturn to the first setup screen, say‘‘Backward,’’ or move the interfaceselector to the left to select BACK.
Allows you to turn voice controlsystem prompts or . Toselect ON or OFF, turn the interfaceknob to the right or left, then pressthe interface selector. When ,you will not hear the voice controlsystem confirmations or prompts.
Allows you to select the guidancevoice: or . Toselect MALE or FEMALE, turn theinterface knob to the right or left,then press the interface selector.
You can adjust the clock of yoursystem. When the battery isdisconnected or the fuse for thecompass system is removed, youneed to reset the time. See page
for more information on settingthe clock.272
Third Set up Screen
ON OFF
OFF
MALE FEMALE
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
255
06/08/12 18:52:13 31SJA620 0260
Pressing the () button allows you to switch
display modes.
Each time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ACCESSORY (I)position, the display mode is in auto.The screen changes between dayand night modes when you turn theheadlights on and off.
To override the auto mode, selecteither day or night mode. This canbe useful if you want to use theheadlights during the day. Be awarethat using day mode at night willmake the screen extremely bright.
This function allows you to turnor verbal reminders. Examplesof these reminders include:
Driving with the parking brake on
Driving with the trunk or a dooropen
A reminder to fasten the driver’sand front passenger’s seat belts
To select ON or OFF, turn theinterface knob to the right or left,then press the interface selector.
To change the color, select Day ornight by turning the interface knobto the right or left. Press theinterface selector, then turn theinterface knob to select desired color.Press the interface selector to enteryour choice.
Choose silver metal (factorydefault) as the color to obtainthe best display contrast.Choose black metal (factorydefault) as the color toobtain the best display contrast.
Verbal Reminder Setting Display ModeDisplay
modeON
OFF
Day
Night
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
256
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:52:24 31SJA620 0261
CONTINUED
Enter the four-digit compass systemsecurity code. If you have entered itcorrectly, the display changes to the
. You have tenchances to enter the correct code. Ifall ten are incorrect, turn the ignitionto OFF, then back to ON (II) to haveten more chances to enter thecorrect code.
When you purchased the vehicle,you should have received two cardsthat have the audio and compasssystem’s security codes and serialnumbers. Keep these cards in a safe
place in case you need the codes. Ifyou lose the cards, you must obtainthe security codes from your dealer.
If the battery goes dead or isdisconnected for any reason, you willhave to enter a security code intoboth the audio system and thecompass system before you can useit again.
To enter the code, turn the interfaceknob to select the number, thenpress the interface selector to enterit. Keep doing the same procedure toenter all four correct numbers. If youneed to delete the number youentered mistakenly, move theinterface selector to the right.
If for any reason, you lose power tothe compass system (the battery wasdisconnected), the system needs tobe initialized before you can use it.
Initialization requires this:
Entry of the compass system 4-digit security code to ‘‘unlock’’ thesystem.
GPS initialization. This may not beneeded depending on how long thesystem was without power.
Disclaimer screen
System Initialization Entering the Security Code
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
257
06/08/12 18:52:33 31SJA620 0262
If this procedure is not necessary thesystem proceeds directly to the
(see page ).During initialization, the systemsearches for all available GPSsatellites, and obtains their orbitalinformation. During this procedurethe vehicle should be out in the openwith a clear view of the sky.
Depending on the length of time thebattery was disconnected, yoursystem may require GPSinitialization. If it does, the abovescreen appears. Follow theinstructions on the screen.
Follow the instructions in the audiosystem section to enter the 5-digitaudio code (see page ). Thesystem voice will not operate if theaudio code is not entered
245239 Compass screen
GPS initialization
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
258
06/08/12 18:52:39 31SJA620 0263
CONTINUED
If within ten minutes the system failsto locate a sufficient number ofsatellites to locate your position, thescreen above appears. Follow theinstructions on the screen.
You have acquired a device(‘‘DEVICE’’) that includes softwarelicensed by ALPINE ELECTRONICS,INC., from an affiliate of MicrosoftCorporation (collectively ‘‘MS’’).Those installed software products ofMS origin, as well as associatedmedia, printed materials, and‘‘online’’ or electronic documentation(‘‘SOFTWARE’’) are protected byinternational intellectual propertylaws and treaties. The SOFTWAREis licensed, not sold. All rightsreserved.
After 30 minutes with this screendisplayed, turn off the engine andrestart the vehicle. If you now seethe , the GPSinitialization is complete.
The average acquiring time is lessthan 10 minutes, but it can take aslong as 45 minutes.If the system is still unable toacquire a signal, follow theinstructions on the screen, orcontact your local dealer forassistance.
License notice
Disclaimer screen
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
259
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:52:46 31SJA620 0264
NO WARRANTIES FOR THESOFTWARE. THE SOFTWARE isprovided ‘‘AS IS’’ and with all faults.THE ENTIRE RISK AS TOSATISFACTORY QUALITY,PERFORMANCE, ACCURACY,AND EFFORT (INCLUDING LACKOF NEGLIGENCE) IS WITH YOU.ALSO, THERE IS NO WARRANTYAGAINST INTERFERENCE WITHYOUR ENJOYMENT OF THESOFTWARE OR ATGAINSTINFRINGEMENT. IF YOU HAVERECEIVED ANY WARRANTIESREGARDING THE DEVICE ORTHE SOFTWARE, THOSEWARRANTIES DO NOTORIGINATE FROM, AND ARENOT BINDING ON, MS.
This EULA grants youthe following license;
You may use the SOFTWARE onlyon the DEVICE.
NOT FAULT TOLERANT. THESOFTWARE IS NOT FAULTTOLERANT. ALPINEELECTRONICS, INC., HASINDEPENDENTLY DETERMINEDHOW TO USE THE SOFTWARE INTHE DEVICE, AND MS HASRELIED UPON ALPINEELECTRONICS, INC., TOCONDUCT SUFFICIENT TESTINGTO DETERMINE THAT THESOFTWARE IS SUITABLE FORSUCH USE.
IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THISEND USER LICENSEAGREEMENT (‘‘EULA’’), DO NOTUSE THE DEVICE OR COPY THESOFTWARE. INSTEAD,PROMPTLY CONTACT ALPINEELECTRONICS, INC., FORINSTRUCTIONS ON RETURN OFTHE UNUSED DEVICE(S) FOR AREFUND. ANY USE OF THESOFTWARE, INCLUDING BUTNOT LIMITED TO USE ON THEDEVICE, WILL CONSTITUTEYOUR AGREEMENT TO THISEULA (OR RATIFICATION OFANY PREVIOUS CONSENT).
GRANT OF SOFTWARELICENSE.
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
260
06/08/12 18:52:52 31SJA620 0265
CONTINUED
If ALPINE ELECTRONICS, INC.,provides or makes available to youSupplemental Components and noother EULA terms are providedalong with the SupplementalComponents, then the terms ofthis EULA shall apply.
If MS, Microsoft Corporation ortheir affiliates make availableSupplemental Components, and noother EULA terms are provided,then the terms of this EULA shallapply, except that the MS,Microsoft Corporation or affiliateentity providing the SupplementalComponent(s) shall be thelicensor of the SupplementalComponent(s).
Limitations, on Reverse Engineering,Decompilation, and Disassembly.You may not reverse engineer,decompile, or disassemble theSOFTWARE, except and only to theextent that such activity is expresslypermitted by applicable law not withstanding this limitation.
Additional Software/Services. TheSOFTWARE may permit ALPINEELECTRONICS, INC.,, MS,Microsoft Corporation or theiraffiliates to provide or makeavailable to you SOFTWAREupdates, supplements, add-oncomponents, or Internet- basedservices components of theSOFTWARE after the date youobtain your initial copy of theSOFTWARE (‘‘SupplementalComponents’’).
No Liability for Certain Damages,EXCEPT AS PROHIBITED BY LAW,MS SHALL HAVE NO LIABILITYFOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL,CONSEQUENTIAL ORINCIDENTAL DAMAGES ARISINGFROM OR IN CONNECTIONWITH THE USE ORPERFORMANCE OF THESOFTWARE. THIS LIMITATIONSHALL APPLY EVEN IF ANYREMEDY FAILS OF ITSESSENTIAL PURPOSE. IN NOEVENT SHALL MS BE LIABLEFOR ANY AMOUNT IN EXCESSOF U.S.TWO HUNDRED FIFTYDOLLARS (U.S.$250.00).
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
261
06/08/12 18:52:58 31SJA620 0266
Youacknowledge that SOFTWARE is ofUS-origin. You agree to comply withall applicable international andnational laws that apply to theSOFTWARE, including the U.S.Export Administration Regulations,as well as end-user, end-use andcountry destination restrictionsissued by U.S. and othergovernments.For additional information onexporting the SOFTWARE, see http://www.microsoft.com/exporting/.
You maypermanently transfer rights underthis EULA only as part of apermanent sale or transfer of theDevice, and only is the recipientagrees to this EULA. If theSOFTWARE is an upgrade, anytransfer must also include all priorversions of the SOFTWARE.
ALPINE ELECTRONICS, INC.,, MS,Microsoft Corporation and theiraffiliates reserve the right todiscontinue any Internet-basedservices provided to you or madeavailable to you through the use ofthe SOFTWARE.
IfSOFTWARE is provided by ALPINEELECTRONICS, INC., on separatemedia and labeled ‘‘Recovery Media’’you may use the Recovery Mediasolely to restore or reinstall theSOFTWARE originally installed onthe DEVICE.
EXPORT RESTRITIONS.SOFTWARE TRANSFERALLOWED BUT WITHRESTRICTIONS.
RECOVERY MEDIA.
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
262
06/08/12 18:53:03 31SJA620 0267
This button activates the voicecontrol system. Press it when youwant to give a voice command. See
on page fora list of voice commands.
This button has the same function asthe CANCEL button on the centerconsole (see page ). When youpress it, the display returns to theprevious screen. When the previousscreen appears, the system replaysthe last prompt. This button can beused to cancel an audio, climatecontrol, or compass system voicecommand up to one second after thecommand confirmation.
For models with navigationsystem, refer to the navigationsystem manual.
Your vehicle has a voice controlsystem that allows hands-freeoperation of the audio system, theclimate control system and somefunctions of the compass system.The voice control system uses theTALK and BACK buttons on thesteering wheel and a microphone
near the map light on the ceiling.
While using the voice controlsystem, all of the speakers aremuted.
241
266Voice Command Index
Voice Control Basics Talk Button
Back Button
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
263
NOTE:
NOTE:
TALK BUTTON
BACK BUTTONMICROPHONE(on the ceiling)
06/08/12 18:53:12 31SJA620 0268
Most of the system’s functions canbe controlled by voice commandsactivated with the button. Tocontrol your compass system byvoice:
Press and release the button.Wait for the beep.Give a voice command.
You should use the voice controlsystem as much as possible, andconsider manual entry using the
as a ‘‘back-up’’method of entry.
If the system does not understand acommand or you wait too long togive a command, it responds with‘‘Pardon,’’ ‘‘Please repeat,’’ or ‘‘Wouldyou say again.’’ If the system cannotperform a command or thecommand is not appropriate for thescreen you are on, it sounds a beep.
Anytime you are not sure of whatvoice commands are available on ascreen, you can always say ‘‘Help’’ atany screen. The system can thenread the list of commands to you.
When you speak a command, thesystem generally either repeats thecommand as a confirmation or asksyou for further information. If you donot wish to hear this feedback, youcan turn it off. See the
setting inSetup.
If you hear a prompt such as ‘‘Pleaseuse the interface dial to...’’ or ‘‘Pleasechoose an area with the interfacedial.’’ the system is asking for inputthat cannot be done by voice.
Once the microphone picks up yourcommand, the system changes thedisplay in response to the commandand prompts you for the nextcommand. Using the button,answer the prompts as required.
Using the Voice Control System
Talk
Talk
interface dialVoice
Recognition Feedback
Talk
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
264
06/08/12 18:53:18 31SJA620 0269
To achieve optimum voicerecognition, the following guidelinesshould be followed:
Make sure the correct screenis displayed for the voice commandthat you are using. See VoiceCommand Index on page .
Close the windows and themoonroof.
The fan speed will beautomatically adjusted to low.
If the system cannot recognizeyour command because ofbackground noise, speak louder.
If the microphone picks up voicesother than yours, the system maynot interpret your voicecommands correctly.
If you speak a command withsomething in your mouth, or yourvoice is either too high or toohusky, the system maymisinterpret your voice commands.
If you are still having trouble withthe voice control system, refer to
on themain menu screen.
Make sure the airflow from theA/C vents does not interfere withthe system microphone in theceiling console. Place your handover the microphone; if you feelany airflow, adjust the vents.
After pressing the button,wait for the beep, then give a voicecommand.
Give a voice command in a clear,natural speaking voice withoutpausing between words.
266
Improving Voice Recognition
Voice Command Help
Talk
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
265
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:53:28 31SJA620 0270
*
*
*
The voice control system needsappropriate voice commands forcontrolling the climate control, theaudio system, and the compasssystem.
The system accepts thesecommands on any screen.
(reads list of the commandsfor the displayed screen)
(displays set up screen)(displays the
compass screen)(displays the main
menu)(displays the
screen)
(to previous screen,same as CANCEL or BACKbutton)
(cancels current activity)
The system accepts these climatecontrol commands on most screens.
The voice command help option onthe main menu lists many of thefollowing controls. To avoiddistraction while you are driving, thesystem can read the commands foryou.
The commands are accessible at anytime while driving and can be read toyou so that you do not need tomemorize all of them.
(controlstemperature to 72 degrees F)
(controlstemperature to your selection)
Help
Set upDisplay map guide
Display menu
Information tripcomputerTrip ComputerBackward
CancelWhat time is it?Calendar
CalculatorRepeat voiceVoice command help
Climate control full automatic
Climate control automatic
Climate control offAir conditioner onAir conditioner offAir conditionerClimate control defrost onClimate control defrost offClimate control defrostRear defrost onRear defrost offRear defrost
Voice Command Index
Global Commands
Climate Control Commands
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
266
06/08/12 18:53:36 31SJA620 0271
#
#
#
#
#
#
#
# -
**
*Temperature Commands
Temperature degrees
Temperature upTemperature downTemperature max hotTemperature max cold
Temperature balanceTemperature dual mode onTemperature dual mode offTemperature dual modeDrive temperature degrees
Passenger temperature degrees
Drive vent temperature adjustmentPassenger vent temperatureadjustmentVent temperature upVent temperature downVent temperature maxVent temperature minimumVent temperature normal
Climate control fresh airClimate control recirculateClimate control ventClimate control bi-level
Climate control floorClimate control floor and defrostFan speed upFan speed downFan speed
The system accepts thesecommands on most screens.
Repeating these commandsswitches (toggles) the functionbetween On and Off.
( : 57 to87 degrees F)
(displays HI)(displays
LO)
( : 57to 87 degrees F)
( : 57 to 87 degrees F)
Repeating these commandsswitches (toggles) the functionbetween On and Off.
The commands for venttemperature settings are available onthe climate control screen.
(vent andfloor)
( : 1 7) (for bestvoice control, keep fan speed at 1 or2)
CONTINUED
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
267
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:53:43 31SJA620 0272
### #
#
#
##
###
# -# -
# -# -
#
#
# -# -
# -# -# -
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
The system accepts these audiosystem commands on most screens.
The system accepts thesecommands on most screens.
( : 1 6)( : 1 30)
( 1: 1 6,2: 1 30)
(resumes ‘‘Play’’from these commands: ‘‘CD trackrandom,’’ ‘‘CD track repeat,’’ and‘‘CD disc repeat’’)
To control the radio system, say oneof the following commands:
(or )
( : frequency.Example
( : frequency.Example
(same as Radio)
( : 1 6)( : 1 6)
( : 1 6)( : 1 6)
( : 1 6)
Repeating these commandsswitches (toggles) the functionbetween On and Off.
CD playCD play discCD play trackCD play disc 1 track 2
CD skip forwardCD skip backCD play next discCD play previous discCD track randomCD track repeatCD disc repeatCD track scanCD disk scanCD normal play
CD track listCD folder randomCD folder repeatCD folder scanCD folder list
Audio onAudio offAudioRadio on Radio playRadio offRadioRadio select FM1Radio select FM2Radio select AMRadio FM
Radio 95.5 FM)Radio AM
Radio 1020 AM)Radio seek upRadio seek downRadio next stationseekRadio presetRadio FM preset
Radio FM1 presetRadio FM2 presetRadio AM presetRadio auto selectRadio scan
CD Commands
Radio Commands
Audio System Commands
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
268
06/08/22 16:12:39 31SJA620 0273
### #
# -# -
#- # -
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
CONTINUED
The system accepts thesecommands on most screens.
( : 1 6)( : 1 30)
( 1:1 6, 2: 1 30)
(resumes ‘‘Play’’from these commands: ‘‘DVDtrack random,’’ ‘‘DVD track repeat,’’‘‘DVD disc repeat,’’ ‘‘DVD folderrandom,’’ and ‘‘DVD folderrepeat’’)
Repeating these commandsswitches (toggles) the functionbetween On and Off. Repeating these commands
switches (toggles) the functionbetween On and Off.
DVD playDVD play discDVD play trackDVD play disc 1 track 2
DVD skip forwardDVD skip backDVD play next discDVD play previous discDVD track randomDVD track repeatDVD disc repeatDVD track scanDVD disc scanDVD normal play
DVD track listDVD folder randomDVD folder repeat
DVD folder listDVD Commands
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
269
06/08/22 16:12:45 31SJA620 0274
### #
### ## -
# -#
- # -
# -# -
#- # -
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
The system accepts thesecommands on most screens.
Repeating these commandsswitches (toggles) the functionbetween On and Off.
These are additional commands notfound on the
screen. Follow the voiceprompts.
( : 1 6)( : 1 30)
( 1:1 6, 2: 1 30)
(resumes ‘‘Play’’from these commands: ‘‘MP3track random,’’ ‘‘MP3 track repeat,’’‘‘MP3 disc repeat,’’ ‘‘MP3 folderrandom,’’ and ‘‘MP3 folderrepeat’’)
( : 1 6)( : 1 30)
( 1:1 6, 2: 1 30)
(resumes ‘‘Play’’from these commands: ‘‘WMAtrack random,’’ ‘‘WMA trackrepeat,’’ ‘‘WMA disc repeat,’’‘‘WMA folder random,’’ and‘‘WMA folder repeat’’)
(the systemreads and lists all of thecommands)
MP3 playMP3 play discMP3 play trackMP3 play disc 1 track 2
MP3 skip forwardMP3 skip backMP3 play next discMP3 play previous discMP3 track randomMP3 track repeatMP3 disc repeatMP3 track scanMP3 disc scanMP3 normal play
MP3 track listMP3 folder randomMP3 folder repeat
MP3 folder listWMA playWMA play discWMA play trackWMA play disc 1 track 2
WMA skip forwardWMA skip backWMA play next discWMA play previous discWMA track randomWMA track repeatWMA disc repeatWMA track scanWMA disc scanWMA normal play
WMA track listWMA folder randomWMA folder repeatWMA folder list
MP3/WMA Commands
Voice command help
CalendarCalculatorTrip computer
Main Menu Screen Commands
Voice CommandsHelp
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
270
06/08/22 16:12:50 31SJA620 0275
The system accepts thesecommands on the first setup screen.(For the second and third setupscreens, simply say what is writtenon the screen, and follow the voiceprompts)
The system accepts over 100 on-screen commands. The onlycommands that must be chosen bythe interface dial are listed below.
Brightness upBrightness downBrightness minimum/min.Brightness maximum/max.Contrast upContrast downContrast minimum/minContrast maximum/maxBlack level upBlack level downBlack level minimum/minBlack level maximum/maxVolume upVolume downVolume minimum/min.Volume maximum/max.Volume OffInterface Dial feedback offInterface Dial feedback auto
Interface Dial feedback on
NextPreviousReturnOKDelete
Set up Screen Commands
On-Screen Commands
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
271
06/08/12 18:54:08 31SJA620 0276
To set the clock, the ignition switchmust be in the Accessory (I) or ON(II) position.
Say ‘‘Set up’’ or press the SET UPbutton on the center console todisplay the Set up screen. Thenmove the interface dial to the right.
Select the byturning the interface knob to theright, then press the center of theinterface selector.
Select the , thenpress the center of the interfaceselector. The display changes to the
screen for HOUR.
Setting the Clock
Clock Adjustment Time Adjustment
Time Adjustment
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
272
06/08/12 18:54:16 31SJA620 0277
To adjust the minute, turn theinterface knob to the right to displaythe adjustment screen for MINUTE.
Press the center of the interfaceselector to enter the time. Thescreen will return to the
screen (see page ).
Turn the interface knob to adjust theminute.
To adjust the hour, turn the interfaceknob, then press the center of theinterface selector.
272Clock
adjustment
Compass System (U.S. model without navigation system)
Features
273
06/08/12 18:54:22 31SJA620 0278
The security system will not set ifthe hood, trunk, or any door is notfully closed. If the system will not set,check the Door and Trunk Openmonitor on the instrument panel (seepage ) to see if the doors andtrunk are fully closed. Since it is notpart of the monitor display, manuallycheck the hood.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it.
The security system helps to protectyour vehicle and valuables from theft.The horn sounds and a combinationof headlights, parking/side markerlights, and taillights flash if someoneattempts to break into your vehicleor remove the radio. This alarmcontinues for 2 minutes, then thesystem resets. To reset an alarmingsystem before the 2 minutes haveelapsed, unlock either front doorwith the remote or the built-in key.
With the system set, you can stillopen the trunk with the remotewithout triggering the alarm. Thealarm will sound if the trunk lock isforced, or the trunk is opened withthe trunk release button on thedriver’s door or the emergency trunkopener.
Once the security system is set,opening any door or the hoodwithout using the built-in key or theremote will cause it to sound. It alsosounds if the radio is removed fromthe dashboard or the audio systemwiring is cut.
The security system automaticallysets 15 seconds after you lock thedoors, close the hood, and close thetrunk. For the system to activate,you must lock the doors from theoutside with the remote, built-in key,lock tab, or door lock switch. Thesecurity system indicator on theinstrument panel starts blinkingimmediately to show you the systemis setting itself.
13
Security System
274
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
06/08/12 18:54:28 31SJA620 0279
Cruise control allows you to maintaina set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)without keeping your foot on theaccelerator pedal. It should be usedfor cruising on straight, openhighways. It is not recommended forcity driving, winding roads, slipperyroads, heavy rain, or bad weather.
Push in the CRUISE button or theACC button (models with adaptivecruise control) on the steeringwheel. The CRUISE MAIN orgreen ACC indicator (models withACC) indicator on the instrumentpanel comes on.
To switch from ACC to cruisecontrol, press the distance button
on the steering wheel, and hold itfor 1 second (see page ).
Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed above 25 mph (40 km/h).
Press and release the SET/DECEL button on the steeringwheel. The CRUISE CONTROLicon appears on the multi-information display to show thesystem is now activated.
When cruise control is on whiledriving, the SH-AWD torquedistribution monitor and the tirepressure monitor are not shownon the multi-information display.
1.
2.
3.
292
CONTINUED
On models with adaptive cruisecontrol
Using Cruise Control
Cruise Control
Features
275
RES/ACCELBUTTON
CRUISE (ACC) BUTTON
SET/DECELBUTTON
Non-ACC model is shown
Improper use of the cruisecontrol can lead to a crash.
Use the cruise control onlywhen traveling on openhighways in good weather.
06/08/12 18:54:37 31SJA620 0280
You can increase the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
You can decrease the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
Press and hold the RES/ACCELbutton. When you reach thedesired cruising speed, release thebutton.
Push on the accelerator pedal.Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed, then press the SET/DECEL button.
Press and hold the SET/DECELbutton. Release the button whenyou reach the desired speed.
To increase your speed in verysmall amounts, tap the RES/ACCEL button. Each time you dothis, the vehicle speeds up about 1mph (1.6 km/h).
Cruise control may not hold the setspeed when you are going up anddown hills. If your speed increasesgoing down a hill, use the brakes toslow down. This cancels cruisecontrol. On models with adaptivecruise control (ACC), this alsocauses the cruise control icon on themulti-information display to go offand the cruise mode icon to come on.To resume the set speed, press theRES/ACCEL button. The CRUISECONTROL icon on the multi-information display will come backon.
When climbing a steep hill, theautomatic transmission maydownshift to hold the set speed.
To slow down in very smallamounts, tap the SET/DECELbutton. Each time you do this,your vehicle will slow down about1 mph (1.6 km/h).
Tap the brake pedal lightly withyour foot. The CRUISECONTROL indicator or ACCindicator on the instrument paneland the CRUISE CONTROL iconon the multi-information displaywill go out. When the vehicleslows to the desired speed, pressthe SET/DECEL button.
Changing the Set Speed
Cruise Control
276
06/08/12 18:54:46 31SJA620 0281
Tap the brake pedal.
Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.
Resting your foot on the brake pedalcauses cruise control to cancel.
Even with cruise control on, you canstill use the accelerator pedal tospeed up for passing. Aftercompleting the pass, take your footoff the accelerator pedal. The vehiclewill return to the set cruising speed.
You can cancel cruise control in anyof these ways:
Push the CRUISE (ACC) button.
When you push the CANCEL buttonor tap the brake pedal, the systemremembers the previously set speed.To return to that speed, accelerate toabove 25 mph (40 km/h), then pressand release the RES/ACCEL button.The CRUISE CONTROL (ACC(green)) indicator comes on. Thevehicle accelerates to the samespeed as before.
Pressing the CRUISE (ACC) buttonturns the system completely off anderases the previous cruising speed.
Resuming the Set SpeedCanceling Cruise Control
Cruise Control
Features
277
CANCEL BUTTON
CRUISE (ACC) BUTTON
Non-ACC model is shown
06/08/12 18:54:54 31SJA620 0282
The radar sensor for ACC is sharedwith the collision mitigation brakesystem (CMBS). For moreinformation on the radar sensor, seepage . For more information onCMBS, see page .
Adaptive cruise control (ACC)consists of a radar sensor in thefront grille, the ACC buttons on thesteering wheel, and the ACCfunctions of the multi-informationdisplay.
355356
If equippedACC Components
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
278
ACC INDICATORMULTI-INFORMATIONDISPLAY
RES/ACCELBUTTON
ACC BUTTON
DISTANCE BUTTON
CANCEL BUTTON
SET/DECELBUTTON
06/08/12 18:55:01 31SJA620 0283
Adaptive cruise control (ACC) allowsyou to maintain a set speed and keepthe vehicle ahead of you and yourvehicle at a safe distance withouthaving to use the accelerator pedalor the brake pedal.
If the vehicle ahead of you slowsdown suddenly or another vehiclecuts in front of your vehicle, ACCalerts you by sounding a beeper anddisplaying a message on the multi-information display.The ACC radar sensor in the frontgrille can detect and monitor thedistance of a vehicle up to 328 feet(100 meters) ahead of your vehicle.For more information on the radarsensor, see page .
Do not use ACC under theseconditions:
In poor visibility.In heavy traffic.When you must slow down andspeed up repeatedly.On winding roads.When you enter a toll gate,interchange, service area, parkingarea, etc. In these areas, there isno vehicle ahead of you, but ACCwould still try to accelerate to yourset speed.In bad weather (rain, fog, snow,etc.)On a slippery road (for example aroad covered with ice or snow).
As with any system, there are limitsto ACC. Inappropriate use of ACCcan result in a serious accident. Usethe brake pedal whenever necessary,and always keep a safe distancebetween your vehicle and othervehicles.
When the vehicle ahead of you slowsdown or speeds up, ACC senses thechange in distance and compensatesby accelerating or braking yourvehicle to reach the cruising speedyou previously set. The distancebetween vehicles is based on yourspeed: the faster you go, the longerthe distance will be; the slower yougo, the shorter it will be.
356
CONTINUED
Overview
Important Safety Precautions
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Features
279
06/08/12 18:55:10 31SJA620 0284
When there is no vehicle ahead withinACC range
When a vehicle ahead is within ACCrange and going slower than your setspeedYour vehicle will maintain a set
cruising speed. If the vehicle ahead of you is goingslower than your set speed, yourvehicle will slow down to the speedof that vehicle. Your vehicle will thenfollow at a constant distance until thevehicle ahead changes speed again.
Operating Characteristics
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
280
Improper use of ACC can leadto a crash.
Use ACC only when travelingon open highways in goodweather.
06/08/12 18:55:17 31SJA620 0285
If the vehicle ahead of you slowsdown abruptly, or if another vehiclecuts in front of you, a beeper soundsand a message appears on the multi-information display to warn you.
Your vehicle follows the vehicleahead of it, keeping a constantdistance. ACC will not keep yourvehicle at a constant distance if thevehicle ahead of you goes out ofrange of your set speed.
If the vehicle ahead of you slowsdown and changes lanes, ACC nolonger tracks it. Your vehicle willthen return to your set speed.
In the case, decelerate your vehicleby pressing the brake pedal, andkeep an appropriate distance fromthe vehicle ahead.
When a vehicle ahead is within ACCrange and going at a steady speed
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Features
281
06/08/12 18:55:24 31SJA620 0286
ACC does not work below 25 mph(40 km/h). It cannot bring yourvehicle to a complete stop.
ACC will not sound a beeper ordisplay a message on the multi-information display to warn you ofvehicles going slower than 13 mph(20 km/h) or vehicles that areparked. In these cases, it is up toyou to maintain a safe distance byusing the brake pedal.
ACC may not recognizemotorcycles or other smallvehicles ahead of your vehicle.
ACC may react to vehicles besideyou or even building beside you bymomentarily applying the brakesor sounding a beeper underconditions such as a sudden curveor narrowing of the road, anabrupt movement of the steeringwheel, or if you are in an unusualposition within your lane.
Limitations
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
282
06/08/12 18:55:28 31SJA620 0287
Push the ACC button on thesteering wheel. The ACC indicatoron the instrument panel comes on,and ‘‘ACC’’ is shown on the multi-information display.
Accelerate to the desired speedabove 25 mph (40 km/h).
Press and release the SET/DECEL button on the steeringwheel.
If you press the SET/DECEL buttonwhen the vehicle speed is below 25mph (40 km/h), you will hear threebeeps. This means ACC is notactivated, and you cannot set yourspeed.
When your speed reaches 25 mph(40 km/h), ACC goes into wait mode,and ‘‘ACC STANDBY’’ is shown onthe multi-information display.
1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
Using the ACC
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Features
283
ACC BUTTON
SET/DECEL BUTTON
06/08/12 18:55:36 31SJA620 0288
When the speed is set, it is shownalong with a vehicle icon anddistance bars on the multi-information display.Refer to page for how to set andchange the set distance betweenyour vehicle and the vehicle ahead ofyou.
If you cancel ACC by pressing theCANCEL button or by tapping thebrake pedal, the previously setcruising speed is shown on the multi-information display. To store thisspeed as your new cruising speed,press and release the RES/ACCELbutton.
If you change the speed unitmeasurement from the factorydefault setting, the initial speed unitmeasurement is shown under thecurrent unit.
To change the speed unitmeasurement from mph to km/h,see page .92
287
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
284
SET VEHICLESPEED
U.S.
CANADA CANADA CANADA
U.S. U.S.
PREVIOUSLY SET SPEEDSET VEHICLEDISTANCE INITIAL SPEED UNIT
06/08/12 18:55:46 31SJA620 0289
The set speed can be increasedusing the RES/ACCEL button or theaccelerator pedal.
To increase the set speed with theRES/ACCEL button, do this:
Press and hold the RES/ACCELbutton. The vehicle will accelerate.When you reach the speed you want,release the button.
To increase your speed in small
amounts, tap the RES/ACCELbutton repeatedly. Each time you dothis, your vehicle will speed up about1 mph (1 km/h).
While the vehicle accelerates to theset speed, the set speed on the multi-information display will flash.
If a vehicle ahead of you is driving ata slower speed than the speed youwant to set, your vehicle will notaccelerate; it will keep some distancebetween your vehicles.
To increase the set speed with theaccelerator pedal, do this:
Press the accelerator pedal toincrease to the speed you want, thenpress the SET/DECEL button. Theset speed will be shown on the multi-information display. If you do notpress the SET/DECEL button, yourvehicle will return to the previouslyset speed.
The ACC beeper will not soundwhile you press the accelerator pedal,no matter how close you get to thevehicle ahead of you.
Increasing the Set Speed
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Features
285
RES/ACCEL BUTTON
06/08/12 18:55:54 31SJA620 0290
The set speed can be decreasedusing the SET/DECEL button or thebrake pedal.
To decrease the set speed with theSET/DECEL button, do this:
Press and hold the SET/DECELbutton. Release the button when youreach the speed you want.
To slow down in small amounts, tapthe SET/DECEL button repeatedly.
Each time you do this, your vehicleslows down about 1 mph (1 km/h).
When the system detects a vehicleahead of you, a beeper sounds onceand a solid-line vehicle icon appearson the multi-information display.
The set cruising speed will be shownon the multi-information display.
On a steep downhill, the vehiclespeed may exceed the set cruisingspeed.
To decrease the set speed with thebrake pedal, do this:
Tap the brake pedal. When thevehicle slows down to the speed youwant, press the SET/DECEL button.The set speed will be shown on themulti-information display. If you usethe brake pedal to decrease speed,and then press the RES/ACCELbutton, your vehicle will return to thepreviously set speed.
Decreasing the Set Speed Detecting a Vehicle Ahead of You
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
286
SET/DECEL BUTTON
U.S.
CANADA
06/08/12 18:56:04 31SJA620 0291
With ACC on, the distance betweenyour vehicle and the vehicle ahead ofyou is controlled and maintained.You can change this distance to oneof three ranges: long, middle, orshort.
To change the range, press theDISTANCE button. Each time youpress the button, the range changesfrom Long, to Middle, and then toShort.
The higher your vehicle speed is, thelonger the distance between thevehicle in front will be set as shownbelow.
When that vehicle changes lanes orgoes out of ACC range, a beepersounds once. If there is no vehicleahead of you within ACC range, adotted-line vehicle icon will be on themulti-information display.To set the ACC beeper on or off, seepage .90
CONTINUED
SpeedVehicleDistance
Long
Middle
Short
50 mph(80 Km/h)
154 feet47 meters111 feet
34 meters85 feet
26 meters
65 mph(104 Km/h)
200 feet61 meters173 feet
42 meters101 feet
31 meters
Changing Vehicle Distance
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Features
287
DISTANCE BUTTONU.S.
CANADA
06/08/12 18:56:14 31SJA620 0292
Press the ACC button. The ACCindicator in the instrument panelgoes off.
Tap the brake pedal.
Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.
If you cancel ACC by pressing theACC button, the previously setcruising speed is erased frommemory.
The distance you select is alsoshown on the multi-informationdisplay.
ACC is canceled whenever you doany of these actions:
When you push the CANCEL buttonor tap the brake pedal to cancel ACC,the set cruising speed stays inmemory. When you turn on ACCagain, the speed is shown on themulti-information display. To returnto that speed, accelerate to over 25mph (40 km/h), then press the RES/ACCEL button.
Canceling the ACC
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
288
LONGRANGE
MIDDLERANGE
SHORTRANGE
CANCEL BUTTON
U.S.
CANADA
U.S.
CANADA
U.S.
CANADA
06/08/12 18:56:26 31SJA620 0293
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it comes on at any othertime, there is a problem in the ACCsystem. If this happens, take thevehicle to your dealer to have itchecked.
The ACC system cannot be usedwhile this indicator is on.
When ACC is automaticallycancelled, the beeper sounds threetimes, and an ACC OFF messageappears on the multi-informationdisplay for 3 seconds.
Any of these conditions may causeACC to cancel:
The vehicle speed decreasesbelow 22 mph (35 km/h).
Driving on a mountainous road, ordriving off road for extendedperiods.
When the VSA indicator comes on.
When the ABS or VSA is activated.
Abrupt steering wheel movement.
If ACC is cancelled by any theseconditions, wait until the conditionimproves, then press the RES/ACCEL button to restore ACC.When you do this, the vehicle willresume its set cruising speed.
If you turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0)position after ACC was automaticallycancelled, the set speed is erased,and you must enter it again (seepage ).
Poor weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.)
When the radar sensor in the frontgrille gets dirty.
The vehicle ahead of you cannotbe detected.
An abnormal tire condition isdetected, or the tires are skidding. 283
Automatic ACC Cancellation ACC Indicator
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Features
289
ACC INDICATOR
06/08/12 18:56:37 31SJA620 0294
The multi-information display showsvarious messages related to ACC.For a description of each ACCmessage you may see, refer to thechart on this and the following page.
Message Description
ACC is on.
ACC is on and in standby mode.
A cruising speed can be set bypressing the SET/DECEL button.
ACC is in standby mode, and thepreviously set cruising speed is inmemory.The previously set speed can beresumed by pressing the RES/ACCEL button.
Messages on theMulti-Information Display
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
290
U.S.
CANADA
06/08/12 18:56:45 31SJA620 0295
Message MessageDescription Description
ACC detects a vehicle ahead of you.
You will hear a beep when the vehiclemoves out of the ACC radar sensor’srange.
ACC does not detect a vehicle aheadof you.
You will hear a beep when ACCdetects a vehicle ahead of you.
ACC has automatically cancelledbecause its radar sensor in the frontgrill is dirty.
You will hear three beeps.
ACC has automatically cancelledbecause of bad weather or otherconditions.
You will hear three beeps.
Apply the brakes immediately.Your vehicle is too close to the vehicleahead of it.
You will hear a continuous beep.
ACC needs to be checked.
Have your vehicle checked by adealer.
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Features
291
U.S.
U.S.
CANADA
CANADA
06/08/12 18:56:53 31SJA620 0296
To switch from ACC to cruisecontrol, press the distance button onthe steering wheel, and hold it for 1second.
Always be aware which mode isselected.
When the cruise control is selected,ACC does not sound a beeper ordisplay a message on the multi-information display. Make sure tokeep a safe distance from the vehicleahead of you.
When you press the button, you willsee CRUISE MODE SELECTED onthe multi-information display for 2seconds. To switch back to ACC,press and hold the distance buttonagain for 1 second.
Switching to Cruise Control
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
292
DISTANCE BUTTON
Press the distance button.
06/08/12 18:57:00 31SJA620 0297
-
To do this, press and hold the twooutside buttons on the HomeLinktransceiver for about 20 seconds,until the red indicator flashes.Release the buttons, then proceed tostep 1.
If you justreceived your vehicle and have nottrained any of the buttons inHomeLink before, you should eraseany previously learned codes beforetraining the first button.
If you are training the second orthird buttons, go directly to step 1.
Unplug the garage door openermotor from the electrical outlet.
Hold the end of the garage dooropener remote 2 to 5 inches fromHomeLink. Make sure you are notblocking your view of the redindicator in HomeLink.
The HomeLink universaltransceiver built into your vehiclecan be programmed to operate up tothree remotely controlled devicesaround your home, such as garagedoors, lighting, or home securitysystems.
If you are training HomeLink tooperate a garage door or gate, youshould unplug the motor for thatdevice during training. Repeatedlypressing the remote control buttoncould burn out the motor.
HomeLink stores the code in apermanent memory. There shouldbe no need to retrain HomeLink ifyour vehicle’s battery goes dead or isdisconnected. If your garage dooropener was manufactured beforeApril 1982, you may not be able toprogram HomeLink to operate it.They do not have the safety featurethat causes the motor to stop and
reverse if an obstacle is detectedduring closing, increasing the risk ofinjury.
Always refer to the openinginstructions and safety informationthat came with your garage dooropener or other equipment youintend to operate with HomeLink. Ifyou do not have this information,contact the manufacturer of theequipment.
For quick and accurate training,make sure the remote transmitterfor the device (garage door,automatic gate, security system, etc.)has a fresh battery.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Training HomeLink
General Information
Important Safety Precautions
Before you begin
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Features
293
06/08/12 18:57:11 31SJA620 0298
Plug in the garage door openermotor, then test the HomeLinkbutton by pushing it for about 1
second.If the button works,programming is complete.If the button does not work goto step 6.
Press and hold the remotetransmitter button and one of theHomeLink buttons at the sametime.
If the red indicator in HomeLinkbegins to flash slowly at first,then rapidly, release bothbuttons, and go to step 5.
If the red indicator in HomeLinkcontinues to flash slowly (doesnot flash rapidly), your remotetransmitter may stoptransmitting after a short time.Go to step 4.
Press and hold the remotetransmitter button and one of theHomeLink buttons at the sametime. While continuing to hold theHomeLink button, press andrelease the remote transmitterbutton every 2 seconds.
If the red indicator in HomeLinkbegins to flash slowly at first,then rapidly, release bothbuttons, and go to step 5.If the red indicator in HomeLinkcontinues to flash slowly (doesnot begin to flash rapidly),repeat steps 2 thru 4.
Repeat these steps to train theother two HomeLink buttons tooperate any other compatibleremotely controlled devicesaround your home (lighting,automatic gate, security system,etc.).
If the indicator flashes rapidlyfor 2 seconds then stays on, youhave a rolling code transmitter:go to ‘‘Training with a RollingCode System’’ (see page ).
If the indicator stays on orflashes slowly, repeat steps 2thru 5.
Push and hold the HomeLinkbutton for a few seconds, thenwatch the red indicator onHomeLink.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
295
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
294
RED INDICATOR
06/08/12 18:57:21 31SJA620 0299
For security purposes, newer garagedoor opening systems use a ‘‘rolling’’or variable code. Information fromthe remote control and the garagedoor opener is needed beforeHomeLink can operate the garagedoor opener.
Find the ‘‘training’’ button on yourgarage door opener unit. Thelocation will vary, depending onthe manufacturer.
Make sure you have properlycompleted the ‘‘TrainingHomeLink’’ procedure.
Press the HomeLink button againfor about 1 second. It shouldoperate the garage door.
The ‘‘Training HomeLink’’procedure trains HomeLink to theproper garage door opener code.The following proceduresynchronizes HomeLink to thegarage door opener so it sends andreceives the correct codes.
Press the training button on thegarage door opener unit until theindicator next to the button comeson. The indicator may blink, orcome on and stay on. You thenhave approximately 30 seconds tocomplete the following steps.
Press and hold the button onHomeLink for 3 to 4 seconds.
Press and hold the HomeLinkbutton again for 3 to 4 seconds.This should turn off the trainingindicator on the garage dooropener unit. (Some systems mayrequire you to press the button upto three times.)
6.
2.
4.
5.
1.
3.
Training With a Rolling CodeSystem
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Features
295
TRAINING BUTTON
06/08/12 18:57:30 31SJA620 0300
You should erase all three codesbefore selling the vehicle.
To erase the codes stored in all threebuttons, press and hold the twooutside buttons until the redindicator begins to flash, thenrelease the buttons.
If you want to retrain a programmedbutton for a new device, you do nothave to erase all button memory.You can replace the existing memorycode using this procedure:
If a standard transmitter wasprogrammed, the indicator willstay on for about 25 seconds.
HomeLink is a registeredtrademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.
If you have problems with trainingthe HomeLink Universal Transceiver,or would like information on homeproducts that can be operated byHomeLink, call (800) 355-3515. Onthe Internet, go towww.homelink.com.
Once the HomeLink indicatorbegins to flash slowly, continue tohold the HomeLink button, andfollow steps 3 thru 6 under‘‘Training HomeLink’’ (see page
).
If a rolling code transmitter waspreviously programmed, theindicator will flash rapidly for 2seconds, and then stay on forabout 23 seconds.
Press and hold the HomeLinkbutton to be trained until theHomeLink indicator begins toflash slowly.
1.
2.
293
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Erasing Codes
Retraining a ButtonCustomer Assistance
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
296
06/08/12 18:57:41 31SJA620 0301
Most AcuraLink functions arecontrolled by the interface dial. Theinterface dial has two parts, a knoband a selector.
The knob turns left and right. Use itto make selections or adjustments toa list or menu on the screen.
The selector can be pushed left,right, up, down, and in. Use theselector to scroll through lists, toselect menus, and to highlight menuitems. When you make a selection,push the center of the selector(ENTER) to go to that selection.
AcuraLink enhances your ownershipexperience by providing a directcommunication link between yourvehicle and the Acura Server.Working through the XM radiosatellite, AcuraLink works inconjunction with the navigationsystem, HandsFreeLink (HFL), andaudio system in your vehicle. Itdisplays and receives several kindsof messages, including:
Operating tips and information onyour vehicle’s features.
Important recall and safetyinformation.
Maintenance information to keepyour vehicle in top condition.
Diagnostic information to provideinformation about any problemswith your vehicle.
RL Technology Package and RL CMBS/PAX models
Interface Dial
AcuraLink
Features
297
ENTER
SELECTOR
KNOB
06/08/12 18:57:49 31SJA620 0302
If you have new messages, anenvelope icon appears in the topright corner of the navigation screen.
To open a message:
Press ENTER on the interfaceselector, then select New Messagefrom the navigation system mapmenu. If there is more than onemessage, stored in the system,you will see a list of message titles.
Unread messages have a closedenvelope icon next to them. The icondisappears when it has already beenread.
Only diagnostic infomessages overlay the screen whiledriving. They indicate if your vehiclehas a problem that may needimmediate attention (see page ).
After purchasing your vehicle,messages may not appearimmediately.Your dealer has to register thevehicle identification before you canreceive messages. This can takeseveral days to process.
Scroll up or down, and select themessage you want to read bypressing ENTER on the interfaceselector.
To view previously read messages,press the INFO button, selectMESSAGES, then select thecategory you want to review.
304
Reading Messages
AcuraLink
298
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:57:59 31SJA620 0303
Diagnostic info and recall/campaign messages can only bedeleted by your dealer.
To delete a single message:Press the INFO button to bring upthe Information screen.
Scroll to the Messages option,then select it by pressing ENTERon the interface selector.
When you open a message, you canread a summary of it, and thenchoose one of several options. If anoption is not available for a message,that button will not be highlighted.
Scroll to the category with themessages you want to delete, andselect the category by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
Scroll to the Delete Messagesoption, and select it by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
Use the interface knob to scroll tothe AcuraLink/Messages button,and select it by pressing ENTERon the interface selector.
Select MORE by pushing theinterface selector to the right.
Press the SETUP button to viewthe setup screen.
The Delete All Messagescommand does not apply to Recall orDiagnostic Info messages. Thesemessages must be deleted by yourdealer.
To delete all messages:
Use the interface knob to scroll upor down to the message title youwant to delete, and select it bypressing ENTER on the interfaceselector.
Select the message category forthe message you want to delete.
Scroll to Delete with the interfaceknob, and select it by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
CONTINUED
Deleting Messages Message Options
AcuraLink
Features
299
NOTE: NOTE:
06/08/12 18:58:12 31SJA620 0304
-
-
-
-
-
-
To set your AcuraLink preferences(the types of messages you want toreceive, if any), visit the Owner Linkwebsite at www.owners.acura.com,and choose what you would like toreceive. If you do not have internetaccess, call Acura Client Services at(800) 382-2238; they can set yourmessage preferences for you.
Select this button todelete the current message.
Select this button to hear avoice read the entire message. Thisgives you more information than thescreen can display at one time. Whenyou select the Voice button, itchanges to a Stop Reading button.Select the button again to stop thevoice.
Select this button to call aphone number embedded in themessage. When you select , theHandsFreeLink (HFL) dials thenumber for you.To make a call, your Bluetoothcompatible phone must be paired toyour vehicle’s HandsFreeLinksystem, have its power on, and beinside the vehicle (see page ).
Select this button to find the nearestAcura dealer using the navigation
system.
Selectthis button to call the Acura dealeryou purchased your vehicle from.AcuraLink also directs you to thisdealer so you can schedule amaintenance appointment or receiveinformation about a message. If yourassigned servicing dealer changes,AcuraLink will be updated to callthat dealer.
Select this button toget more information about thecurrent diagnostic message. To usethis option, your cell phone must bepaired to the HFL. In addition, thepaired phone must have a compatibledata service and be set up with theAcuraLink system to make a dataconnection. Access thehandsfreelink.com website to findout which data services are currentlycompatible with AcuraLink.
306
Message PreferencesDelete
Voice
Call
Call
Find Nearest Acura Dealer
Call Your Acura Dealer
More Info
AcuraLink
300
06/08/12 18:58:19 31SJA620 0305
-
-
-
-
To access the following functions,press the SETUP button, push theinterface selector to the right toselect MORE, then rotate theinterface knob to select AcuraLink/Messages.
Select thisbutton to delete all stored messageswithin a category, except fordiagnostic info and recall campaignmessages. These messages can onlybe deleted by a certified technicianafter the recall is done or theproblem is corrected, or through abroadcast message from Acura.
Select ON if you want to be notifiedof new messages (envelope iconappears on the navigation screen).Select OFF if you do not want to benotified of new messages (envelopeicon does not appear on thenavigation screen).
Messages can still be accessed usingthe INFO menu. If you would like tostop receiving messages, visit theOwnerLink website at
to change your messagingpreferences.
Select ON to havethe system automatically read eachmessage to you. Select OFF tomanually select the Voice buttonwhen you want a message read toyou.
Selectthis button to begin the processrequired to connect to Acura. This isused to access the most recentdiagnostic information when aproblem occurs.
www.owners.acura.com
CONTINUED
AcuraLink/Message Screen
Delete Messages
New Message Notification
Auto Reading
Phone-Data Connection
AcuraLink
Features
301
06/08/12 18:58:28 31SJA620 0306
-There are six message categories inAcuraLink: Quick Tips, FeatureGuides, Maintenance Minders,Recalls/Campaigns, Diagnostic Info,and Dealer Appointment Reminders.The system can store up to 256messages.
Message categories can be added,revised, or deleted throughbroadcast messages from Acura.
For the Phone DataConnection button to be active, youneed a Bluetooth compatible andenabled cellphone paired to theHandsFreeLink (HFL). To completethe date connection setup, the pairedphone must have a compatible dataservice.
The default setting is prompt. Whena diagnostic info message appears,and you select the Check Nowbutton, the system will prompt youbefore connecting to the Acuraserver. If you do not wish to connectat that time, select No at the prompt,and you will see the informationfrom the onboard database. The‘‘Auto’’ setting will remove theprompt when you select the CheckNow button and will automaticallyconnect to the Acura server. Thissetting only applies when you have aBluetooth enabled phone that ispaired with the HFL and you havecompleted the Phone-DataConnection setup.
AcuraLink
Message CategoriesConnect to the Acura Server
302
NOTE:
06/08/12 18:58:33 31SJA620 0307
These messages provide detailedinformation about the serviceneeded for your vehicle. When amaintenance message appears onthe multi-information display, a list ofneeded maintenance items isprovided through in an AcuraLinkmessage. These messages tell youthe exact maintenance needed,helping you to avoid unnecessarymaintenance costs.
These messages, based on updatedvehicle information and commentsfrom other RL owners, supplementyour Owner’s Manual and QuickStart Guide. They provide you withrelevant information for a safe andenjoyable ownership experience. Foradditional information, call AcuraClient Services directly through theHFL.
During the first 90 days ofownership, one of up to 32 differentmessages appears each day. Thesemessages help you to use andunderstand the technologicalfeatures of your vehicle.
CONTINUED
AcuraLink
Maintenance MinderQuick Tips Feature Guide
Features
303
06/08/12 18:58:42 31SJA620 0308
When an indicator comes on or amessage is displayed on the multi-information display (MID),AcuraLink can provide informationabout the cause of indicator ormessage and the recommendedaction to take. This helps you handlethe problem as it occurs, preventingor limiting costly repairs.
The AcuraLink system cannotdetermine some mechanicalproblems (such as squeaks orrattles) that are not triggered by thediagnostic indicator monitors.
If your vehicle is affected by a recallor other important safetyinformation, a letter will be mailed toyou about the issue and how to fix it.If you don’t get your vehicle fixed,you will also receive a remindermessage through AcuraLink. Youcan then use the message options tocall your dealer for an appointmentor to find the nearest dealer.
You can then use the messageoptions to call your dealer for anappointment or to find the nearestdealer.
For more information on theinstrument panel indicators, see page
.61
AcuraLink
Diagnostic InfoRecall/Campaigns
304
06/08/12 18:58:49 31SJA620 0309
When you select the More Infooption, if the HFL is connected to acellular data service, AcuraLinkgathers more information about theproblem, and sends it to Acura.There, the information is analyzedand returned to the vehicle with themost accurate repair information.
When an instrument panel indicatorcomes on or a message is displayedon the MID, AcuraLink immediatelynotifies you with the message,‘‘Check more information.’’ If you donot want the information right away,select the Check Later option. If youwant the information now, select theCheck Now option. (If the navigationscreen is not active, you must selectOK from the navigation disclaimerscreen before you can check theinformation.)
Depending on the severity of theproblem, the message will let youknow if you should see your dealerimmediately or if you can wait awhile.
You will see information from theonboard troubleshooting database.
You can then use message options tocall your dealer for an appointment,find the nearest dealer, or find outmore information about the issue.
AcuraLink
Features
305
06/08/12 18:58:56 31SJA620 0310
Bluetooth is a registered trademarkof Bluetooth SIG, Inc.Bluetooth is the wireless technologythat links your phone to the HFL.The HFL uses a Class 2 Bluetooth,which means the maximum rangebetween your phone and vehicle is30 feet (10 meters).
To use the HFL, your phone musthave approved Bluetooth capabilityalong with the Hands Free Profile.This type of phone is availablethrough many phone makers andcellular carriers. You can also find anapproved phone by visiting
( In Canada, visit) or by calling the
Hands Free Link customer supportat
Your vehicle is equipped with theHandsFreeLink (HFL). HFL usesBluetooth technology as a wirelesslink between it and your Bluetoothcompatible cellphone. When you arein your vehicle and your phone islinked to the HFL, you’ll enjoyhands-free phone use. The HFL isavailable in both English and French(Canadian models only). To changethe language, see page .
Here are the main features of theHFL. Instructions for using the HFLbegin on page .
HFL recognizes simple voicecommands, such as phonenumbers and names. It uses thesecommands to automatically dial,receive, and store numbers. Formore information on voice control,see Using Voice Control on page .
When you make an appointmentthrough the Owner’s Link OnlineScheduling Service, you can bereminded about that appointmentthrough the AcuraLink system inadvance. If you need to reschedule,you can call your dealer directly withthe HFL.
The timing of your reminder isbased on your reminder preferenceestablished on Owner Link.
322
307
309
handsfreelink.com.www.acura.ca.
(888) 528-7876.
Bluetooth Wireless TechnologyHandsFreeLink
Voice Control
Dealer Appointment Reminder
AcuraLink, HandsFreeLink
306
TM
TM
06/08/12 18:59:06 31SJA620 0311
To operate the HFL, use the HFLTalk and Back buttons on the leftside of the steering wheel. Below theHFL buttons is another set of voicecontrol buttons for the navigation,climate control, and audio systems.
When the HFL is in use, the soundcomes through the vehicle’s frontaudio system speakers. If the audiosystem is in use while operatingeither of the HFL buttons or makinga call, the HFL over-rides the audiosystem. To change the volume level,use the audio system volume knob.
With a linked phone, the HFL allowsyou to send and receive calls in yourvehicle without holding the phone.
The HFL can store up to 50 namesand phone numbers in its phonebook.With a linked phone, you can thenautomatically dial any name ornumber in the phonebook.
Here are the main components ofthe HFL system:
The HFL microphone is on theceiling console. The microphone isshared with the navigation system (ifequipped).
CONTINUED
HandsFreeLink
HFL ButtonsAudio SystemIncoming/Outgoing Calls
Phonebook
Microphone
Features
307
HFL TALKBUTTON
HFL BACKBUTTON
VOICE CONTROLBUTTONS
TM
06/08/12 18:59:16 31SJA620 0312
*
*
*
-
-
-
-
-
*
Signal Strength Indicates thenetwork signal strength of thecurrent phone. Five bars equalsfull strength.
ROAM Status Indicates yourphone is roaming.
Battery Level Status Indicatesthe power currently remaining inyour phone’s battery. Five barsequals full battery strength.
HFL Mode Indicates when youare dialing and receiving calls.
Phone Dialing Indicates thenumber you entered or thenumber of the incoming call.
Some phones do not send thisinformation to the HFL.
When you are operating the HFL, orwhen you manually select HFL onthe multi-information display, youwill see this information on thescreen:
Here is the function of each HFLbutton:
HFL Talk: This button is used beforeyou give a command, to answerincoming calls, and to confirmsystem information.
HFL Back: This button is used toend a call, go back to the previousvoice control command, and tocancel an operation.
:
HandsFreeLink
Multi-Information Display
308
SIGNALSTRENGTH
BATTERYLEVEL STATUS
HFLMODE
ROAM STATUS PHONE DIALING
TM
06/08/12 18:59:25 31SJA620 0313
CONTINUED
Here are some guidelines for usingvoice control:
To enter a command, press theTalk button. Then, after the beep,say your command in a clear,natural tone.
For best system operation, set theclimate control fan speed to low,and direct the center vents awayfrom the microphone in the ceiling.
If the HFL does not recognize acommand, its response is, ‘‘Pardon.’’If it doesn’t recognize thecommand a second time, itsresponse is, ‘‘Please repeat.’’ If itdoesn’t recognize the command athird time, it plays the Helpprompt.
The HFL is operated by the HFLTalk and Back buttons on the leftside of the steering wheel. The nextfew pages provide instructions for allbasic features of the HFL.
All phones may notoperate identically, and some maycause inconsistent operation of theHFL.
With the HFL system activated, youwill also see ‘‘HF LINK’’ on the upperdisplay.
When you are dialing or receivingcalls with the audio system in use,you will see the HFL screen on thenavigation display.
HandsFreeLink
Using Voice ControlHow to Use the HFL
Features
309
NOTE:
TM
06/08/12 18:59:35 31SJA620 0314
When you finish a commandsequence, the HFL goes back toits main menu. For example, whenyou store the name, ‘‘Eric,’’ theHFL response is, ‘‘Eric has beenstored.’’ The next time you pressthe Talk button, you will be at themain menu.
If nothing is said while the HFL islistening for a command, the HFLwill time out and stop its voicerecognition. The next time youpress the Talk button, the HFLbegins listening from the point atwhich it timed out.
To go back one step in a commandprocess, say, ‘‘Go back,’’ or pressthe Back button.
To end a command sequence atany time, press and hold the Backbutton, or press and release theTalk button, wait for the beep, andsay, ‘‘Cancel.’’ The next time youpress the Talk button, the HFLbegins from its main menu.
Many commands can be spokentogether. For example, you cansay, ‘‘Dial 123-456-7891.’’
To hear a list of available optionsat any time, press the Talk button,wait for the beep, and say, ‘‘Handsfree link help.’’
To enter a string of numbers in aCall or Dial command, you can saythem all at once, or you canseparate them in blocks of 3, 4, 7,10, or 11.
To skip a voice prompt, press theTalk button while the HFL isspeaking. The HFL will then beginlistening for your next command.
HandsFreeLink
310
TM
06/08/12 18:59:41 31SJA620 0315
The HFL system responsecontinues ‘‘A security option isavailable to lock the hands freesystem. Each time the vehicle isturned on, a password would berequired to use this system. Wouldyou like this security option turnedon?’’
Press and release the Talk button.If you say ‘‘No’’ after the beep, theHFL system response is, ‘‘Securitywill not be used. The system setupis complete.’’
If you say ‘‘Yes,’’ you can set yourpassword. Refer to the settingprocedure in the next column.
Press and release the Talk button.If you say ‘‘Yes’’ after the beep, theHFL system response is, ‘‘Wouldyou like the notification to be aring tone or a prompt?’’ If you say‘‘No’’ after the beep, the HFLsystem returns to its main menu.Saying ‘‘No’’ will result in no ringtone or prompt playback during anincoming call. The audio systemwill be mute, and a message willbe displayed.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Ring tone’’ or‘‘Prompt.’’ The HFL systemresponse is ‘‘A ring tone will beused.’’ or ‘‘An incoming callprompt will be used.’’If you choose ‘‘Ring tone,’’ you willhear a ring tone through the audiospeakers to announce an incomingcall. If you choose ‘‘Prompt,’’ youwill hear this message toannounce an incoming call: ‘‘Youhave an incoming call.’’
The voice of the HFL can be set tomale or female (U.S. models only).Also, the incoming notification canbe set to a ring tone, a prompt, or nonotification.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘System.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘System optionsare setup and clear.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Setup.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Would you likemale or female prompts?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Male’’ or‘‘Female,’’ depending on thesystem voice you want. The HFLresponse is, ‘‘Male (Female)prompts have been selected.Would you like an audiblenotification of an incoming call?’’
4.
5.
6.
7.1.
2.
3.
To set up the system, do this:
HandsFreeLink
Setting Up the System
Features
311
TM
06/08/12 18:59:52 31SJA620 0316
The HFL system will accept anumeric, four-digit password thatyou can use for security purposes.
Follow the system setupprocedure from the step 1 throughthe step 5 as described previously.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’
The HFL system response is‘‘What is the four digit numberyou would like to set as yourpassword?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL system response is ‘‘Thesystem is now locked. Each timethe vehicle is turned on, thepassword will be required to usethe system. The system setup iscomplete. Returning to the mainmenu.’’
Once a password is set, you can lockthe HFL system so it only operatesafter the password is entered.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the four-digitpassword you want to use. Forexample, say ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4.’’ The HFLsystem response is ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4. Isthis correct?’’
The HFL system will prompt youfor your password each time theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position and you press theTalk button. You will only beasked for the password once perignition cycle. If the password isset, the response is ‘‘The system islocked. What is the four-digitpassword?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say your four-digitpassword. For example, say ‘‘1, 2,3, 4.’’
If the password is correct, theHFL system response is ‘‘Mainmenu.’’
If the password is not correct, theHFL system response is ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4 isincorrect. Please try again.’’ Go backto the step 2.
If you forget your password and youcannot activate the HFL system,consult your dealer to cancel thepassword.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.To set your password, do this:
To enter your password, do this:
HandsFreeLink
Setting Your Password
312
TM
06/08/12 19:00:04 31SJA620 0317
CONTINUED
Your Bluetooth compatible phonewith HandsFree Profile must bepaired to the HFL before you canmake and receive hands-free calls.
HFL does not allow you to pairyour phone if the vehicle ismoving.For pairing, your phone must be inits Discovery mode.Up to six phones can be paired tothe HFL.The following procedure works formost phones. If you cannot pairyour phone to the HFL with thisprocedure, refer to your phone’soperating manual, talk to yourphone retailer, or call theHandsFreeLink customer supportat (888) 528-7876.During the pairing process, turnoff any previously paired phonesbefore pairing a new phone.
With your phone on and theignition in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position, press and releasethe Talk button. After the beep,say ‘‘Phone setup.’’ The HFLresponse is ‘‘Phone setup optionsare status, pair, edit, delete, andlist.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Pair.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘The pairingprocess requires operation of yourmobile phone. For safety, onlyperform this function while thevehicle is stopped. State a four-digit code for pairing. Note thiscode. It will be requested by thephone.’’
1.
2.
HandsFreeLink
Pairing Your Phone
Features
313
NOTE:
TM
06/08/12 19:00:13 31SJA620 0318
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwant to use. For example, say‘‘Eric’s phone.’’ The HFL responseis ‘‘Eric’s phone has beensuccessfully paired. Returning tothe main menu.’’
If you want to pair another phone,repeat steps 1 through 7.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the four-digitcode you want to use. For example,say ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4.’’ The HFL responseis, ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4. Is this correct?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL system response is‘‘Searching for a Bluetooth phone.Make sure the phone you aretrying to pair is in discovery mode.’’
Steps 5 and 6 show acommon way to get your phone intoits Discovery mode. If these steps donot work on your phone, refer to thephone’s operating manual.
Follow the prompts on your phoneto get it into its Discovery mode.The phone will search for the HFL.When it comes up, selectHandsFreeLink from the list ofoptions displayed on your phone.
When asked by the phone, enterthe four-digit code from step 3 intoyour phone. The HFL response is‘‘A new phone has been found.What would you like to name thisphone?’’
Once the pairing process iscompleted, AcuraLink may display aconnection confirmation screen. Thisscreen is used to create a dataconnection between your cellphoneand the AcuraLink system. You canchoose to set up the data connectionnow, or do it later. If you want to doit now, exit the HFL menu bypressing the HFL Back button oneor more times.
4. 5.
6.
7.3.
8.
On vehicles with navigation system
HandsFreeLink
314
NOTE:
TM
06/08/12 19:00:21 31SJA620 0319
To rename a paired phone, do this: To delete a paired phone, do this:Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Edit.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Which phonewould you like to edit?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name ofthe phone you want to rename.For example, say ‘‘Eric’s phone.’’The HFL response is ‘‘What is thenew name for Eric’s phone?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the new nameof the phone. For example, say‘‘Lisa’s phone.’’ The HFL responseis, ‘‘The name has been changed.Returning to the main menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Delete.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Which phonewould you like to delete?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name ofthe phone you want to delete. Forexample say ‘‘Eric’s phone.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Would you liketo delete Eric’s phone?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Preparing todelete Eric’s phone.’’ Say ‘‘OK’’ tocontinue. Otherwise, say ‘‘Go back,’’or ‘‘Cancel.’’
Press and release the Talk button.If you say ‘‘OK’’ after the beep, theHFL response is ‘‘The phone hasbeen deleted. Returning to themain menu.’’ If you say ‘‘Go back,’’or ‘‘Cancel,’’ the phone will not bedeleted.
2.
3.
4.1. 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
CONTINUED
HandsFreeLink
Features
315
TM
06/08/12 19:00:31 31SJA620 0320
To list all paired phones, do this: To find out the status of the phone beingused, do this:
To change from the currently linkedphone to another paired phone, do this:Press and release the Talk button.
After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Next phone.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Searchingfor the next phone.’’ The HFLthen disconnects the linked phoneand searches for another pairedphone. If no other phones arefound, the first phone remainslinked.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ TheHFL responds by listing the nameof each paired phone. When allphones paired to the system havebeen read, the HFL response is‘‘The entire list has been read.Returning to the main menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Status.’’ Anexample of the HFL response is,‘‘Eric’s phone is linked. Batterystrength is three bars. Signalstrength is five bars, and thephone is roaming. Returning to themain menu.’’
2.
1.1.
2.
1.
HandsFreeLink
316
TM
06/08/12 19:00:38 31SJA620 0321
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Calling’’ or‘‘Dialing.’’ Once connected, youwill hear the person you calledthrough the audio speakers. Tochange the volume, use the audiosystem volume knob.
You can make calls using any phonenumber, or by using a name in theHFL phonebook. You can also redialthe last number called. During a call,the HFL allows you to talk up to 30minutes after you remove the keyfrom the ignition switch.
With your phone on and theignition in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position, press and releasethe Talk button. After the beep,say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’ The HFLresponse is, ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to call/dial?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the numberyou want to call. For example, say‘‘123 456 7891.’’ The HFL responseis ‘‘123 456 7891. Say call, dial, orcontinue to add numbers.’’
To end the call, press the Backbutton.
With your phone on and theignition in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position, press and releasethe Talk button. After the beep,say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’ The HFLresponse is ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to call/dial?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwant to call. For example, say
‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is‘‘Would you like to call Eric?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Calling’’ or‘‘Dialing.’’ Once connected, youwill hear the person you calledthrough the audio speakers. Tochange the volume, use the audiosystem volume knob.
To end the call, press the Backbutton.
To redial the last number called bythe phone, press and release theTalk button. After the beep, say‘‘Redial.’’ The HFL response is,‘‘Redialing.’’ Once connected, youwill hear the person you calledthrough the audio speakers. Tochange the volume, use the audiosystem volume knob.
1.
3.
3.
1.
2.
2.
4.
4.
To make a call using a phone number,do this:
To make a call using a name in the HFLphonebook, do this:
Making a Call
HandsFreeLink
Features
317
TM
06/08/12 19:00:48 31SJA620 0322
If you receive a call when you are noton the phone, the HFL interrupts theaudio system (if it is on), and playsthe incoming call notification, ifactivated. To answer the call, pressthe Talk button and begin speaking.If you don’t want to answer the call,press the Back button.
The HFL allows you to sendnumbers or names during a call. Thisis useful when you call a menu-driven phone system. You can alsoprogram account numbers into theHFL phonebook for easy retrievalduring menu-driven calls.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to send?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the numberyou want to send. For example,say ‘‘1, 2, 3.’’ The HFL response is‘‘1, 2, 3. Say send, or continue toadd numbers.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ Thedial tones will be sent, and the callwill continue.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to send?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwant to send. For example, say‘‘Account number.’’ The HFLresponse is ‘‘Would you like tosend account number?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ Thedial tones will be sent, and the callwill continue.
If your phone has Call Waiting, andyou receive a call when you are onthe phone, press and release theTalk button to answer it. When youdo this, the original call is placed onhold. To return to the original call,press the Talk button again. If youdon’t want to answer the new call,disregard it, and continue with youroriginal call. If you want to hang upthe original call and answer the newcall, press the Back button.
1.
2.1.
2.
3.
3.
To send a number during a call, do this:
To send a name during a call, do this:
Receiving a CallSending Numbers or NamesDuring a Call
HandsFreeLink
318
TM
06/08/12 19:00:58 31SJA620 0323
During a call, you can transfer itfrom the HFL to your phone, or fromyour phone to the HFL.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Transfer.’’The audio switches from the HFLto the phone.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Transfer.’’The audio switches from yourphone to the HFL.
During a call, you can mute orunmute your voice to the person youare talking to.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Mute.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Mute is active.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Mute.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Mute iscanceled.’’
The HFL phonebook can store upto 50 names with their associatednumbers. These can be any typesof numbers. For example, you canstore a phone number and use it tomake a call, or you can store anaccount number and use it duringa call to a menu-driven phonesystem.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebookoptions are store, edit, delete,receive contact, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Store.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What namewould you like to store?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwould like to store. For example,say ‘‘Eric’’ or say ‘‘account number.’’The HFL response is ‘‘What is thenumber for Eric,’’ or ‘‘What is thenumber for account number?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the number.For example, say ‘‘123 456 7891.’’The HFL response is ‘‘123 4567891.’’
2.
3.
1.
1.
2.
4.
2.
1.
To transfer a call from the HFL to yourphone, do this:
To transfer a call from your phone to theHFL, do this:
To mute your voice, do this:
To unmute your voice, do this:
To add a name, do this:
CONTINUED
Transferring a Call
Muting a Call
Setting up the Phonebook
HandsFreeLink
Features
319
TM
06/08/12 19:01:12 31SJA620 0324
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwould like to delete. For example,say ‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is‘‘Do you want to delete Eric?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘The name hasbeen deleted. Returning to themain menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the newnumber for Eric. For example, say‘‘987 654 3219.’’ The HFL responseis, ‘‘987 654 3219.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Enter.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘The number hasbeen changed. Returning to themain menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘ThePhonebook options are store, edit,delete, receive contact, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Delete.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What namewould you like to delete?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Enter.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Eric (or accountnumber) has been stored.Returning to the main menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebookoptions are store, edit, delete,receive contact, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Edit.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What namewould you like to edit?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwould like to edit. For example,say ‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is‘‘What is the new number forEric?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘ThePhonebook options are store, edit,delete, receive contact, and list.’’
2.
1.
4. 3.
4.5.
1.2.
1.
3.
5.
To list all names in the phonebook, dothis:
To delete a name, do this:
To edit the number of a name, do this:
HandsFreeLink
320
TM
06/08/12 19:01:24 31SJA620 0325
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Clear.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘This processwill clear all paired phones, clearall entries in the phonebook, andclear the passcode. Is this whatyou would like to do?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Preparing toclear all paired phones, allphonebook entries, and thepasscode. This may take up to 2minutes to complete.’’ Press andrelease the Talk button. After thebeep, say ‘‘OK’’ to proceed, or say‘‘Go back’’ or ‘‘Cancel.’’
If you said ‘‘OK,’’ after a shortperiod of time, the HFL responseis, ‘‘System has been cleared.Returning to the main menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ TheHFL responds by listing thenames in the phonebook. Whenthe end of the list is reached, theHFL response is, ‘‘The entire listhas been read. Returning to themain menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ TheHFL responds by listing thenames in the phonebook. When itsays the name you want to call, forexample, Eric, press the Talkbutton, and then say ‘‘Call.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Would you liketo call Eric?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Calling.’’ Onceconnected, you will hear theperson you called through theaudio speakers. To change thevolume, use the audio systemvolume knob.
This operation clears the HFL ofyour passcode, your paired phones,and all names in the HFL phonebook.Clearing is recommended before yousell your vehicle.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘System.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘System optionsare setup and clear.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebookoptions are store, edit, delete,receive contact, and list.’’
2.
3.
4.
1.
1.
2.
3.
2.
To call a name from the phonebook list,do this:
To clear the system, do this:
Clearing the System
HandsFreeLink
Features
321
TM
06/08/12 19:01:33 31SJA620 0326
< >
<>
To change from French to English, dothis:
To change from English to French, dothis:
If there are paired phoneswithout French name tags, thefollowing prompts will continue.
The HFL response is, for example,‘‘Quel est le nom Français pour
Paul’s phone ?’’ Press andrelease the Talk button. After thebeep, say ‘‘Téléphone de Paul.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘Quel est lenom Français pour Pat’sphone ?’’ Press and release theTalk button. Say ‘‘Téléphone dePat.’’ After all paired phonesmissing a French name tag are re-recorded, the HFL will prompt,‘‘Retour au menu principal.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘ChangerLangue.’’ The HFL response is,‘‘Anglais ou Francais?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Changelanguage.’’ The HFL response is‘‘English or French?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Français.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Vous avezsélectionné Français. Les nomsenregistrés en mode Anglais neseront pas accessible en modeFrançais. Voulez-vous continuer?
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Oui.’’ If thereare no paired phones withoutFrench name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘La langue a étéchangée. Retour au menu principal.’’
If there are paired phones withoutFrench name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘Pour que le systèmeidentifie les téléphones qui ont étéjumelés dans une autre langue, lesnoms des téléphones doivent êtreré-enregistrés.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘English.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘You haveselected English. Name tags thatwere stored while in French modewill not be accessible in Englishmode. Would you like tocontinue?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ If thereare no paired phones withoutEnglish name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘The language hasbeen changed. Returning to themain menu.’’
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
HandsFreeLink
Changing LanguageCanadian models only
322
NOTE:
TM
06/08/12 19:01:44 31SJA620 0327
< >
<>
If there are paired phones withoutEnglish name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘The language has beenchanged. For the system to identifyphones that were paired while inanother language, the phone namesneed to be re-recorded.’’
If there are paired phoneswithout English name tags, thefollowing prompts will continue.
The HFL says, for example, ‘‘Whatis the English name for
Téléphone de Paul ?’’ Pressand release the Talk button. Afterthe beep, say ‘‘Paul’s phone. ’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘What is theEnglish name for Téléphone dePat ?’’ Press and release the Talkbutton. After the beep, say ‘‘Pat’sphone.’’ After all paired phonesmissing an English name tag arere-recorded, the HFL will say‘‘Returning to the main menu.’’
When using voice control, the HFLcall is placed on hold, or the HFLstops its voice recognition. Tooperate the HFL again, press theTalk button. Then after the beep, saythe appropriate command.
In addition, you cannot use the HFLwhile using AcuraLink.
4.
HandsFreeLink
HFL Limitations
Features
323
NOTE:
TM
06/08/12 19:01:50 31SJA620 0328
On models with navigation system
Whenever you shift to reverse (R)with the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the rear view is shownon the navigation system screen.
For the best picture, always keep therearview camera clean, and do notcover the camera lens. To avoidscratching the lens when you clean it,use a moist, soft cloth.
Since the rearview camera displayarea is limited, you should alwaysback up slowly and carefully, andlook behind you for obstacles.
Rearview Camera and Monitor
324
REAR VIEW CAMERA
06/08/12 19:01:54 31SJA620 0329
Before you begin driving yourvehicle, you should know whatgasoline to use and how to check thelevels of important fluids. You alsoneed to know how to properly storeluggage or packages. Theinformation in this section will helpyou. If you plan to add anyaccessories to your vehicle, pleaseread the information in this sectionfirst.
.............................Break-in Period . 326.................Fuel Recommendation . 326
.........Service Station Procedures . 327.....................................Refueling .327
......Tighten Fuel Cap Message .329Opening and Closing
.................................the Hood .329....................................Oil Check .331
..............Engine Coolant Check .331...............................Fuel Economy . 332
...Accessories and Modifications . 333.............................Carrying Cargo . 335
Before Driving
Before
Driving
325
06/08/12 19:01:58 31SJA620 0330
Help assure your vehicle’s futurereliability and performance by payingextra attention to how you driveduring the first 600 miles (1,000 km).During this period:
Avoid full-throttle starts and rapidacceleration.
Avoid hard braking for the first200 miles (300 km).
Do not change the oil until thescheduled maintenance time.
You should also follow theserecommendations with anoverhauled or exchanged engine, orwhen the brakes are replaced.
Do not tow a trailer.
We recommend quality gasolinescontaining detergent additives thathelp prevent fuel system and enginedeposits.
In addition, in order to maintain goodperformance, fuel economy, andemissions control, we stronglyrecommend, in areas where it isavailable, the use of gasoline thatdoes NOT contain manganese-basedfuel additives such as MMT.Use of gasoline with these additivesmay adversely affect performance,and cause the malfunction indicatorlamp on your instrument panel tocome on. If this happens, contactyour authorized dealer for service.
Your vehicle is designed to operateon premium unleaded gasoline with apump octane of 91 or higher. If thisoctane grade is unavailable, regularunleaded gasoline with a pumpoctane of 87 or higher may be usedtemporarily. The use of regularunleaded gasoline can cause metallicknocking noises in the engine andwill result in decreased engineperformance. The long-term use ofregular-grade gasoline can lead toengine damage.
Break-in Period Fuel Recommendation
Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation
326
06/08/12 19:02:07 31SJA620 0331
CONTINUED
Park with the driver’s side closestto the service station pump.
Some gasoline today is blended withoxygenates such as ethanol orMTBE. Your vehicle is designed tooperate on oxygenated gasolinecontaining up to 10% ethanol byvolume and up to 15% MTBE byvolume. Do not use gasolinecontaining methanol.
If you notice any undesirableoperating symptoms, try anotherservice station or switch to anotherbrand of gasoline.
For further important fuel-relatedinformation, please refer to your
.Open the fuel fill door by pressingthe button on the driver’s door.(To open the fuel fill doormanually, see page .)
1.
2.
446
Service Station Procedures
Refueling
Quick Start Guide
Before
Driving
327
FUEL FILL CAP
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE BUTTON
TETHER
Stop the engine, and keepheat, sparks, and flamesaway.Handle fuel only outdoors.Wipe up spills immediately.
Gasoline is highly flammableand explosive. You can beburned or seriously injuredwhen handling fuel.
06/08/12 19:02:16 31SJA620 0332
Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.You may hear a hissing sound aspressure inside the tank escapes.Place the cap in the holder on thefuel fill door.
Stop filling the tank after the fuelnozzle automatically clicks off. Donot try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank. Leavesome room for the fuel to expandwith temperature changes.
Screw the fuel fill cap back onuntil it clicks at least once. If youdo not properly tighten the cap,you will see a ‘‘TIGHTEN FUELCAP’’ message on the multi-information display (see rightcolumn on this page), and themalfunction indicator lamp mayalso come on (see page ).
Push the fuel fill door closed untilit latches.
even though the tank is not full,there may be a problem with yourvehicle’s fuel vapor recoverysystem. The system helps keepfuel vapor from going into theatmosphere. Try filling at anotherpump. If this does not fix theproblem, consult your dealer.
3.
4.
5.
6.
444
If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking off
Service Station Procedures
328
06/08/12 19:02:22 31SJA620 0333
Park the vehicle, and set theparking brake. Pull the hoodrelease lever located under thelower left corner of the dashboard.The hood will pop up slightly.
Your vehicle’s on board diagnosticsystem will detect a loose or missingfuel fill cap as an evaporative systemleak. The first time a leak is detecteda ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ messageappears on the multi-informationdisplay. Turn the engine off, andconfirm the fuel fill cap is installed. Ifit is, loosen it, then retighten it untilit clicks at least once. The messageshould go off after several days ofnormal driving once you tighten or
replace the fuel fill cap. To scroll toanother message, press the INFObutton. The ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’message will appear each time yourestart the engine until the systemturns the message off.
If the system still detects a leak inthe vehicle’s evaporative emissionssystem, the malfunction indicatorlamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fillcap was not already tightened, turnthe engine off, and check orretighten the fuel fill cap until itclicks at least once. The MIL shouldgo off after several days of normaldriving once the cap is tightened orreplaced. If the MIL does not go off,have your vehicle inspected by adealer. For more information, seepage .
1.
444
CONTINUED
Opening and Closing the HoodTighten Fuel Cap Message
Service Station Procedures
Before
Driving
329
HOOD RELEASE LEVER
06/08/12 19:02:29 31SJA620 0334
Lift the hood up most of the way.The hydraulic supports will lift itup the rest of the way and hold itup.
If the hood latch handle movesstiffly, or if you can open the hoodwithout lifting the handle, themechanism should be cleaned andlubricated.
Reach between the hood and thefront bumper with your finger.Slide the latch handle up.
To close the hood, lower the hood toabout a foot (30 cm) above thefender, then firmly press down onthe front edge of the hood. Makesure it is securely latched.
3.2.
Service Station Procedures
330
LATCH
06/08/12 19:02:36 31SJA620 0335
Remove the dipstick again, andcheck the level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.
If it is near or below the lowermark, see onpage .
Wait a few minutes after turning theengine off before you check the oil.
Remove the dipstick (orange loop).
Wipe the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel.
Insert the dipstick all the way backinto its hole.
Look at the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Make sure it isbetween the MAX and MIN lines. Ifit is below the MIN line, see
on page .
4.
1.
2.
3.395
398
CONTINUED
Engine Coolant Check
Adding Engine Oil
Oil Check
AddingEngine Coolant
Service Station Procedures
Before
Driving
331
RESERVE TANK
MAX
MIN
LOWER MARK
UPPER MARK
DIPSTICK
06/08/12 19:02:47 31SJA620 0336
Combine several short trips intoone.
The air conditioning puts an extraload on the engine which makes ituse more fuel. Use the fresh-airventilation when possible.
Refer toon page for information
about checking other items on yourvehicle.
Try to maintain a constant speed.Every time you slow down andspeed up, your vehicle uses extrafuel. Use cruise control whenappropriate.
Always maintain your vehicleaccording to the maintenancemessages. See
(page ).
an underinflated tirecauses more ‘‘rolling resistance,’’which uses more fuel.
The build-up of snow or mud onyour vehicle’s underside addsweight and rolling resistance.Frequent cleaning helps your fuelmileage and reduces the chance ofcorrosion.
Drive moderately. Rapidacceleration, abrupt cornering,and hard braking use more fuel.
Always drive in the highest gearpossible.
388
388
For example,
Improving Fuel EconomyOwner’s MaintenanceChecks
Owner’sMaintenance Checks
Service Station Procedures, Fuel Economy
332
06/08/12 19:02:55 31SJA620 0337
When properly installed, cellularphones, alarms, two-way radios, andlow-powered audio systems shouldnot interfere with your vehicle’scomputer controlled systems, suchas your airbags and anti-lock brakes.
Before installing any accessory:
Make sure the accessory does notobscure any lights, or interferewith proper vehicle operation orperformance.
Modifying your vehicle, or installingsome non-Acura accessories, canmake your vehicle unsafe. Beforeyou make any modifications or addany accessories, be sure to read thefollowing information.
Your dealer has Acura accessoriesthat allow you to personalize yourvehicle. These accessories havebeen designed and approved for yourvehicle, and are covered by warranty.
Before installing any electronicaccessory, have the installercontact your dealer. If possible,have your dealer inspect the finalinstallation.
Be sure electronic accessories donot overload electrical circuits(see page ) or interfere withthe proper operation of yourvehicle.
Do not install accessories on theside pillars or across the rearwindows. In these areas,accessories may interfere withproper operation of the sidecurtain airbags.
Although non-Acura accessories mayfit on your vehicle, they may notmeet factory specifications, andcould adversely affect your vehicle’shandling and stability.
447
Accessories
Accessories and Modifications
Before
Driving
333
Improper accessories ormodifications can affect yourvehicle’s handling, stability, andperformance, and cause acrash in which you can be hurtor killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regardingaccessories and modifications.
06/08/12 19:03:04 31SJA620 0338
Larger or smaller wheels and tirescan interfere with the operation ofyour vehicle’s anti-lock brakes andother systems.
Modifying your steering wheel orany other part of your vehicle’ssafety systems could make thesystems ineffective.
If you plan to modify your vehicle,consult your dealer.
Raising your vehicle with a non-Acura suspension kit can affectthe handling and stability.
Lowering the vehicle with a non-Acura suspension kit thatsignificantly reduces groundclearance can allow theundercarriage to hit speed bumpsor other raised objects, whichcould cause the airbags to deploy.
Non-Acura wheels can causeexcessive stress on suspensioncomponents and are notcompatible with the tire pressuremonitoring system.
Removing parts from your vehicle,or replacing components with non-Acura components could seriouslyaffect your vehicle’s handling,stability, and reliability.
Here are some examples:
Modifying Your Vehicle
Accessories and Modifications
334
06/08/12 19:03:11 31SJA620 0339
Your vehicle has several convenientstorage areas:
Glove boxFront door and seat-back pocketsConsole compartment
In addition, the trunk pass-throughallows you to carry longer items.
However, carrying too much cargo,or improperly storing it, can affectyour vehicle’s handling, stability,stopping distance, and tires, andmake it unsafe. Before carrying anytype of cargo, be sure to read thefollowing pages.
TrunkUtility pocket
Carrying Cargo
Before
Driving
335
TRUNK SEAT-BACK POCKETS GLOVE BOX
UTILITY POCKETCONSOLE COMPARTMENT FRONT DOOR POCKET
06/08/12 19:03:20 31SJA620 0340
- ×
Steps for Determining Correct LoadLimit:The maximum load for your vehicle
is 850 lbs (385 kg) for U.S. vehicles,and 395 kg for Canadian vehicles.This figure includes the total weightof all occupants, cargo, andaccessories, and the tongue load ifyou are towing a trailer.
Locate the statement, ‘‘thecombined weight of occupants andcargo should never exceed 850pounds’’ on your vehicle’s placard.[The placard is on the driver’sdoorjamb.]
Determine the combined weightof the driver and passengers thatwill be riding in your vehicle. (Fiveis the seating capacity of yourvehicle.)
Subtract the combined weight ofthe driver and passengers from850 pounds or 385 kilograms. [395kg Canada.]
The resulting figure equals theavailable amount of cargo andluggage load capacity.For example, if the amount equals850 lbs and there will be five 150 lbpassengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo andluggage load capacity is 100 lbs.(850 750 (5 150) = 100 lbs.)
In addition, the total weight of thevehicle, all occupants, accessories,cargo, and trailer tongue loadmust not exceed the gross vehicleweight rating (GVWR) or thegross axle weight rating (GAWR).Both are on a label on the driver’sdoorjamb.
If your vehicle will be towing atrailer, load from your trailer willbe transferred to your vehicle.Consult this manual to determinehow this reduces the availablecargo and luggage load capacity ofyour vehicle (see page ).
Determine the combined weightof luggage and cargo being loadedon the vehicle. That weight maynot safely exceed the availablecargo and luggage load capacitycalculated in step 4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
373
Carrying Cargo
Load Limits
336
Overloading or improperloading can affect handling andstability and cause a crash inwhich you can be hurt or killed.
Follow all load limits and otherloading guidelines in thismanual.
06/08/12 19:03:29 31SJA620 0341
Store or secure all items that couldbe thrown around and hurtsomeone during a crash.
Do not put any items on top of therear shelf. They can block yourview and be thrown around thevehicle during a crash.
Be sure items placed on the floorbehind the front seats cannot rollunder the seats and interfere withthe pedals or seat operation.
Keep the glove box closed whiledriving. If it is open, a passengercould injure their knees during acrash or sudden stop.
Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor of the trunk, placing theheaviest items on the bottom andas far forward as possible.
If you carry large items thatprevent you from closing the trunklid, exhaust gas can enter thepassenger area. To avoid thepossibility of
, follow the instructionson page .
If you carry any items on a roofrack, be sure the total weight ofthe rack and the items does notexceed the maximum allowableweight. Please contact your dealerfor further information.
If you carry any items extendingthrough the trunk pass-through,tie down or secure all items thatcould be thrown around thevehicle and hurt someone during acrash or sudden stop.
56
carbon monoxidepoisoning
Carrying Items in the PassengerCompartment
Carrying Cargo in the Trunk or ona Roof Rack
Carrying Cargo
Before
Driving
337
06/08/12 19:03:37 31SJA620 0342
The cargo floor hooks can also beused to tie down and secure items onthe floor.
There are hooks on the floor andboth sides of the trunk. They can beused to install the cargo net forsecuring items. The side cargohooks are designed to hold lightitems (maximum load: 6 lbs or 3 kgsfor each hook). Heavy objects maydamage the side hooks.
Cargo Hooks
Carrying Cargo
338
SIDE CARGO HOOKS CARGO FLOOR HOOKS
06/08/12 19:03:42 31SJA620 0343
This section gives you tips onstarting the engine under variousconditions, and how to operate theautomatic transmission. It alsoincludes important information onparking your vehicle, the brakingsystem, the SH-AWD system, thevehicle stability assist (VSA) system,the tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS), the collision mitigationbrake system (CMBS), and facts youneed if you are planning to tow atrailer.
........................Preparing to Drive . 340.......................Starting the Engine . 341
Check Starting System.................................Message . 342
..............Automatic Transmission . 343...........................SH-AWD System . 350
...........................................Parking . 351.............................Braking System . 352
................Anti-lock Brakes(ABS) . 353Collision Mitigation Brake System
......................................(CMBS) . 355Tire Pressure
...Monitoring System (TPMS) . 365Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)
........................................System . 371...........................Towing a Trailer . 373
...................Towing Your Vehicle . 378
Driving
Driving
339
06/08/12 19:03:46 31SJA620 0344
Make sure all windows, mirrors,and outside lights are clean andunobstructed. Remove frost, snow,or ice.
Check that the hood is fully closed.
Check that any items you may becarrying are stored properly orfastened down securely.
Check the seat adjustment (seepage ).
Check the steering wheeladjustment (see page ).
Make sure the doors and thetrunk are securely closed andlocked.
Fasten your seat belt. Check thatyour passengers have fastenedtheir seat belts (see page ).
You should do the following checksand adjustments before you driveyour vehicle.
When you start the engine, checkthe gauges and indicators in theinstrument panel, and themessages on the multi-informationdisplay (see pages , and
).
Visually check the tires. If a tirelooks low, use a gauge to check itspressure (see page ).
Check the adjustment of theinside and outside mirrors (seepage ).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
17
78
155
158
147
415
61 70
Preparing to Drive
340
06/08/19 14:26:29 31SJA620 0345
If the engine does not start within15 seconds, or starts but stallsright away, repeat step 4 with theaccelerator pedal pressed halfwaydown. If the engine starts, releasepressure on the accelerator pedalso the engine does not race.
If the engine fails to start, pressthe accelerator pedal all the waydown, and hold it there whilestarting to clear flooding. If theengine still does not start, returnto step 5.
Apply the parking brake.
In cold weather, turn off allelectrical accessories to reducethe drain on the battery.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark. Press on the brake pedal.
Your vehicle’s starting system has anauto control mode. When you turnthe ignition switch to the START(III) position, this feature keeps theengine’s starter motor running untilthe engine starts. Follow theseinstructions to start the engine:
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition switch tothe START (III) position, thenrelease the ignition switch. You donot need to hold the ignitionswitch in the START (III) positionto start the engine. Depending onthe outside temperature, thestarter motor runs for about 6 to 9
seconds until the engine starts.
If you hold the ignition switch inthe START (III) position for morethan 7 seconds, the starter motor,depending on the outsidetemperature, runs for about 10 to25 seconds until the engine starts.
If the engine does not start, wait atleast 10 seconds before tryingagain.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
150
Starting the Engine
Driving
341
The engine is harder to start in coldweather. Also, the thinner air f ound ataltitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400meters) adds to this problem.
The immobilizer system protects yourvehicle f rom thef t. If an improperly-coded key (or other device) is used, theengine’s f uel system is disabled. Formore inf ormation, see page .
06/08/12 19:04:05 31SJA620 0346
If there is a problem with thestarting system, you will see a‘‘CHECK STARTING SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay when the ignition switch isturned to the ON (II) position. Youwill also see this message when theauto control mode of the startingsystem has a problem.
If this message is on, the ignitionswitch has to be held in theSTART (III) position manuallyuntil the engine starts. Theignition switch can be held in thatposition up to 15 seconds.
Even though you may be able tostart the engine manually withoutthe auto control mode of the startingsystem, have your dealer inspectyour vehicle.
Starting the Engine
Check Starting System Message
342
06/08/12 19:04:10 31SJA620 0347
These indicators on the instrumentpanel show which position the shiftlever is in. In the SequentialSportShift Mode, the ‘‘M’’ indicatornext to the ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on,and the illuminated number underthe low oil pressure indicator showsyou the gear you have selected.
To shift from Park to any position,press firmly on the brake pedal andslide the lever along the guide on theconsole. You cannot shift out of Parkwhen the ignition switch is in theLOCK (0) or the ACCESSORY (I)position.
The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it flashes while driving (inany shift position), it indicates apossible problem in the transmission.
If the malfunction indicator lampcomes on along with the ‘‘D’’indicator, there is a problem with theautomatic transmission controlsystem. Avoid rapid acceleration, andhave the transmission checked byyour dealer as soon as possible.
When the ‘‘D’’ indicator warns of apossible problem with thetransmission, you will see a ‘‘CHECKTRANSMISSION’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).78
Shift Lever Position Indicators Shifting
Automatic Transmission
Driving
343
06/08/12 19:04:18 31SJA620 0348
-
- -
-
-
-
Do this:Press the brake pedal, thenmove the shift lever.
Move the lever.
To shift from:P to R
R to NN to DD toDD to DD to NN to RR to P
3
3
To avoid transmission damage, cometo a complete stop before shiftinginto Park. The shift lever must be inPark before you can turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position, orremove the built-in key from theignition switch.
Press the brakepedal to shift from Park to reverse.To shift from neutral to reverse,come to a complete stop and thenshift.
Your vehicle has a reverse lockout soyou cannot accidentally shift toreverse from neutral or any otherdriving position when the vehiclespeed exceeds 5 6 mph (8 10km/h).
If you cannot shift to reverse whenthe vehicle is stopped, press thebrake pedal, slowly shift to neutral,and then shift to reverse.
If there is a problem in the reverselockout system, or your vehicle’sbattery is disconnected or goes dead,you cannot shift to reverse. (Refer to
on page ).
Use neutral if youneed to restart a stalled engine, or ifit is necessary to stop briefly withthe engine idling. Shift to the Parkposition if you need to leave yourvehicle for any reason. Press on thebrake pedal when you are movingthe shift lever from neutral toanother gear.
Use this position foryour normal driving. Thetransmission automatically selects asuitable gear (1 through 5) for yourspeed and acceleration. You maynotice the transmission shifting up athigher engine speeds when theengine is cold. This helps the enginewarm up faster.
If you have done all of the above andstill cannot move the lever out ofPark, see onpage .
This position mechani-cally locks the transmission. UsePark whenever you are turning off orstarting the engine. To shift out ofPark, you must press on the brakepedal and have your foot off theaccelerator pedal. Move the shiftlever to the right to shift out of Park.
348
348
Automatic Transmission
Reverse (R)
Shift Lock Release
Neutral (N)
Drive (D)
Shift Lock Release
Park (P)
344
06/08/12 19:04:26 31SJA620 0349
+ -
+
-
-
+
With the shift lever in ‘‘D’’ position,you can select the SequentialSportShift mode to shift gears muchlike a manual transmission, butwithout a clutch pedal.
To enter the Sequential SportShiftmode, move the shift lever further tothe driver’s side. To return to ‘‘D,’’move the shift lever to thepassenger’s side.In Sequential SportShift mode, eachtime you push forward on the shiftlever, the transmission shifts to ahigher gear. Pull back on the lever todownshift. The number of the gearselected is displayed on theinstrument panel.
When you move the shift lever from‘‘D’’ to ‘‘M’’ position, the displayshows the selected gear.
While in the Sequential SportShiftmode, you can also shift up or downusing the (right side) or (leftside) paddle shifters on the right andleft side of the steering wheel.
For up shift, press the right side ( )paddle shifter.For down shift, press the left side( ) paddle shifter.
CONTINUED
Sequential SportShift Mode
Automatic Transmission
Driving
345
SELECTED GEAR
( ) DOWN SHIFT
( ) UP SHIFT
PADDLE SHIFTER
06/08/12 19:04:35 31SJA620 0350
→
→
→
→
The transmission may automaticallydownshift from the higher gear tothe lower gear under theseconditions:
Driving on level roads and downhill
Driving uphill
Downshifting gives you more powerwhen climbing, and provides enginebraking when going down a steep hill.
The gear indicator will flash thenumber of the lower gear severaltimes, then return to the higher gear.
To shift from
4 3
5 4
To shift from
4 3
5 4
Speed range
under 17 mph(27 km/h)
under 38 mph(60 km/h)
When you accelerate away from astop, the transmission starts in firstgear. You have to manually upshiftbetween first and fifth gears. Makesure you upshift before the enginespeed reaches the tachometer’s redzone.
The transmission also shiftsautomatically as the vehicle comes toa complete stop. It downshifts to firstgear when the vehicle speed is under8 mph (13 km/h).
If you try to manually downshift at aspeed that would cause the engine toexceed the redline in a lower gear,the transmission does not downshift.
If the vehicle speed slows to belowthe redline of the selected lower gearposition while the indicator isflashing, the transmissiondownshifts, and the display showsthe selected lower gear.
Speed range
under 41 mph(65 km/h)
under 47 mph(75 km/h)
The transmission remains in theselected gear (5, 4, 3, 2, or 1). Thereis no automatic downshift when youpush the accelerator pedal to thefloor.
Automatic Transmission
346
06/08/12 19:04:45 31SJA620 0351
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
The table shows the speed rangesfor upshifting and downshifting. When you are in Sequential
SportShift mode, and the vehicle isstopped, push forward on the shiftlever to shift to second gear. Youwill see ‘‘2’’ in the display. Startingout in second gear will help toreduce wheelspin in deep snow oron a slippery surface.
If you start out in second gear, thetransmission will be fixed in thatgear.
To shift from
1 2
2 3
3 4
4 5
To shift from
3 2
4 3
5 4
The transmission will notautomatically downshift to first geareven when the vehicle speed isunder 8 mph (13 km/h). You need toshift down to first gear manually.
Speed range
over 0 mph(0 km/h)
over 8 mph(13 km/h)
over 17 mph(27 km/h)
over 37 mph(60 km/h)
Speed range
under 56 mph(90 km/h)
under 93 mph(150 km/h)
under 130 mph(209 km/h)
CONTINUED
Starting in Second Gear
Automatic Transmission
Driving
347
06/08/12 19:04:53 31SJA620 0352
-If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, the enginespeed will enter into the tachometer’sred zone. If this occurs, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce therpm below the red zone.
Make sure the ignition switch is inthe LOCK (0) position.
Set the parking brake.
Before downshifting, make sure theengine will not go into thetachometer’s red zone.
This allows you to move the shiftlever out of Park if the normalmethod of pushing on the brakepedal does not work.
This position issimilar to D, except only the firstthree gears are selected. Use Dwhen towing a trailer in hilly terrain,or to provide engine braking whengoing down a steep hill. D can alsokeep the transmission from cyclingbetween third, fourth, and fifth gearsin stop-and-go driving.
For faster acceleration when in D orD, you can get the transmission toautomatically downshift by pushingthe accelerator pedal to the floor.The transmission will shift down one,two, or three gears, depending onyour speed.
To release the reverse lockout, makesure the ignition switch is in theACCESSORY(I) position.
1.
2.
3
3
3
Engine Speed Limiter Shift Lock ReleaseDrive (D )
Automatic Transmission
3
348
06/08/12 19:05:01 31SJA620 0353
If you need to use the shift lockrelease, it means your vehicle isdeveloping a problem. Have thevehicle checked by a dealer.
Put a cloth on the edge of the shiftlock release slot cover next to theshift lever. Use a small flat-tippedscrewdriver or a metal fingernailfile to remove the cover. Carefullypry on the edge of the cover.
Insert a built-in key into the shiftlock release slot.
Push down on the built-in key, andmove the shift lever out of Park toneutral.
Remove the built-in key from theshift lock release slot, thenreinstall the cover. Make sure thenotch on the cover is on the driver’sside. Press the brake pedal, andrestart the engine.
To release the reverse lockout,move the shift lever from neutralto reverse, then to Park.
3. 4.
5.
6.
Automatic Transmission
Driving
349
COVER SHIFT LOCK RELEASE SLOT
06/08/12 19:05:09 31SJA620 0354
Each torque indicator is displayedas a bar graph divided into 5segments. The number ofsegments represents the amountof torque distributed to eachwheel.
The SH-AWD torque distributionmonitor on the multi-informationdisplay shows you the amount oftorque being sent to the wheels.Each wheel: right front (RF), leftfront (LF), right rear (RR), and leftrear (LR), has its own torqueindicator.
When cruise control is on whiledriving, the torque distributionmonitor is not shown.
The SH-AWD system is a full timeall-wheel-drive system thatautomatically controls and transfersvarying amounts of engine torque toall wheels independently, accordingto the driving conditions.
When there is only a slight change intorque distribution while driving,such as cruising on level roads at thesame speed, the torque distributionmonitor may stop displaying theamount of torque. This is not asystem problem. The monitor willshow the amount if the systemsenses any change in torquedistribution.
While the SH-AWD system helps toenhance the vehicle’s drivingstability in all situations, it is stillyour responsibility to drive andcorner at reasonable speeds and toleave a sufficient margin of safety.
SH-AWD Torque DistributionMonitor
SH-AWD System
350
TORQUE INDICATOR
TORQUE INDICATOR
06/08/12 19:05:16 31SJA620 0355
If the SH-AWD indicator on theinstrument panel stays on, and themulti-information display shows anSH-AWD message, there is aproblem with the system. Yourvehicle still has normal front-wheeldrive with vehicle stability assist(VSA), but does not have theadvantages of SH-AWD. Have yourvehicle checked by a dealer as soonas possible.
Check the indicator on theinstrument panel to verify that thesecurity system is set.
If the vehicle is facing downhill,turn the front wheels toward thecurb.
If the vehicle is facing uphill, turnthe front wheels away from thecurb.
Never park over dry leaves, tallgrass, or other flammablematerials. The hot three waycatalytic converter could causethese materials to catch on fire.
Make sure the parking brake isfully released before driving away.Driving with the parking brakepartially set can overheat ordamage the rear brakes.
Always use the parking brake whenyou park your vehicle. Make surethe parking brake is set firmly, oryour vehicle may roll if it is parkedon an incline.
Set the parking brake before you putthe transmission in Park. This keepsthe vehicle from moving and puttingpressure on the parking mechanismin the transmission.
Make sure the moonroof and thewindows are closed.
Turn off the lights.
Place any packages, valuables, etc.,in the trunk or take them with you.
Lock the doors.
SH-AWD System, Parking
Parking
Parking Tips
Driving
351
06/08/12 19:05:26 31SJA620 0356
Your vehicle is equipped with discbrakes at all four wheels. A powerassist helps reduce the effort neededon the brake pedal. The brake pedalassist function increases the forceyou apply to the brake pedal duringan emergency stop. When the brakepedal assist is activated, the e-pretensioners (if equipped) tightenfront seat belts (see page ). Theanti-lock brake system (ABS) helpsyou retain steering control whenbraking very hard (see page ).
Resting your foot on the brake pedalapplies the brakes slightly. Thisbuilds up heat, and reduces brakeeffectiveness and brake pad life. Inaddition, fuel economy can bereduced. It also keeps your brakelights on all the time, confusingdrivers behind you.
The hydraulic system that operatesthe brakes has two separate circuits.Each circuit works diagonally acrossthe vehicle (the left-front brake isconnected with the right-rear brake,etc.). If one circuit should develop aproblem, you will still have brakingat two wheels.
Constant application of the brakeswhen going down a long hill buildsup heat and reduces their effective-ness. Use the engine to assist thebrakes by taking your foot off theaccelerator and downshifting to alower gear.
Check the brakes after drivingthrough deep water. Apply thebrakes moderately to see if they feelnormal. If not, apply them gently andfrequently until they do. Be extracautious in your driving.
If the brake pads need replacing, youwill hear a distinctive, metallicscreeching sound when you applythe brake pedal. If you do not havethe brake pads replaced, they willscreech all the time. It is normal forthe brakes to occasionally squeal orsqueak when you apply them.
24
353
Braking System
Braking System Design
Brake Pad Wear Indicators
352
06/08/12 19:05:33 31SJA620 0357
The anti-lock brake system (ABS)helps prevent the wheels fromlocking up, and helps you retainsteering control by pumping thebrakes rapidly, much faster than aperson can do it.
When the ABS indicator comes on,you will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message in the multi-information display.
If this indicator comes on, the anti-lock function of the braking systemhas shut down. The brakes still worklike a conventional system, butwithout anti-lock. You should haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible.
You will feel a pulsation in the brakepedal when the ABS activates, andyou may hear some noise. This isnormal: it is the ABS rapidlypumping the brakes. On drypavement, you will need to press onthe brake pedal very hard before theABS activates. However, you mayfeel the ABS activate immediately ifyou are trying to stop on snow or ice.
Let the ABS work for you by alwayskeeping firm, steady pressure on thebrake pedal. This is sometimesreferred to as ‘‘stomp and steer.’’
The electronic brake distribution(EBD) system, which is part of theABS, also balances the front-to-rearbraking distribution according tovehicle loading.
You should never pump the brake pedal.
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
ABS Indicator
Driving
353
06/08/12 19:05:40 31SJA620 0358
on loose oruneven surfaces, such as gravel orsnow, than a vehicle without anti-lock.
It only helps with steeringcontrol during braking.
such as trying to take acorner too fast or making a suddenlane change. Always drive at a safespeed for the road and weatherconditions.
Always steer moderatelywhen you are braking hard. Severeor sharp steering wheel movementcan still cause your vehicle to veerinto oncoming traffic or off the road.
If the ABS indicator and the brakesystem indicator come on together,and the parking brake is fullyreleased, the EBD system may alsobe shut down.
Test your brakes as instructed onpage . If the brakes feel normal,drive slowly and have your vehiclerepaired by your dealer as soon aspossible. Avoid sudden hard brakingwhich could cause the rear wheels tolock up and possibly lead to a loss ofcontrol.
The VSA indicator will come onalong with the ABS indicator.
445
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
A vehicle with ABS may require alonger distance to stop
Important Safety RemindersABS does not reduce the time ordistance it takes to stop thevehicle.
ABS will not prevent a skid thatresults from changing directionabruptly,
ABS cannot prevent the loss ofstability.
354
06/08/12 19:05:46 31SJA620 0359
The CMBS does not activate if thespeed difference between yourvehicles is less than 10 mph (15km/h). CMBS may also notactivate if you turn the steeringwheel to avoid the collision.
When the CMBS activates, the brakelights also come on.
The collision mitigation brakesystem (CMBS) can assist you whenthere is a possibility of your vehiclehitting the vehicle in front of you. Itis designed to reduce the speed ofyour vehicle before an unavoidablecollision occurs and, if possible, toalert you to a potential collision whilethere is time to prevent it. Here is abrief description of what the CMBScan do:
When your speed is above 10 mph(15 km/h), the CMBS radarsensor in the front grille can sensea vehicle ahead of you. When yourvehicle gets too close to thevehicle ahead of you, the systemmay activate a warning beep,causing automatic application ofthe brakes, and causing thee-pretensioners to tighten thefront seat belts (see page ).
The CMBS consists of a radarsensor in the front grille, a brakeactuator in the engine compartment,an indicator on the instrument panel,seat belt e-pretensioners on the frontseats, and an on/off switch on thedashboard.
24
If equipped
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
Overview
Driving
355
RADAR SENSOR
BRAKE ACTUATOR
SEAT BELTE-PRETENSIONER
06/08/12 19:05:53 31SJA620 0360
The radar sensor is located behindthe Acura emblem in the front grille.If the emblem is covered with mud,dirt, dead leaves, wet snow, etc., or ifyou put a sticker on it, the CMBS willautomatically shut off, and theCMBS indicator on the instrumentpanel will come on. You will also seea CHECK CMBS RADAR SENSORmessage on the multi-informationdisplay for about 5 seconds.
Always keep the emblem clean. If itgets dirty, clean it with water or amild detergent. Never use chemicalsolvents or polishing powder.
Do not allow anything to impact theradar sensor or the emblem. If eitherof these parts receives a strongimpact, turn off the system bypressing the CMBS off switch, andhave your vehicle checked by adealer. If the front grille ever needsto be repaired, consult a dealer first.
There are three bolts on the sides ofthe radar sensor. Do not tamper withthese bolts, or you may cause thesystem to malfunction.
If the front emblem or the radarsensor ever needs to be removed,take your vehicle to a dealer.
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
Radar Sensor
356
EMBLEM
BOLTS(Do not tamper)
06/08/12 19:06:00 31SJA620 0361
When the CMBS is on, the radarsensor constantly scans for vehiclesahead of you. This means thatdriving on a road with a few or novehicles could cause a CHECKCMBS RADAR SENSOR message toappear on the multi-informationdisplay. This is normal and not acause for concern.
The radar sensor may not alwaysscan as intended. Here are twoexamples:
The tires are not correctlymaintained. Always make sure thetire pressures are correct (seepage ), and that the tires arethe correct size and in goodcondition (see Tires on page ).
Your vehicle is tilted because of aheavy load in the rear or frommodifications to the suspension.Do not overload your vehicle (seeCarrying Cargo on page ), anddo not make any modifications tothe suspension (see Accessoriesand Modifications on page ).
335
333
415
415
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
Driving
357
06/08/12 19:06:05 31SJA620 0362
If the system senses a likely collisionwith a vehicle or object ahead of you,it alerts you with an audible and avisual alarm.
The audible alarm is a constantbeeping sound; the visual alert is anamber colored BRAKE message thatflashes in the multi-informationdisplay. If these alarms come on,take the appropriate means toprevent a collision (apply the brakes,change lanes, etc.).
To turn the CMBS off, press theCMBS OFF switch on the dashboardfor about 1 second. When you do this,a beeper sounds, a CMBS indicatoron the instrument panel comes on,and a CMBS OFF message appearson the multi-information display. Toturn the system back on, press theswitch again for about 1 second.
Collision Alarm CMBS OFF Switch
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
358
CMBS OFF SWITCH
06/08/12 19:06:12 31SJA620 0363
The CMBS will automaticallyrecover when these conditions areimproved.
Any of the conditions below cancause the CMBS to shut off. Whenthe system shuts off, the CMBSindicator in the instrument panelcomes on, and a CHECK CMBSSYSTEM message appears on themulti-information display for about 5seconds.
An abnormal tire condition isdetected (wrong tire size, flat tire,etc.).
Extended off-road or mountainousdriving.
Driving your vehicle with theparking brake applied.
Driving your vehicle in badweather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
A dirty emblem on the front grille.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the CMBS isturned on if it was on previously.
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
Automatic Shut Off
Driving
359
06/08/12 19:06:20 31SJA620 0364
The CMBS indicator normally comeson under these conditions:
When you manually turn off thesystem.
When the system shuts offautomatically.
When you drive in bad weather(rain, snow, fog, etc.).
When the VSA system indicatorcomes on (see page ).
When you turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position, the CMBSindicator should come on for a fewseconds, then go off. If theindicator comes on at any othertime and a CHECK CMBSSYSTEM message appears on themulti-information display, there isa problem with the CMBS. Youcan still drive your vehicle, butCMBS will not be operating. Haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer.
If anything covers the front grille(dirt, mud, dry leaves, wet snow,etc.).This indicator comes on for several
seconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. It alsocomes on and stays on when youturn the CMBS off by pressing theCMBS OFF switch.
To turn the CMBS back on, makesure the vehicle is stopped and theignition switch is in the ON (II)position, then press the CMBS OFFswitch for about 1 second.
371
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
CMBS Indicator
360
CMBS INDICATOR
06/08/12 19:06:29 31SJA620 0365
CONTINUED
A vehicle cuts in front of you andbrakes suddenly.
When you accelerate rapidly andapproach the vehicle ahead of youat high speed.
Driving in heavy, stop-and-gotraffic.
The vehicle ahead of you is amotorcycle or other small vehicle.
Immediately after you drive off.
The CMBS may not activate undersome conditions. Here are a fewexamples:
The distance between your vehicleand the vehicle ahead of you is tooshort.
A vehicle cuts in front of you at aslow speed.
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
Limitations
Driving
361
YOUR VEHICLEYOUR VEHICLE
06/08/12 19:06:38 31SJA620 0366
Even with little or no chance of acollision, the CMBS may activateunder these conditions:
A vehicle suddenly crosses in frontof you.
When you approach or pass avehicle ahead of you that isturning left or right in anintersection.
When you change lanes quickly,then overtake the vehicle ahead ofyou.
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
362
YOUR VEHICLEYOUR VEHICLE
The CMBS is not designed to detectpedestrians.
06/08/12 19:06:44 31SJA620 0367
CONTINUED
When you pass a low bridge athigh speed.
When you approach train tracks atthe bottom of a hill and you do notapply the brakes.
Because of the road condition(curved, winding, etc.) or the state ofyour vehicle (turning angle, laneposition, etc.), CMBS can sometimesmistake a stationary object (lightpole, traffic sign, etc.) as a vehicleahead of you and temporarilyoperate. This is normal.
When you go over a sharp-edgedspeed bump at high speed.
When you go over areas ofconstruction on the road surface.
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
Driving
363
LOW BRIDGE
RAILS
YOUR VEHICLE
SIGN, POLE, etc.
06/08/12 19:06:53 31SJA620 0368
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
The main purpose of the CMBS is toreduce the severity of injuriescaused by an unavoidable collision.While the CMBS may help to alertyou and minimize the severity of acollision, it may not activate in everydangerous situation.
Even with the CMBS, it is still yourresponsibility to operate the brakepedal and steering wheelappropriately, according to thedriving conditions.
Collision Mitigation Brake System (CMBS)
Important Safety Reminder
364
06/08/12 19:06:58 31SJA620 0369
Your vehicle is equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that turns on every time you start theengine and monitors the pressure inyour tires while driving.
Each tire has its own pressuresensor. If the air pressure of a tirebecomes significantly low, thesensor in that tire immediately sendsa signal that causes the low tirepressure indicator in theinstrumental panel and theappropriate tire position indicator onthe tire pressure monitor on themulti-information display (see page
) to come on.
For example, if you check and fillyour tires in a warm area, then drivein extremely cold weather, the tirepressure will be lower thanmeasured and could be underinflatedand cause the low tire pressureindicator to come on. Or, if youcheck and adjust your tire pressurein cooler conditions, and drive intoextremely hot conditions, the tiremay become overinflated. However,the low tire pressure indicator willnot come on if the tires areoverinflated.
When the low tire pressure indicatoris on, one or more of your tires issignificantly underinflated. Themulti-information display also showsa ‘‘CHECK TIRE PRESSURE’’message (see page ). You shouldstop and check your tires as soon aspossible, and inflate them to theproper pressure as indicated on thevehicle’s tire information placard.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Under-inflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Because tire pressure varies bytemperature and other conditions,the low tire pressure indicator maycome on unexpectedly.
Refer to page for tire inflationguidelines.367
367
415
CONTINUED
Low Tire PressureIndicator
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Driving
365
06/08/12 19:07:06 31SJA620 0370
Although your tire pressure ismonitored, you must manually checkthe tire pressures monthly.
If you have a flat tire, the low tirepressure and tire monitor indicatorswill come on. Replace the indicatedflat tire with the compact spare tire(see page ).
Each tire, including the spare, shouldbe checked monthly when thevehicle is cold, and set to therecommended inflation pressure asspecified on the vehicle placard andin the owner’s manual (see page
).
After you replace the flat tire withthe spare, the low tire pressureindicator stays on. This is normal;the system is not monitoring thespare tire pressure. Manually checkthe spare tire pressure to be sure itis correct.
Never use a puncture-repairing agentin a flat tire. If used, you will have toreplace the tire pressure sensor.Have the flat tire repaired by yourdealer as soon as possible.
Each wheel is equipped with a tirepressure sensor mounted inside thetire behind the valve stem. You mustuse TPMS specific wheels. It isrecommended that you always haveyour tires serviced by your dealer ora qualified technician.
If the tire is flat, or if the tirepressure is too low to continuedriving, replace the tire with thecompact spare tire.
If you think you can safely drive ashort distance to a service station,proceed slowly to the station, theninflate the tire to the recommendedpressure.
415
432
Changing a Tire with TPMS
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
366
06/08/12 19:07:14 31SJA620 0371
CONTINUED
If any of the tires have low pressure,the multi-information display willshow a ‘‘CHECK TIRE PRESSURE’’message. You will also see one ormore low pressure tire positionsblinking in the display (see page
).
If there is a system error with theTPMS, the multi-information displayshows a ‘‘SYSTEM FUNCTIONERROR’’ message (see page ),and the tire pressure readings willnot be displayed. You will also see a‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ messageon the multi-information display (seepage ).
When all tire pressures are normal,the multi-information display willshow ‘‘TIRE PRESSURE OKSYSTEM FUNCTION NORMAL.’’
When any of the tires has lowpressure, the multi-informationdisplay shows a ‘‘TIRE PRESSUREERROR SYSTEM FUNCTIONNORMAL’’ message (see page ).76
79
369
79
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Tire Pressure Monitor
Driving
367
VEHICLE ICON
06/08/12 19:07:22 31SJA620 0372
If one or more tires have lowpressure, the low tire pressureindicator on the instrument panelalso comes on (see page ).
When cruise control is on whiledriving, the pressure reading cannotbe checked by the tire pressuremonitor on the multi-informationdisplay.
If the low tire pressure indicator andthe low tire position on the low tirepressure monitor do not go out afterinflating the tires to the specifiedvalues, have your dealer check thesystem as soon as possible.
When the TPMS is functioningnormally, you can see the tirepressure readings of each tire in psi(U.S. models) or kPa (Canadianmodels) by pressing the SEL/RESET button while the multi-information display shows the tirepressure monitor.
365
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Tire Pressure Readings
368
CANADAU.S.
06/08/12 19:07:29 31SJA620 0373
It is possible that the pressuresshown on the multi-informationdisplay and the pressures youmanually measure are slightlydifferent.If the difference is significant or youcannot make the low tire pressureindicator and message on the multi-information display go out afterinflating the tires to the specifiedvalues, have your dealer check thesystem as soon as possible.
If there is a problem with the TPMS,the multi-information display showsa ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’message.
If you see this message, the tirepressure monitor shows a ‘‘SYSTEMFUNCTION ERROR’’ message. Thesystem may not be able to detect orsignal low tire pressure as intended.Also, the tire pressure readings willnot be displayed. Have your vehiclechecked by a dealer as soon aspossible.
CONTINUED
Check TPMS System Message
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Driving
369
06/08/12 19:07:35 31SJA620 0374
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
If the low tire pressure indicatorcomes on, or the multi-informationdisplay shows a ‘‘CHECK TPMSSYSTEM’’ message, the VSA systemautomatically turns on even whenthe VSA system is turned off bypressing the VSA OFF switch (seepage ). If this happens, youcannot turn the VSA system off bypressing the VSA OFF switch again.
372
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
370
06/08/12 19:07:40 31SJA620 0375
The vehicle stability assist (VSA)system helps to stabilize the vehicleduring cornering if the vehicle turnsmore or less than desired. It alsoassists you in maintaining tractionwhile accelerating on loose orslippery road surfaces. It does thisby regulating the engine’s output andby selectively applying the brakes.
When VSA activates, you may noticethat the engine does not respond tothe accelerator in the same way itdoes at other times. You will also seethe VSA activation indicator blink.
The VSA system cannot enhance thevehicle’s driving stability in allsituations and does not control yourvehicle’s entire braking system. It isstill your responsibility to drive andcorner at reasonable speeds and toleave a sufficient margin of safety.
When VSA activates, you will see theVSA activation indicator blink (seepage ).
If this indicator comes on whiledriving, pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe, and turn off theengine. Reset the system byrestarting the engine. If the VSAsystem indicator stays on, or comesback on while driving, have the VSAsystem inspected by your dealer.
If the indicator does not come onwhen the ignition switch is turned tothe ON (II) position, there may be aproblem with the VSA system. Haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible (see page ).
When the VSA system indicatorcomes on, you will also see a‘‘CHECK VSA SYSTEM’’ messageon the multi-information display.
Without VSA, your vehicle still hasnormal braking and cornering ability,but it does not have VSA traction andstability enhancement.
If the low tire pressure indicatorcomes on (see page ), or themulti-information display shows a‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message(see page ), the VSA systemautomatically turns on even whenthe VSA system is turned off withthe VSA OFF switch. In this case,you cannot turn the VSA system offby pressing the VSA OFF switchagain.
65
65
365
369
VSA Activation Indicator
VSA System Indicator
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
Driving
371
06/08/12 19:07:49 31SJA620 0376
Driving with varying tire or wheelsizes may cause the VSA tomalfunction. When replacing tires,make sure they are of the same sizeand type as your original tires (seepage ).
In certain unusual conditions whenyour vehicle gets stuck in shallowmud or fresh snow, it may be easierto free it with the VSA temporarilyswitched off. When the VSA systemis off, the traction control system isalso off. You should only attempt tofree your vehicle with the VSA off ifyou are not able to free it when theVSA is on.
Immediately after freeing yourvehicle, be sure to switch the VSA onagain. We do not recommend drivingyour vehicle with the VSA andtraction control systems switched off.
This switch is at the right side of theleft vent. Press it to turn VSA on andoff.
When VSA is off, the VSA activationindicator comes on as a reminder.
VSA is turned on every time youstart the engine, even if you turned itoff the last time you drove thevehicle.
If you install winter tires, make surethey are the same size as those thatwere originally supplied with yourvehicle. Exercise the same cautionduring winter driving as you would ifyour vehicle was not equipped withVSA.
419
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
VSA and Tire SizesVSA Off Switch
372
VSA OFF SWITCH
06/08/12 19:07:57 31SJA620 0377
Your vehicle has been designedprimarily to carry passengers andtheir cargo. You can also use it totow a trailer if you carefully observethe load limits, use the properequipment, and follow the guidelinesin this section.
The weight thatthe tongue of a fully-loaded trailerputs on the hitch should beapproximately 10 percent of thetrailer weight. Too much tongueload reduces front-tire traction andsteering control. Too little tongueload can make the trailer unstableand cause it to sway.
Themaximum allowable weight of thetrailer and everything in or on itmust not exceed 1,000 lbs (450 kg).Towing a load that is too heavycan seriously affect your vehicle’shandling and performance. It canalso damage the engine anddrivetrain.
CONTINUED
Load Limits
Tongue Load:Total Trailer Weight:
Towing a Trailer
Driving
373
Exceeding any load limit orimproperly loading your vehicleand trailer can cause a crash inwhich you can be seriously hurtor killed.
Check the loading of yourvehicle and trailer carefullybefore starting to drive.
06/08/12 19:08:04 31SJA620 0378
To achieve a proper tongue load,start by loading 60 % of the loadtoward the front of the trailer and40 % toward the rear, then re-adjustthe load as needed.
The best way to confirm that vehicleand trailer weights are within limitsis to have them checked at a publicscale.
Using a suitable scale or a specialtongue load gauge, check the tongueload the first time you set up atowing combination (a fully-loadedvehicle and trailer), then recheck thetongue load whenever the conditionschange.
The maximum allowable weight ofthe vehicle, all occupants, all cargo,and the tongue load is: 4,980 lbs(2,260 kg)
The maximum allowable weight ofthe vehicle axles are: 2,680 lbs(1,215 kg) on the front axle, and2,380 lbs (1,080 kg) on the rearaxle.
Towing generally requires a varietyof supplemental equipment,depending on the size of your trailer,how much load you are towing, andwhere you tow. To ensure the bestquality, we recommend that youpurchase Acura equipmentwhenever possible.
Discuss your needs with your trailersales or rental agency, and follow theguidelines in the rest of this section.Also make sure that all equipment isproperly installed and maintained,and that it meets federal, state,province, and local regulations.
Any hitch used on your vehicle mustbe properly bolted to the underbody.
Checking Loads Towing Equipment andAccessories
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating(GVWR):
Gross Axle Weight Rating(GAWR):
Towing a Trailer
Hitches
374
06/08/12 19:08:13 31SJA620 0379
Always use safety chains when youtow a trailer. Make sure the chainsare secured to the trailer and hitch,and that they cross under the tongueand can catch the trailer if itbecomes unhitched. Leave enoughslack to allow the trailer to turncorners easily, but do not let thechains drag on the ground.
Acura recommends that any trailerhaving a total weight of 1,000 lbs(450 kg) or more be equipped withits own electric or surge-type brakes.
If you choose electric brakes, besure they are electronically actuated.Do not attempt to tap into yourvehicle’s hydraulic system. Nomatter how successful it may seem,any attempt to attach trailer brakesto your vehicle’s hydraulic systemwill lower braking effectiveness andcreate a potential hazard.
Trailer lights and equipment mustcomply with federal, state, and localregulations. Check with your localtrailer dealer or rental agency for therequirements in your area, and useonly equipment designed for yourvehicle.
Since lighting and wiring vary bytrailer type and brand, you shouldhave a qualified technician install asuitable connector between thevehicle and the trailer. Improperequipment or installation can causedamage to your vehicle’s electricalsystem and affect your vehiclewarranty.
See your trailer dealer or rentalagency for more information oninstalling electric brakes.
CONTINUED
Safety Chains Trailer LightsTrailer Brakes
Towing a Trailer
Driving
375
06/08/12 19:08:21 31SJA620 0380
Many states and Canadian provincesrequire special outside mirrors whentowing a trailer. Even if they don’t,you should install special mirrors ifyou cannot clearly see behind you, orif the trailer creates a blind spot.
Ask your trailer sales or rentalagency if any other items arerecommended or required for yourtowing situation.
When preparing to tow, and beforedriving away, be sure to check thefollowing:
The vehicle has been properlyserviced, and the tires, brakes,suspension, cooling system, andlights are in good operatingcondition.
All items in or on the trailer areproperly secured and cannot shiftwhile you drive.
The hitch, safety chains, and anyother attachments are secure.
All weights and loads are withinlimits.
The trailer has been properlyserviced and is in good condition,and the lights and brakes on thetrailer are working properly.
Your vehicle tires and spare areproperly inflated, and the trailertires and spare are inflated asrecommended by the trailermaker.
Pre-Tow Checklist
Towing a Trailer
Additional Towing Equipment
376
06/08/12 19:08:29 31SJA620 0381
--
--
--
The added weight, length, andheight of a trailer will affect yourvehicle’s handling and performance,so driving with a trailer requiressome special driving skills andtechniques.
For your safety and the safety ofothers, take time to practice drivingmaneuvers before heading for theopen road, and follow the guidelinesbelow.
When driving uphill and downhill,use the Sequential SportShift modeto provide the proper engine powerand engine braking on each gear.Select fourth, third, second, or firstgear; depending on the vehiclespeeds and road condition. Do notuse fifth gear. The recommendedspeed range for each gear position isshown in the table.
Make turns more slowly and widerthan normal. The trailer tracks asmaller arc than your vehicle, and itcan hit or run over something thevehicle misses. Allow more time anddistance for braking. Do not brake orturn suddenly as this could cause thetrailer to jackknife or turn over.
Drive slower than normal in alldriving situations, and obey postedspeed limits for vehicles with trailers.Use D position when towing a traileron level roads. D is the proper shiftlever position to use when towing atrailer in hilly terrain. (See ‘‘
’’ on the next page foradditional gear information.)
Gear position
1
2
3
4
Speed range
0 19 mph(0 30 km/h)
19 31 mph(30 50 km/h)
31 41 mph(50 65 km/h)
over 41 mph(over 65 km/h)
3
CONTINUED
Driving Safely With a Trailer
Towing Speeds and Gears
Making Turns and Braking
Drivingon Hills
Towing a Trailer
Driving
377
06/08/12 19:08:38 31SJA620 0382
Crosswinds and air turbulencecaused by passing trucks can disruptyour steering and cause trailer tosway. When being passed by a largevehicle, keep a constant speed, andsteer straight ahead. Do not try tomake quick steering or brakingcorrections.
Follow all normal precautions whenparking, including firmly setting theparking brake and putting thetransmission in Park. Also, placewheel chocks at each of the trailer’stires.
When driving down hills, reduceyour speed, and shift down to secondgear. Do not ‘‘ride’’ the brakes, andremember, it will take longer to slowdown and stop when towing a trailer.
If you must stop when facing uphill,use the foot brake or parking brake.Do not try to hold the vehicle inplace by pressing on the accelerator,as this can cause the automatictransmission to overheat.
When climbing hills, closely watchyour temperature gauge. If it nearsthe red (Hot) mark, turn the airconditioning off, reduce speed and, ifnecessary, pull to the side of theroad to let the engine cool.
If the automatic transmission shiftsfrequently while going up a hill, shiftto D .
Always drive slowly and havesomeone guide you when backing up.Grip the of the steeringwheel; turn the wheel to the left toget the trailer to move to the left,and turn the wheel right to move thetrailer to the right.
Your vehicle is not designed to betowed behind a motor home. If yourvehicle needs to be towed in anemergency, see page .455
3
bottom
Backing Up
Handling Crosswinds and Buffeting
Parking
Driving on Hills
Towing a Trailer, Towing Your Vehicle
Towing Your Vehicle
378
06/08/12 19:08:48 31SJA620 0383
This section explains why it isimportant to keep your vehicle wellmaintained and how to follow basicmaintenance safety precautions.
If you have the skills and tools toperform more complex maintenancetasks on your vehicle, you may wantto purchase the service manual. Seepage for information on how toobtain a copy, or see your dealer.
This section also includesinstructions on how to read themaintenance minder messages onthe multi-information display, amaintenance record, and instructionsfor simple maintenance tasks youmay want to take care of yourself.
......................Maintenance Safety . 380....................Maintenance Minder . 381....................Maintenance Record . 391
..............................Fluid Locations . 393......Engine Compartment Covers . 394
........................Adding Engine Oil . 395.........Changing the Oil and Filter . 396
..............................Engine Coolant . 398....................Windshield Washers . 400
....Automatic Transmission Fluid . 400....................................Brake Fluid . 402
....................Power Steering Fluid . 402....................................Timing Belt . 403
.............................................Lights . 404..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 411................Cleaning the Seat Belts . 411
.....................................Floor Mats . 412.................................Wiper Blades . 413
...........................................Wheels . 415...............................................Tires . 415
...................Checking the Battery . 423.............................Vehicle Storage . 425
477
Maintenance
Maintenance
379
06/08/12 19:08:53 31SJA620 0384
To eliminate potential hazards, readthe instructions before you begin,and make sure you have the toolsand skills required.
To clean parts, use a commerciallyavailable degreaser or partscleaner, not gasoline.
Be sure there isadequate ventilation whenever youoperate the engine.
Let theengine and exhaust system cooldown before touching any parts.
Donot run the engine unlessinstructed to do so.
Some of the most important safetyprecautions are given here. However,we cannot warn you of everyconceivable hazard that can arise inperforming maintenance. Only youcan decide whether or not youshould perform a given task.
Make sure your vehicle is parkedon level ground, the parking brakeis set, and the engine is off.
To reduce the possibility of fire orexplosion, keep cigarettes, sparks,and flames away from the batteryand all fuel-related parts.
Wear eye protection andprotective clothing when workingwith the battery or compressed air.
All service items not detailed in thissection should be performed by acertified technician or other qualifiedmechanic.
Maintenance Safety
Important Safety Precautions
Potential Vehicle HazardsCarbon Monoxide poison fromengine exhaust.
Burns from hot parts.
Injury from moving parts.
380
Improperly maintaining thisvehicle, or failing to correct aproblem before driving cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspectionand maintenancerecommendations andschedules in this owner’smanual.
Failure to properly followmaintenance instructions andprecautions can cause you tobe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the proceduresand precautions in this owner’smanual.
06/08/12 19:09:02 31SJA620 0385
------------
One of the most convenient andimportant features of the multi-information display on your vehicleis the maintenance minder.
Based on engine operatingconditions and accumulated enginerevolutions, the onboard computer inyour vehicle calculates the remainingengine oil life.
The system also displays the codefor other scheduled maintenanceitems needing service.
To see the remaining engine oil lifedisplayed on the lower right corneron the multi-information display as apercentage, turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position, and press theSEL/RESET button on the steeringwheel repeatedly until the engine oillife appears (see page ).
The remaining engine oil life isdisplayed according to the tableshown below.
Calculated EngineOil Life (%)
100% 91%90% 81%80% 71%70% 61%60% 51%50% 41%40% 31%30% 21%20% 16%15% 11%10% 6%
5% 1%0%
DisplayedEngine Oil Life
(%)100%90%80%70%60%50%40%30%20%15%10%5%0%
73
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
Engine Oil Life Display
Maintenance
381
REMAINING ENGINE OIL LIFE
06/08/12 19:09:11 31SJA620 0386
▼ ▲▼ ▲
The message will be canceled if theor button on the steering wheel
is pressed. Press the or buttonto see the message again.
When the remaining engine oil life is15 to 6 percent, the multi-informationdisplay shows a ‘‘SERVICE DUESOON’’ message along with themaintenance schedule codeindicating the main and sub itemsrequired at the time of the oil change.Refer to page and for acomplete list of the maintenancemain items and sub items.
Press the SEL/RESET button on thesteering wheel repeatedly to selectthe engine oil life. The message‘‘OIL LIFE’’ along with thepercentage of oil life remaining andthe maintenance item code(s),appear on the lower part of the multi-information display.389 390
Maintenance Minder
382
MESSAGE
MAINTENANCEMAIN ITEM
REMAININGENGINE OIL LIFE
MAINTENANCEITEM CODE (S)
MAINTENANCESUB ITEM (S)
06/08/12 19:09:16 31SJA620 0387
▼ ▲▼ ▲
The message will be canceled if theor button on the steering wheel
is pressed. Press the or buttonto see the message again.
When the remaining engine oil life is1 to 5 percent, the multi-informationdisplay shows a ‘‘SERVICE DUENOW’’ message with themaintenance items. When you seethis message have the indicatedmaintenance performed as soon aspossible.
Press the SEL/RESET button on thesteering wheel repeatedly to selectthe engine oil life. The message‘‘SERVICE OIL LIFE’’, along with‘‘5%’’, and the maintenance itemcode(s) are displayed on the lowerpart of the multi-information displaywhen the calculated engine oil life is1 to 5 percent (see page ).381
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
383
06/08/12 19:09:22 31SJA620 0388
▼ ▲
▲ ▼
Press and hold the SEL/RESETbutton on the steering wheel formore than 10 seconds. Theremaining engine oil life resetmode will be shown on the multi-information display.
To reset the engine oil life, pressthe or button on the steeringwheel to select RESET on thedisplay, and press the SEL/RESET button.
To cancel resetting the oil life,press the or button on thesteering wheel to select CANCELon the display, and press the SEL/RESET button.
If you do not complete the resetprocedure within 30 seconds afterselecting the reset mode, the modewill be canceled automatically.
Your dealer will reset the displayafter completing the requiredmaintenance service. You will see‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on the display thenext time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
If maintenance service is done bysomeone other than your dealer,reset the maintenance minder asfollows:
If the oil life minder is notdisplayed, press the SEL/RESETbutton on the steering wheelrepeatedly until it is.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
The maintenance item code or codesindicate the main and sub itemsrequired at the time of the oil change(see page ).
1.
2.
3.
389
Maintenance Minder
384
U.S.
CANADA
06/08/12 19:09:31 31SJA620 0389
▼ ▲▼ ▲
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe oil life minder as previouslydescribed.
The message will be canceled if theor button on the steering wheel
is pressed. Press the or buttonto see the message again.
If the indicated maintenance serviceis not done and the remaining engineoil life reaches 0 %, the multi-information display will show themessage ‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’and the maintenance item code(s).This message is displayed when thetotal mileage is less than 10 miles(for U.S. models)/10 km (forCanadian models) after the engineoil life became 0 %.
Press the SEL/RESET button on thesteering wheel repeatedly to selectthe engine oil life minder. Themessage ‘‘SERVICE OIL LIFE’’,along with ‘‘0%’’, and themaintenance item code are displayedon the lower part of the multi-information display when thecalculated engine oil life is 0 percent.
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
385
06/08/12 19:09:37 31SJA620 0390
▼ ▲▼ ▲
And also, the percentage ‘‘0’’ keepsblinking on the display.
If the indicated required service isnot done and the remaining engineoil life becomes 0 %, the multi-information display will show a‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’ message,the total mileage after the remainingoil life became 0 %, and themaintenance item code(s).
This message is displayed when youdrive over 10 miles (for U.S. models)or 10 km (for Canadian models)after seeing the 0 % message.
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe display as previously described.
The message will be canceled if theor button on the steering wheel
is pressed. Press the or buttonto see the message again.
This particular message is displayedwhen the mileage after the engine oillife became 0 % reaches 10 miles (forU.S. models)/10 km (for Canadianmodels).
The maximum total mileage shownwith this message is ‘‘9999 mile’’ (forU.S. models) or ‘‘9999 km’’ (forCanadian models).
Maintenance Minder
386
TOTAL PAST DUE MILEAGE
U.S.
CANADAMAINTENANCE ITEM CODE (S)
06/08/12 19:09:45 31SJA620 0391
--
This particular message is displayedwhen you drive over 10 miles (forU.S. models) or 10 km (for Canadianmodels) after seeing 0 %.
When you press the SEL/RESETbutton to select the engine oil lifeminder, the message ‘‘SERVICE’’,along with the maintenance itemcode and the total negative mileageafter the oil life became 0 percent,will be displayed on the lower part ofthe multi-information display.
The maximum total negative mileageis ‘‘ 9999 mile’’ (for U.S. models) or‘‘ 9999 km’’ (for Canadian models).
If you have the required serviceperformed but do not reset thedisplay, or reset the display withoutperforming the service, the systemwill not show the propermaintenance intervals. This can leadto serious mechanical problemsbecause you will no longer have anaccurate record of whenmaintenance is needed.
Your authorized Acura dealer knowsyour vehicle best and can providecompetent, efficient service.
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
Important MaintenancePrecautions
Maintenance
387
U.S.
CANADA
TOTAL PAST DUE MILEAGE
06/08/12 19:09:53 31SJA620 0392
-
-
-
-
-
-#
Engine oil level Check everytime you fill the fuel tank. Seepage .
Engine coolant level Check theradiator reserve tank every timeyou fill the fuel tank. See page .
Automatic transmission Checkthe fluid level monthly. See page
.
Lights Check the operation ofthe headlights, parking lights,taillights, high-mount brake light,and license plate lights monthly.See page .
Tires Check the tire pressuremonthly. Examine the tread forwear and foreign objects. See page
.
Brakes Check the fluid levelmonthly. See page .
U.S. Vehicles:Your authorized dealer knows yourvehicle best and can providecompetent, efficient service.However, service at a dealer is notmandatory to keep your warrantiesin effect. Maintenance may be doneby any qualified service facility orperson who is skilled in this type ofautomotive service. Keep all receiptsas proof of completion, and have theperson who does the work fill out themaintenance record. Check yourwarranty booklet for moreinformation.
We recommend the use of Acuraparts and fluids whenever you havemaintenance done. These aremanufactured to the same high-quality standards as the originalcomponents, so you can be confidentof their performance and durability.
According to state and federalregulations, failure to performmaintenance on the items markedwith will not void your emissionswarranties. However, Acurarecommends that all maintenanceservices be performed in accordancewith the intervals indicated by theMulti-Information Display.
You should check the followingitems at the specified intervals. Ifyou are unsure of how to performany check, turn to the appropriatepage listed.
331
331
400
402
417
404
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance, replacement, orrepair of emissions controldevices and systems may be doneby any automotive repairestablishment or individual usingparts that are ‘‘certif ied’’ to EPAstandards.
Owner’s Maintenance Checks
388
06/08/12 19:10:03 31SJA620 0393
*
#
#
#
*
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
389
:
If the message ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW’’ does not appear more than 12 monthsafter the display is reset, change the engine oil every year.
See information on maintenance and emissions warranty on page .
Independent of the maintenance messages in the Multi-InformationDisplay, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km).Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 only if they are noisy.
NOTE:
1 :
388
Maintenance Main ItemsReplace engine oilReplace engine oil and oil filterInspect front and rear brakesCheck parking brake adjustmentInspect these items:
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and line (including ABS)All fluid levels and condition of fluidsExhaust systemFuel lines and connections
AB
Symbol1
Main
tenance
Min
der
06/08/12 19:10:10 31SJA620 0394
- -
Maintenance Minder
390
Maintenance Sub ItemsReplace rear differential fluid
Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehiclespeeds or trailer towing results in higher level ofmechanical (shear) stress to fluid This requiresdifferential fluid changes more frequently thanrecommended by the Maintenance Minder. If youregularly drive your vehicle under these conditions,have the differential fluid changed at 7,500 miles(12,000 km), then every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
Maintenance Sub ItemsRotate tiresReplace air cleaner element
If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 15,000miles (24,000 km).
Replace dust and pollen filterIf you drive primarily in urban areas that have highconcentrations of soot in the air from industry andfrom diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000miles (24,000 km).
Inspect drive beltReplace transmission and transfer fluid
Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehiclespeeds or trailer towing results in highertransmission and transfer temperatures.This requires transmission and transfer fluid changesmore frequently than recommended by theMaintenance Minder. If you regularly drive yourvehicle under these conditions, have the transmissionand transfer fluid changed at 60,000 miles(100,000 km), then every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
Replace spark plugsReplace timing belt and inspect water pump
If you drive regularly in very high temperatures (over110°F, 43°C), or in very low temperatures (under
20°F, 29°C), replace every 60,000 mile (U.S.)/100,000 km (Canada)
Inspect valve clearanceReplace engine coolant
Symbol12
3
4
5
Symbol6
Main
tenance
Min
der
06/08/12 19:10:14 31SJA620 0395
CONTINUED
Maintenance Record
Maintenance
391
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Signature
Date
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Signature
Date
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
You or the servicing dealer can record all completed maintenance here. When maintenance is performed, record the mileage, circle the coded item(s)completed, and write in any other non-coded items (such as brake fluid replacement) below the codes. Keep the receipts for all work done on yourvehicle. Maintenance can also be recorded in your Acura maintenance journal.
06/08/12 19:10:21 31SJA620 0396
Maintenance Record
392
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
Signature
Date
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Signature
Date
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
06/08/12 19:10:27 31SJA620 0397
*
*: The power steering fluid reservoir is located under the right compartment cover.
Fluid Locations
Maintenance
393
RADIATOR CAP
ENGINE OILFILL CAP
ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK(Orange loop)
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSIONFLUID DIPSTICK(Yellow loop)
ENGINECOOLANTRESERVOIR
BRAKE FLUID(Black cap)
WASHER FLUID(Black cap)
POWER STEERINGFLUID(Red cap)
06/08/12 19:10:30 31SJA620 0398
The component parts in the enginecompartment are protected byseveral covers. You may need toremove the covers when youperform some simple maintenancework.
All of the covers are secured byholding clips.
To remove the front bulkhead cover,remove the holding clips with a flat-tip screwdriver.
To remove the left or right enginecompartment cover, remove theholding clips by loosening the pins inthe center of the fastener.
To remove the battery cover, turnthe knob of the fastener (see page
).424
Engine Compartment Covers
394
FRONT BULKHEAD COVER
RIGHT COMPARTMENT COVER LEFT COMPARTMENT COVER
BATTERY COVER
06/08/12 19:10:37 31SJA620 0399
Install the engine oil fill cap, andtighten it securely. Wait a fewminutes, and recheck the oil level.Do not fill above the upper mark; youcould damage the engine.
Unscrew and remove the engine oilfill cap on top of the valve cover.Pour in the oil slowly and carefully soyou do not spill any. Clean up anyspills immediately. Spilled oil coulddamage components in the enginecompartment.
Honda Motor Oil is the preferred5W-20 lubricant for your vehicle. It ishighly recommended that you useHonda Motor Oil in your vehicle foroptimum engine protection. Makesure the API Certification Seal says‘‘For Gasoline Engines.’’The oil viscosity or weight isprovided on the container’s label.5W-20 oil is formulated for year-round protection of your vehicle toimprove cold weather starting andfuel economy.
Oil is a major contributor to yourengine’s performance and longevity.Always use a premium-grade 5W-20detergent oil displaying the APICertification Seal. This seal indicatesthe oil is energy conserving, and thatit meets the American PetroleumInstitute’s latest requirements.
CONTINUED
Recommended Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
Maintenance
395
API CERTIFICATION SEAL
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
Ambient Temperature
06/08/12 19:10:45 31SJA620 0400
Your vehicle does not require any oiladditives. Additives may adverselyaffect the engine or transmissionperformance and durability.
Open the hood, and remove theengine oil fill cap. Remove the oildrain bolt and washer from thebottom of the engine. Drain the oilinto an appropriate container.
You may use a synthetic motor oil ifit meets the same requirementsgiven for a conventional motor oil: itdisplays the API Certification Seal,and it is the proper weight. You mustfollow the oil and filter changeintervals given on the maintenanceschedule.
Run the engine until it reachesnormal operating temperature,then shut it off.
Changing the oil and filter requiresspecial tools and access fromunderneath the vehicle. The vehicleshould be raised on a service station-type hydraulic lift for this service.Unless you have the knowledge andproper equipment, you should havethis maintenance done by a skilledmechanic.
Always change the oil and filteraccording to the maintenancemessages shown on the multi-information display. The oil and filtercollect contaminants that candamage your engine if they are notremoved regularly.
1.
2.
Synthetic Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Changing the Engine Oil andFilter
Adding Engine Oil, Changing the Engine Oil and Filter
396
WASHER
OIL DRAIN BOLT
06/08/12 19:10:53 31SJA620 0401
Remove the oil filter, and let theremaining oil drain. A specialwrench (available from yourdealer) is required.
Refill the engine with therecommended oil.Engine oil change capacity(including filter):
Replace the engine oil fill cap.Start the engine. The oil pressureindicator should go out within 5seconds. If it does not, turn off theengine, and check your work.
Let the engine run for severalminutes, then check the drain boltand oil filter for leaks.
Turn off the engine and let it sitfor several minutes, then checkthe oil level on the dipstick. Ifnecessary, add more oil.
Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt.Tighten the drain bolt to:
Check the oil filter to make sureits gasket did not stick to theengine block. A stuck gasket couldcause an oil leak.
Install a new oil filter according tothe instructions that come with it.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Changing the Oil and Filter
Maintenance
397
OIL FILTER
29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)
4.5 US qt (4.3 )
Improper disposal of engine oil can beharmf ul to the environment. If youchange your own oil, please dispose ofthe used oil properly. Put it in a sealedcontainer, and take it to a recyclingcenter. Do not discard it in a trash binor dump it on the ground.
06/08/12 19:11:03 31SJA620 0402
If the coolant level in the reservetank is at or below the MIN line, addcoolant to bring it up to the MAX line.Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
If the reserve tank is completelyempty, you should also check thecoolant level in the radiator.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is notavailable, you may use anothermajor-brand non-silicate coolant as atemporary replacement. Make sure itis a high-quality coolantrecommended for aluminum engines.Continued use of any non-Hondacoolant can result in corrosion,causing the cooling system tomalfunction or fail. Have the coolingsystem flushed and refilled withHonda antifreeze/coolant as soon aspossible.
Always use Honda Long-life Anti-freeze/Coolant Type 2. This coolantis pre-mixed with 50 percentantifreeze and 50 percent water.Never add straight antifreeze orplain water.
Adding Engine Coolant
Engine Coolant
398
RESERVE TANK
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
06/08/12 19:11:10 31SJA620 0403
The coolant level should be up tothe base of the filler neck. Addcoolant if it is low.
When the radiator and engine arecool, relieve any pressure in thecooling system by turning theradiator cap counterclockwise,without pressing down.
Remove the radiator cap bypushing down and turningcounterclockwise.
Put the radiator cap back on, andtighten it fully.
Pour coolant into the reserve tank.Fill it to halfway between the MAXand MIN marks. Put the cap backon the reserve tank.
Do not add any rust inhibitors orother additives to your vehicle’scooling system. They may not becompatible with the coolant orengine components.
Pour the coolant slowly and carefullyso you do not spill any. Clean up anyspill immediately; it could damagecomponents in the enginecompartment.
3.1.
2.
4.
5.
Engine Coolant
Maintenance
399
RADIATOR CAP
RESERVE TANK
06/08/12 19:11:18 31SJA620 0404
Check the fluid level in thewindshield washer reservoir at leastmonthly during normal use.
Check the fluid level with the engineat normal operating temperature.
Fill the reservoir with a good-qualitywindshield washer fluid. Thisincreases the cleaning capability andprevents freezing in cold weather.When you refill the reservoir, cleanthe edges of the windshield wiperblades with windshield washer fluidon a clean cloth. This will help tocondition them.
If the washer fluid is low, a‘‘WASHER FLUID LOW’’ messageappears on the multi-informationdisplay.
Park the vehicle on level ground.Start the engine and let it run untilthe radiator fan comes on, thenshut off the engine. For accurateresults, wait about 60 secondsbefore going to step 2, but don’twait longer than 90 seconds.
Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)from the transmission, and wipe itwith a clean cloth.
1.
2.
Windshield Washers Automatic Transmission Fluid
Windshield Washers, Automatic Transmission Fluid
400
NOTICE:
DIPSTICK
Do not use engine antif reezeor a vinegar/water solution in thewindshield washer reservoir. Antif reezecan damage your vehicle’s paint, whilea vinegar/water solution can damagethe windshield washer pump. Use onlycommercially-available windshieldwasher f luid.
06/08/12 19:11:26 31SJA620 0405
Insert the dipstick all the way backinto the transmission securely asshown in the illustration.
The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid when thisservice is shown on a maintenancemessage in the multi-informationdisplay.
If you are not sure how to add fluid,contact your dealer.
Insert the dipstick all the way intothe transmission as shown.
Remove the dipstick and checkthe fluid level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.
Pour the fluid slowly and carefullyso you do not spill any. Clean upany spill immediately; it coulddamage components in the enginecompartment.
If the level is below the lowermark, add fluid into the dipstickhole to bring it to the levelbetween the upper and lowermarks.
Always use Honda ATF-Z1(automatic transmission fluid). Ifit’s not available, you may use aDEXRON III automatictransmission fluid as a temporaryreplacement. However, continueduse can affect the shift quality.Have the transmission flushed andrefilled with Honda ATF-Z1 assoon as it is convenient.
5. 6.
3.
4.
Automatic Transmission Fluid
Maintenance
401
LOWER MARK
UPPER MARK
06/08/12 19:11:34 31SJA620 0406
After removing the right enginecompartment cover (see page ),check the level on the side of thereservoir when the engine is cold.The fluid should be between theUPPER LEVEL and LOWER LEVEL.If not, add power steering fluid to theUPPER LEVEL mark.
The fluid level should be betweenthe MIN and MAX marks on the sideof the reservoir. If the level is at orbelow the MIN mark, your brakesystem needs attention. Have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
Check the brake fluid level in thereservoirs monthly.
Replace the brake fluid every 3 years,independent of mileage.
Always use Honda Heavy DutyBrake Fluid DOT 3. If it is notavailable, you should use only DOT 3or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealedcontainer, as a temporaryreplacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid cancause corrosion and decrease the lifeof the system. Have the brakesystem flushed and refilled withHonda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 as soon as possible.
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is notcompatible with your vehicle’sbraking system and can causeextensive damage.
394
Brake Fluid, Power Steering Fluid
Power Steering FluidBrake Fluid
402
MAX MIN
UPPER LEVEL
LOWER LEVEL
06/08/12 19:11:43 31SJA620 0407
- -
If you frequently tow a trailer.
In very high temperatures(over 110°F, 43°C).
In very low temperatures(under 20°F, 29°C).
The timing belt should be replacedat the intervals shown on themaintenance minder. Replace thebelt at 60,000 miles (100,000 km) ifyou regularly drive your vehicle inone or more of these conditions:
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully soyou do not spill any. Clean up anyspill immediately; it could damagecomponents in the enginecompartment.
Always use Honda Power SteeringFluid. You may use another powersteering fluid as an emergencyreplacement, but have the powersteering system flushed and refilledwith Honda PSF as soon as possible.
A low power steering fluid level canindicate a leak in the system. Checkthe fluid level frequently, and havethe system inspected as soon aspossible.
Power Steering Fluid, Timing Belt
Timing Belt
Maintenance
403
Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef tor right lock and holding it there candamage the power steering pump.
06/08/12 19:11:50 31SJA620 0408
The low beam headlight bulbs are atype of high voltage discharge tube.High voltage can remain in thecircuit even with the light switch offand the key removed. Because ofthis, you should not attempt toexamine or change a low beamheadlight bulb yourself. If a lowbeam headlight bulb fails, take thevehicle to your dealer to have itreplaced.
Your vehicle has halogen high beamheadlight bulbs which are also usedfor the daytime running light.Handle it by its base and protect theglass from contact with your skin orhard objects. If you touch the glass,clean it with denatured alcohol and aclean cloth.
Your vehicle is equipped with anautomatic headlight adjustingsystem that adjusts the vertical angleof the headlights automatically.Refer to page for moreinformation.
The headlights were properly aimedwhen your vehicle was new. If youregularly carry heavy items in thetrunk or pull a trailer (if applicable),readjustment may be required.Adjustments should be done by yourdealer or other qualified technician.
144
Lights
Headlight Aiming Replacing a Headlight/DaytimeRunning Light Bulb
404
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil,perspiration, or a scratch on the glasscan cause the bulb to overheat andshatter.
06/08/12 19:11:56 31SJA620 0409
CONTINUED
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pushing on thetab and pulling the connectordown.
Remove the bulb by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Remove the left or right sideengine compartment cover fromthe side you are working on bycarefully pulling the cover out (seepage ).
If you are replacing the bulb onthe driver’s side, remove thebattery cover (see page ), thenremove the battery hold-down byremoving the two nuts with a 10mm wrench. Then carefully slidethe battery toward the engine toaccess the bulb.
2.
3.
1.
394
424
Lights
Maintenance
405
NUTS BULB
BATTERY HOLD-DOWN CONNECTOR
06/08/12 19:12:04 31SJA620 0410
Insert the new bulb into the hole,and turn it one-quarter turnclockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the headlights to test thenew bulb.
(Driver’s side)
Reinstall the engine compartmentside cover.
Push the electrical connector backonto the bulb. Make sure it is onall the way.
Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Push the bulb in slightly, and turnit counterclockwise.
Reinstall the battery in the reverseorder of removal, and reinstall thecover on the battery.
Remove the left or right sideengine compartment cover fromthe side you are working on bycarefully pulling the cover out (seepage ).
If you are replacing a driver’s sidebulb, slide the battery toward theengine to get more clearance (seepage ).
2.
1.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.3.
394
424
Lights
Replacing a Front Turn Signal/Front Parking Light Bulb
406
SOCKETBULB
06/08/12 19:12:13 31SJA620 0411
CONTINUED
If you are replacing a driver’s sidebulb, slide the battery toward theengine to get more clearance (seepage ).
Use a flat-tipped screwdriver toremove the holding clip from thewindshield washer reservoir.
(Passenger’s side)
Remove the left or right sideengine compartment cover (seepage ).
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket.
Install the new bulb into thesocket.
Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
(Driver’s side)Reinstall the battery and thebattery cover.
Reinstall the engine compartmentside cover.
1.
2.
5.
6.
7.
8.
394
424
4.
On model without adaptive frontlighting system
Lights
Replacing a Front Position/SideMarker Light Bulb
Maintenance
407
SOCKETBULB
06/08/12 19:12:25 31SJA620 0412
Your vehicle uses halogen lightbulbs. When replacing a bulb, handleit by its plastic case, and protect theglass from contact with your skin orhard objects. If you touch the glass,clean it with denatured alcohol and aclean cloth.
Install the new bulb into thesocket.
Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
(Driver’s side)Reinstall the battery and thebattery cover.
(Passenger’s side)Reinstall the windshield washerreservoir.
Reinstall the engine compartmentside cover.
Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
3.
4.
Lights
Replacing a Fog Light Bulb
408
SOCKET
HOLDING CLIP
BULB
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil,perspiration, or a scratch on the glasscan cause the bulb to overheat andshatter.
06/08/12 19:12:35 31SJA620 0413
Insert the new bulb into the hole,and turn it one-quarter turnclockwise to lock it in place.
Push the electrical connector backonto the bulb. Make sure it is onall the way.
Turn on the fog lights to test thenew bulb.
Reinstall the two mounting boltson the side under cover andtighten them securely. Put theholding clip back on the sideunder cover and push on thecenter until it locks (the center isflush with the head).
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pushing on thetab and pulling the connectordown.
Remove the bulb by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Carefully push up the side undercover into the bumper.
Use a Phillips-head screwdriver toremove the two mounting bolts,and remove the holding clip with aflat-tipped screwdriver.
3.
4.
5.
6.
8.
7.
1.
2.
Lights
Maintenance
409
CLIPCONNECTOR
BULB
BOLTS
06/08/12 19:12:45 31SJA620 0414
Determine which of the two bulbsis burned out: turn signal or back-up light.
Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Remove the burned out bulb bypulling it straight out of its socket.
Open the trunk lid, and removethe left or right maintenance lid.
Remove the mounting nut with an8 mm wrench.
Carefully pry in the top or bottomedge of the trim with a small flat-tipped screwdriver, and pull thetrim straight back.
Remove the two mounting boltswith an 8 mm wrench.
Pull the taillight assembly straightback out of the body.
2.
1. 3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Lights
Replacing Rear Bulbs
410
MOUNTING NUT
MAINTENANCE LID
BOLTS
BULBSTAIL LIGHT TRIM
SOCKETS
06/08/12 19:12:56 31SJA620 0415
Install the new bulb in the socketby pushing it straight in the socketuntil it bottoms.
Reinstall the socket into the lightassembly. Turn it clockwise tolock it in place.
Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.
Tighten the mounting nut securely,and reinstall the maintenance lid.
When reinstalling the taillightassembly, align and pop the snapfasteners in place. Tighten the twomounting bolts and reinstall thetrim in place.
If your seat belts get dirty, use a softbrush with a mixture of mild soapand warm water to clean them. Donot use bleach, dye, or cleaningsolvents. Let the belts air-dry beforeyou use the vehicle.Dirt build-up in the loops of the seatbelt anchors can cause the belts toretract slowly. Wipe the insides ofthe loops with a clean clothdampened in mild soap and warmwater or isopropyl alcohol.
This filter removes the dust andpollen that is brought in from theoutside through the climate controlsystem.
Have your dealer replace the filterwhen this service is indicated by amaintenance message in the multi-information display. It should bereplaced every 15,000 miles (24,000km) if you drive primarily in urbanareas that have high concentrationsof soot in the air, or if the flow fromthe climate control system becomesless than usual.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Cleaning the Seat BeltsDust and Pollen Filter
Lights, Dust and Pollen Filter, Cleaning the Seat Belts
Maintenance
411
LOOP
06/08/12 19:13:05 31SJA620 0416
Make sure the rear floor mats areproperly hooked to the floor matanchors. Your vehicle is equippedwith front passenger’s seat weightsensors. If the rear passenger’s floormat is on the seat rail of the frontpassenger’s seat, the sensors willdetect the decreased weight on theseat, and they may not work properly.
If you use a non-Acura floor mat,make sure it fits properly and that itcan be used with the floor matanchors. Do not put additional floormats on top of the anchored mats.
If you remove a floor mat, make sureto re-anchor it when you put it backin your vehicle.
The floor mats that came with yourvehicle hook over floor mat anchors.This keeps the floor mats fromsliding forward or backward andpossibly interfering with the pedalsor making the front passenger’sweight sensors ineffective.
Floor Mats
Floor Mats
412
HOOK HOOK
HOOKFront
FrontFront
DRIVER’S SIDE FLOOR MAT FRONT PASSENGER’SSIDE FLOOR MAT
REAR PASSENGER’S FLOOR MAT
06/08/12 19:13:13 31SJA620 0417
Push the end of the cover on theblade assembly until the other endis pivoted out, and remove thecover.
Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm by removingthe two screws from the arm.
Adjust the windshield wiper armsto the winter position by holdingboth wiper arms as shown in theillustration at the same time (seepage ). Raise the wiper armsoff the windshield.
Check the condition of the wiperblades at least every 6 months.Replace them if you find signs ofcracking in the rubber, areas that aregetting hard, or if they leave streaksand unwiped areas when used.
2.1.
3.139
Wiper Blades
Maintenance
413
COVER
SCREWSWIPER ARMS
HOLDING LOCATIONS
BLADE
Do not open the hood when the wiperarms are raised, or you will damagethe hood and the wiper arms.
06/08/12 19:13:20 31SJA620 0418
Remove the blade from its holderby grasping the tabbed end of theblade. Pull firmly until the tabscome out of the holder.
Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metalreinforcement along the backedge, remove the metalreinforcement strips from the oldwiper blade, and install them inthe slots along the edge of the newblade.
Slide the new wiper blade into theholder until the tabs lock.
Reinstall the blade assembly to thewiper arm and tighten the twoscrews securely. Reinstall thecover by pushing it in.
Set the wiper arms back on thewindshield. Adjust the windshieldwipers to their previously parkedposition.
4. 5.
6.
7.
8.
Wiper Blades
414
BLADE BLADE
REINFORCEMENT
06/08/12 19:13:28 31SJA620 0419
CONTINUED
Keeping the tires properly inflatedprovides the best combination ofhandling, tread life, and ridingcomfort.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly,adversely affect handling and fueleconomy, and are more likely tofail from being overheated.
Overinflated tires can make yourvehicle ride more harshly, aremore prone to damage from roadhazards, and wear unevenly.
The tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS) will warn you when a tirepressure is low. See page forinformation on the TPMS.
The following pages give moredetailed information on how to takecare of your tires and what to dowhen they need to be replaced.
To safely operate your vehicle, yourtires must be the proper type andsize, in good condition with adequatetread, and correctly inflated.
Clean the wheels as you would therest of the exterior. Wash them withthe same solution, and rinse themthoroughly.
Aluminum alloy wheels have aprotective clear-coat that keeps thealuminum from corroding andtarnishing. Cleaning the wheels withharsh chemicals (including somecommercial wheel cleaners) or a stiffbrush can damage the clear-coat. Toclean the wheels, use a milddetergent and a soft brush or sponge.
365
Inflation GuidelinesTiresWheels
Wheels, Tires
Maintenance
415
Using tires that are excessivelyworn or improperly inflated cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding tireinflation and maintenance.
06/08/12 19:13:37 31SJA620 0420
If you check the pressure when thetires are hot [driven for several miles(kilometers)], you will see readings 4to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to0.4 kgf/cm ) higher than the coldreading. This is normal; do notrelease air to match the coldpressure. The tires will beunderinflated.
You should get your own tirepressure gauge and use it wheneveryou check your tire pressures. Thiswill make it easier for you to tell if apressure loss is due to a tire problemand not due to a variation betweengauges.
While tubeless tires have someability to self-seal if they arepunctured, you should look closelyfor punctures if a tire starts losingpressure.
Even though your vehicle isequipped with TPMS, werecommend that you visually checkyour tires every day. If you think atire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.
Use a gauge to measure the airpressure in each tire at least once amonth. Even tires that are in goodcondition may lose one to two psi (10to 20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) permonth. Remember to check thespare tire at the same time.
Check the pressure in the tires whenthey are cold. This means the vehiclehas been parked for at least threehours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6km).
Add or release air, if needed, tomatch the recommended cold tirepressures on page .417
Tires
416
06/08/12 19:13:43 31SJA620 0421
The following charts show therecommended cold tire pressures formost normal and high-speed drivingconditions.
For convenience, the recommendedtire sizes and cold tire pressures areon a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
For additional technical informationabout your tires, see page .
Every time you check inflation, youshould also examine the tires fordamage, foreign objects, and wear.
You should look for:
Bumps or bulges in the tread orside of the tire. Replace the tire ifyou find either of these conditions.
Cuts, splits, or cracks in the sideof the tire. Replace the tire if youcan see fabric or cord.
Excessive tread wear.461
Tire Size/Type
Compact Spare
Cold Tire PressureFront
Rear
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure forNormal Driving
Front:
Rear:
CONTINUED
On models with the Michelin PAXsystem
Recommended Tire Pressures Tire Inspection
Tires
Maintenance
417
P245/50R17 98V
T155/70D17110M
32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm )
32 psi (220 kPa ,2.2 kgf/cm )30 psi (210 kPa ,2.1 kgf/cm )
245-680R460A102V
06/08/12 19:13:56 31SJA620 0422
In addition to proper inflation,correct wheel alignment helps todecrease tire wear. If you find a tireis worn unevenly, have your dealercheck the wheel alignment.
Have your dealer check the tires ifyou feel a consistent vibration whiledriving. A tire should always berebalanced if it is removed from thewheel. When you have new tiresinstalled, make sure they arebalanced. This increases ridingcomfort and tire life. For best results,have the installer perform a dynamicbalance.
A tire this worn gives very littletraction on wet roads. You shouldreplace the tire if you can see threeor more tread wear indicators.
To help increase tire life anddistribute wear more evenly, rotatethe tires according to themaintenance messages displayed onthe multi-information display. Movethe tires to the positions shown inthe illustration each time they arerotated. If you purchase directionaltires, rotate only front-to-back.
When the tires are rotated, makesure the air pressures are checked.
Your tires have wear indicatorsmolded into the tread. When thetread wears down, you will see a 1/2inch (12.7 mm) wide band across thetread. This shows there is less than1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left onthe tire.
Tire Maintenance Tire Rotation
Tires
418
INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Front Front
(For DirectionalTires and Wheels)
(For Non-directionalTires and Wheels)
Improper wheel weights can damageyour vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Useonly Acura wheel weights f or balancing.
06/08/12 19:14:05 31SJA620 0423
It is best to replace all four tires atthe same time. If that is not possibleor necessary, replace the two fronttires or two rear tires as a pair.Replacing just one tire can seriouslyaffect your vehicle’s handling.
Wheels:Replace your tires with radial tires ofthe same size, load range, speedrating, and maximum cold tirepressure rating (as shown on thetire’s sidewall).
Mixing radial and bias-ply tires onyour vehicle can reduce brakingability, traction, and steeringaccuracy. Using tires of a differentsize or construction can cause theABS and vehicle stability assistsystem (VSA) to work inconsistently.
If you ever need to replace a wheel,make sure the wheel’s specificationsmatch those of the original wheelthat came on your vehicle.Replacement wheels are available atyour Acura dealer.
Tires:
See page for DOT tire qualitygrading information, and page
for tire size explanation.
462
464
On models with the Michelin PAXsystem
On models with the Michelin PAXsystem
Replacing Tires and Wheels Wheels and Tires
Tires
Maintenance
419
17 x 8.0J AL (TPMS)
P245/50R17 98V
245-680R460A 102V
235 x 460A (TPMS)
Installing improper tires on yourvehicle can affect handling andstability. This can cause a crashin which you can be seriouslyhurt or killed.
Always use the size and type oftires recommended in thisowner’s manual.
06/08/12 19:14:15 31SJA620 0424
+Tires marked ‘‘M S’’ or ‘‘AllSeason’’ on the sidewall have an all-weather tread design suitable formost winter driving conditions.
For the best performance in snowyor icy conditions, you should installsnow tires or tire chains. They maybe required by local laws undercertain conditions.
Mount tire chains on your tires whenrequired by driving conditions orlocal laws. Install them only on thefront tires.
If you mount snow tires on yourvehicle, make sure they are radialtires of the same size and load rangeas the original tires. Mount snowtires on all four wheels. The tractionprovided by snow tires on dry roadsmay be lower than your original tires.Check with the tire dealer formaximum speed recommendations.
Because your vehicle has limited tireclearance, Acura stronglyrecommends using the chain listedbelow, made by Security ChainCompany (SCC).
Tire chains cannot be used with aflat front tire. If a front tire goes flatwhen a tire chain is installed on it,remove the chain, and follow theprecautions described underMichelin PAX System (see page
).
Cable-type: SCC Radial ChainCH2612T
422
Winter Driving Tire ChainsSnow Tires
Tires
420
06/08/12 19:14:22 31SJA620 0425
When installing cables, follow themanufacturer’s instructions, andmount them as tight as you can.Make sure they are not contactingthe brake lines or suspension. Driveslowly with them installed. If youhear them coming into contact withthe body or chassis, stop andinvestigate. Remove them as soon asyou begin driving on cleared roads.
Your vehicle is not designed forMichelin PAX system wheels or tires.Use only the wheels and tiresdesignated in this owner’s manual.Never mix conventional wheels ortires with PAX system wheels ortires.
Vehicles without the Michelin PAXSystem
Tires
Maintenance
421
Using the wrong chains, or notproperly installing chains, candamage the brake lines andcause a crash in which you canbe seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding theselection and use of tire chains.
Traction devices that are the wrongsize or improperly installed candamage your vehicle’s brake lines,suspension, body, and wheels. Stopdriving if they are hitting any part ofthe vehicle.
06/08/12 19:14:27 31SJA620 0426
There are no snow tires compatiblewith the PAX system, and not all tirechains are suitable for use on thePAX system tires. To prevent tirechain damage to the PAX systemtires or wheels, ensure that no partof the chain contacts the PAXsystem.
If you must continue driving with aflat tire, follow all the proceduresand precautions described on page
.
Never use a tire repair agent in aPAX system tire, and never repaira PAX system tire by yourself.Repair or replacement must bedone by an Acura dealer or anauthorized Michelin PAX systemdealer.
Your vehicle is equipped with theMichelin PAX system which,together with the tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS), enablesyou to continue driving even if one ormore of your tires loses its pressure.
The tires and wheels on your vehicleare specially designed for the PAXsystem, and the PAX system isspecifically designed and fine-tunedfor your vehicle.
Because of these reasons, use onlythe wheels and tires designated inthis owner’s manual. Never mix PAXsystem wheels or tires withconventional wheels or tires.
Do not replace the PAX system tiresand wheels with conventional tiresand wheels. Doing so would disablethe PAX system and the tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS),and may void your new vehiclewarranty.
If you mount snow chains on youtires, use the chains recommendedby Acura (see page ).420
428
If equippedMichelin PAX System Important Precautions
Tires
422
TM
06/08/12 19:14:36 31SJA620 0427
-
Check the condition of the batterymonthly by looking at the testindicator window. The label on thebattery explains the test indicator’scolors.
Battery posts,terminals, and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.
Check the terminals for corrosion (awhite or yellowish powder). Toremove it, cover the terminals with asolution of baking soda and water. Itwill bubble up and turn brown. Whenthis stops, wash it off with plainwater. Dry off the battery with acloth or paper towel. Coat theterminals with grease to help preventfuture corrosion.
If additional battery maintenance isneeded, see your dealer or aqualified technician.
If you need to connect the battery toa charger, disconnect both cables toprevent damaging your vehicle’selectrical system. Always disconnectthe negative ( ) cable first, andreconnect it last.
To see the label, remove the batterycover (see page ).424
CONTINUED
WARNING:
Wash your hands after handling.
Checking the Battery
Maintenance
423
TEST INDICATOR WINDOW
The battery gives off explosivehydrogen gas during normaloperation.
A spark or flame can cause thebattery to explode with enoughforce to kill or seriously hurt you.
Wear protective clothing and aface shield, or have a skilledtechnician do the batterymaintenance.
06/08/12 19:14:43 31SJA620 0428
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, all storeddriving positions will be lost. Tostore the driving positions again, seethe storing procedure on page .
The navigation system will alsodisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to thenavigation system manual.
Turn the knob of the battery coverto UNLOCK as shown in theillustration.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the audiosystem will disable itself. The nexttime you turn on the radio you willsee ‘‘ ’’ in the frequencydisplay. Use the preset buttons toenter the five-digit code (see page
).
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, thepower tilt and telescopic steeringwheel system will be disabled. Thesystem needs to be reset afterreconnecting the battery (see page
).The compass System will alsodisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Enter the four-digit anti-theft security code (seepage ). You will also need resetthe clock according to theinstruction of setting the clock (seepage ).
1.
160
239
147
272
257
On vehicles with navigation system
On vehicles without navigation system
Checking the Battery
Removing the Battery Cover
424
KNOBTAB
LOCKUNLOCK
06/08/12 19:14:53 31SJA620 0429
Block the rear wheels.
If the vehicle is to be stored for alonger period, it should besupported on jackstands so thetires are off the ground.
Leave one window open slightly (ifthe vehicle is being storedindoors).
Disconnect the battery.
Support the front wiper bladearms with a folded towel or rag sothey do not touch the windshield.
To minimize sticking, apply asilicone spray lubricant to all doorand trunk seals. Also, apply avehicle body wax to the paintedsurfaces that mate with the doorand trunk seals.
If you need to park your vehicle foran extended period (more than 1month), there are several things youshould do to prepare it for storage.Proper preparation helps preventdeterioration and makes it easier toget your vehicle back on the road. Ifpossible, store your vehicle indoors.
Fill the fuel tank.
Change the engine oil and filter.
Wash and dry the exteriorcompletely.
Clean the interior. Make sure thecarpeting, floor mats, etc., arecompletely dry.
Leave the parking brake off. Putthe transmission in Park.
Push the tabs and remove thecover by pulling it up carefully.
To reinstall the cover, put the tabsof the cover back to the originalposition properly.
Turn the knob of the cover toLOCK position as shown in theillustration.
2.
3.
4.
Vehicle Storage
Maintenance
425
06/08/12 19:15:04 31SJA620 0430
Cover the vehicle with a‘‘breathable’’ cover, one madefrom a porous material such ascotton. Non-porous materials, suchas plastic sheeting, trap moisture,which can damage the paint.
If possible, periodically run theengine until it reaches fulloperating temperature (thecooling fans cycle on and offtwice). Preferably, do this once amonth.
Vehicle Storage
426
06/08/12 19:15:08 31SJA620 0431
This section covers the morecommon problems that motoristsexperience with their vehicles. Itgives you information about how tosafely evaluate the problem and whatto do to correct it. If the problem hasstranded you on the side of the road,you may be able to get going again.If not, you will also find instructionson getting your vehicle towed.
...............Driving with a Flat Tire . 428......................Compact Spare Tire . 431....................Changing a Flat Tire . 432
.............If the Engine Won’t Start . 436................................Jump Starting . 437
..............If the Engine Overheats . 440.........Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 443..........Charging System Indicator . 443
.......Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 444...............Brake System Indicator . 445
Opening the Fuel Fill Door....................................Manually . 446
..............................................Fuses . 447..............................Fuse Locations . 452
......................Emergency Towing . 455..........If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck . 455
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
427
06/08/12 19:15:11 31SJA620 0432
Your vehicle is equipped with theMichelin PAX system. Since eachMichelin PAX system tire has aninner support ring that allows it tocontinue running without air, it maybe difficult to immediately judgefrom its appearance if a tire ispunctured. Your vehicle is alsoequipped with a tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS), and thissystem may be your first detection ofa flat tire.
If the indicator and the messagecome on again, you probably have aflat tire. In this case, you will see a‘‘PAX SYSTEM WARNING’’message on the multi-informationdisplay.
The TPMS monitors the air pressureof all four tires whenever the ignitionswitch is in the ON (II) position. Itwill immediately sense if a tire startsto lose its pressure, and give youwarning with the low tire pressureindicator in the instrument panel anda ‘‘CHECK TIRE PRESSURE’’message on the multi-informationdisplay. If the indicator and thewarning message do not come onagain after you inflate the tire to itscorrect air pressure (see page ),
it was probably a natural loss of theair pressure and you can continuedriving as before.
417
If equipped
Driving With a Flat Tire
Michelin PAX System
428
TM
06/08/12 19:15:17 31SJA620 0433
If you get a flat tire, never try torepair it yourself, and never replace aflat tire with a compact spare tire.
With the PAX system tires, you candrive up to about 125 miles (200 km)even if one or more of your tires arepunctured. This allows you to driveto the nearest Acura dealer orauthorized Michelin PAX systemdealer to have the tire(s) repaired.
The above message shows that youare driving your vehicle on a flat tire,and should observe the ‘‘RUN FLATDRIVING’’ speed limit of 50 mph(80 km/h). Drive to your nearestAcura dealer or authorized MichelinPAX system dealer, or call the PAXhelp hotline at 1-877-PAXTIRE(1-877-729-8473).
If the display changes to the abovemessage, it means that ‘‘RUN FLATDRIVING’’ is nearing the limit, andyou have to stop driving soon. Takeyour vehicle to the nearest Acuradealer or authorized Michelin PAXsystem dealer as soon as possible.
Follow the instructions shown on themulti-information display, and drivevery carefully.
CONTINUED
Driving With a Flat Tire
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
429
06/08/12 19:15:24 31SJA620 0434
If you see the above message on themulti-information display, you havereached the limit of run flat driving,and you should stop drivingimmediately. Be aware that if youcontinue to drive, the noise andvibration level from the tire willincrease significantly, and the tiremay no longer be repairable.
Stop driving immediately whenyou see a ‘‘RUN FLAT LIMITSTOP DRIVING’’ message on themulti-information display.Continuous driving after thismessage will make it impossible torepair the tire.
Call a professional towing servicewho can transport your vehicle onflat-bed equipment. Never tow your
vehicle behind another vehicle with arope or chain. Flat-bed equipment isthe only way to transport yourvehicle.
Do not drive faster than 50 mph(80 km/h).
Drive carefully. Your vehicle mayhandle differently from when thetires are properly inflated,especially when cornering.
In its run flat mode, a PAX systemtire is somewhat noisier than whenit is fully inflated, this is normal.
Although your vehicle is capable ofrun flat driving, you should alwaysobserve the following: If you cannot find an Acura dealer or
an authorized Michelin PAX systemdealer where you are driving, call thePAX help hotline at 1-877-PAXTIRE(1-877-729-8473).
Driving With a Flat Tire
Important Safety Precautions
430
06/08/12 19:15:32 31SJA620 0435
Use the compact spare tire as atemporary replacement only. Getyour regular tire repaired or replaced,and put it back on your vehicle assoon as you can.
Check the inflation pressure of thecompact spare tire every time youcheck the other tires. It should beinflated to:
Replace the tire when you can seethe tread wear indicator bars. Thereplacement should be the same sizeand design tire, mounted on thesame wheel. The spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularwheel, and the spare wheel is notdesigned for mounting a regular tire.
Do not mount snow chains on thecompact spare tire.
Do not use your compact sparetire on another vehicle unless it isthe same make and model.
Follow these precautions:
Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
This tire gives a harsher ride andless traction on some roadsurfaces. Use greater cautionwhile driving.
Compact Spare Tire
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
431
INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
06/08/12 19:15:41 31SJA620 0436
Take the tool case out of the sparetire.
Open the trunk, and fold the trunkfloor forward.
Unscrew the wing bolt, andremove the spacer cone. Thentake the spare tire out of its well.
If you have a flat tire while driving,stop in a safe place to change it.Drive slowly along the shoulder untilyou get to an exit or an area to stopthat is far away from the traffic lanes.
Park the vehicle on firm, level, andnon-slippery ground. Put thetransmission in Park. Apply theparking brake.If you are towing a trailer, unhitchit.
Turn on the hazard warning lights,and turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Have allpassengers get out of the vehiclewhile you change the tire.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Models without Michelin PAX System
Changing a Flat Tire
432
SPARE TIRETRUNK FLOOR
TOOL CASE JACK
The vehicle can easily roll offthe jack, seriously injuringanyone underneath.
Follow the directions forchanging a tire exactly, andnever get under the vehiclewhen it is supported only by thejack.
06/08/12 19:15:48 31SJA620 0437
△
Use the extension and the wheelnut wrench as shown to raise thevehicle until the flat tire is off theground.
Remove the wheel nuts, thenremove the flat tire. Temporarilyplace the flat tire on the groundwith the outside surface of thewheel facing up. You could scratchthe wheel if you put it face down.
Loosen each wheel nut 1/2 turnwith the wheel nut wrench.
Place the jack under the jackingpoint nearest the tire you need tochange. It is pointed to by amark molded into the underside ofthe body. Turn the end bracketclockwise until the top of the jackcontacts the jacking point. Makesure the jacking point tab isresting in the jack notch.
6. 7. 8.
9.
CONTINUED
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
433
WHEEL NUT WRENCH
WHEEL NUT WRENCH
EXTENSION
06/08/12 19:15:57 31SJA620 0438
Before mounting the spare tire,wipe any dirt off the mountingsurface of the wheel and hub witha clean cloth. Wipe the hubcarefully; it may be hot fromdriving.
Put on the spare tire. Put thewheel nuts back on finger-tight,then tighten them in a crisscrosspattern with the wheel nut wrenchuntil the wheel is firmly againstthe hub. Do not try to tighten thewheel nuts fully.
Lower the vehicle to the ground,and remove the jack.
10. 11. 12.
Changing a Flat Tire
434
BRAKE HUB
06/08/12 19:16:03 31SJA620 0439
Store the jack and tools in the toolcase. Place the tool case in the flattire.
Tighten the wheel nuts securely inthe same crisscross pattern. Havethe wheel nut torque checked atthe nearest automotive servicefacility.Tighten the wheel nuts to:
Place the flat tire face down in thespare tire well.
Wrap the spacer cone and sparetire wing bolt with cloth or paper,and store them in the spare tirewell.
Lower the trunk floor, then closethe trunk lid.
Refer to(see page ).
14.13.
15.
16.
17.
18.366
Changing a Flat Tire
Changing a Tire withTPMS
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
435
SPACER CONE
WING BOLT
94 lbf·ft (127 N·m , 13 kgf·m)
Loose items can fly around theinterior in a crash and couldseriously injure the occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and toolssecurely before driving.
06/08/12 19:16:12 31SJA620 0440
You hear nothing, or almostnothing. The engine’s startermotor does not operate at all, oroperates very slowly.
You can hear the starter motoroperating normally, or the startermotor sounds like it is spinningfaster than normal, but the enginedoes not start up and run.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe START (III) position, you do nothear the normal noise of the enginetrying to start. You may hear aclicking sound, a series of clicks, ornothing at all.
Turn the ignition switch to theSTART (III) position. If theheadlights do not dim, check thecondition of the fuses. If the fusesare OK, there is probablysomething wrong with theelectrical circuit for the ignitionswitch or starter motor. You willneed a qualified technician todetermine the problem. See
on page .
Diagnosing why the engine won’tstart falls into two areas, dependingon what you hear when you turn theignition switch to the START (III)position:
Check these things:
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. Turn on theheadlights, and check theirbrightness. If the headlights arevery dim or do not come on at all,the battery is discharged. See
on page .
Check the transmission interlock.The transmission must be in Parkor neutral or the starter will notoperate.
Make sure the remote is with you,inside the vehicle.
If the headlights dim noticeably orgo out when you try to start theengine, either the battery isdischarged or the connections arecorroded. Check the condition of thebattery and terminal connections(see page ). You can then tryjump starting the vehicle from abooster battery (see page ).
437
455
423
437
Nothing Happens or the StarterMotor Operates Very Slowly
Emergency Towing
Jump Starting
If the Engine Won’t Start
436
06/08/12 19:16:21 31SJA620 0441
In this case, the starter motor’sspeed sounds normal, or even fasterthan normal, when you turn theignition switch to the START (III)position, but the engine does not run.
Are you using the proper startingprocedure? Refer to
on page .
There may be an electricalproblem, such as no power to thefuel pump. Check all the fuses(see page ).
If you find nothing wrong, you willneed a qualified technician to findthe problem. See
on page .
Are you using a properly codedbuilt-in key or remote? Animproperly coded built-in key orremote will cause the immobilizersystem indicator in the instrumentpanel to blink rapidly (see page
).
Do you have fuel? Check the fuelgauge; the low fuel indicator maynot be working.
Although this seems like a simpleprocedure, you should take severalprecautions.
You cannot start your vehicle bypushing or pulling it.
64
341
449
455
The Starter Operates Normally
Starting theEngine
EmergencyTowing
Jump Starting
If the Engine Won’t Start, Jump Starting
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
437
A battery can explode if you donot follow the correct procedure,seriously injuring anyonenearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames,and smoking materials awayfrom the battery.
06/08/12 19:16:29 31SJA620 0442
++
+
Open the hood, and check thephysical condition of the battery.In very cold weather, check thecondition of the electrolyte. If itseems slushy or frozen, do not tryjump starting until it thaws.
Turn off all the electrical acces-sories: heater, A/C, climatecontrol, stereo system, lights, etc.Put the transmission in Park, andset the parking brake.
Remove the battery cover (seepage ), then remove thesecondary under-hood fuse boxcover from the positive ( )terminal on the battery.
Connect one jumper cable to thepositive ( ) terminal on yourvehicle’s battery. Connect theother end to the positive ( )terminal on the booster battery.
The numbers in the illustration showyou the order to connect the jumpercables.
1.
2.
3.
4.
424
To Jump Start Your Vehicle:
Jump Starting
438
COVER
BOOSTER BATTERY
If a battery sits in extreme cold, theelectrolyte inside can f reeze.Attempting to jump start with a f rozenbattery can cause it to rupture.
06/08/12 19:16:38 31SJA620 0443
+-
Start your vehicle. If the startermotor still operates slowly, checkthat the jumper cables have goodmetal-to-metal contact.
Once your vehicle is running,disconnect the negative cable fromyour vehicle, then from thebooster battery. Disconnect thepositive cable from your vehicle,then from the booster battery.
Reinstall the secondary under-hood fuse box cover over thepositive ( ) terminal of thebattery, then reinstall the batterycover.
If the booster battery is in anothervehicle, have an assistant startthat vehicle and run it at a fast idle.
Connect the second jumper cableto the negative ( ) terminal onthe booster battery. Connect theother end to the grounding pointas shown. Do not connect thisjumper cable to any other part ofthe engine.
Keep the ends of the jumper cablesaway from each other and any metalon the vehicle until everything isdisconnected. Otherwise, you maycause an electrical short.
7.
5.
6.
8.
9.
Jump Starting
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
439
Connecting the jumper cable to thesecondary under-hood f use box causesthe f uses blown.
06/08/12 19:16:46 31SJA620 0444
The pointer of the vehicle’stemperature gauge should stay inthe midrange. If it climbs to the redmark, you should determine thereason (hot day, driving up a steephill, etc.).
If your vehicle overheats, you shouldtake immediate action. The onlyindication may be the temperaturegauge climbing to or above the redmark. Or you may see steam orspray coming from under the hood.
If you do not see steam or spray,leave the engine running, andwatch the temperature gauge. Ifthe high heat is due to overloading,the engine should start to cooldown almost immediately. If itdoes, wait until the temperaturegauge comes down to the midpoint,then continue driving.
If the temperature gauge stays atthe red mark, turn off the engine.
Look for any obvious coolant leaks,such as a split radiator hose.Everything is still extremely hot,so use caution. If you find a leak, itmust be repaired before youcontinue driving (see
on page ).
If you see steam and/or spraycoming from under the hood,turn off the engine. Wait untilyou see no more signs of steamor spray, then open the hood.
Safely pull to the side of the road.Put the transmission in Park, andset the parking brake. Turn off allaccessories, and turn on thehazard warning lights.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
455Emergency
Towing
If the Engine Overheats
440
Steam and spray from anoverheated engine canseriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steamis coming out.
Driving with the temperature gaugepointer at the red mark can causeserious damage to the engine.
06/08/12 19:16:54 31SJA620 0445
If you do not find an obvious leak,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Add coolantif the level is below the MIN mark.
If there was no coolant in thereserve tank, you may need to addcoolant to the radiator. Let theengine cool down until the pointerreaches the middle of the tempera-ture gauge, or lower, before check-ing the radiator.
Using gloves or a large heavycloth, turn the radiator capcounterclockwise, without pushingdown, to the first stop. After thepressure releases, push down onthe cap, and turn it until it comesoff.
Put the radiator cap back ontightly. Run the engine, and checkthe temperature gauge. If it goesback to the red mark, the engineneeds repair (see
on page ).
If the temperature stays normal,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. If it hasgone down, add coolant to theMAX mark. Put the cap back ontightly.
Start the engine, and set theinterior temperature to maximum(climate control to FULL AUTO at‘‘ ’’). Add coolant to theradiator up to the base of the fillerneck. If you do not have theproper coolant mixture available,you can add plain water.Remember to have the coolingsystem drained and refilled withthe proper mixture as soon as youcan.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
455Emergency
Towing
If the Engine Overheats
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
441
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
06/08/12 19:17:02 31SJA620 0446
You can still drive your vehicle evenif this message appears on the multi-information display, however youshould check the temperature gaugewhile driving.
If you notice the temperature gaugeclimbing to or above the red mark,Safely pull to the side of the road.Follow the instructions on pages
and .
If there is a problem with theradiator system, you will see a‘‘CHECK RADIATOR SYSTEM’’ onthe multi-information display.
If you see this message, the enginehas probably overheated. You shouldtake your vehicle to a dealer, andhave it repaired as soon as possible.
440 441
Check Radiator System
If the Engine Overheats
442
06/08/12 19:17:07 31SJA620 0447
Let the vehicle sit for a minute.Open the hood, and check the oillevel (see page ). An enginevery low on oil can lose pressureduring cornering and other drivingmaneuvers.
If necessary, add oil to bring thelevel back to the full mark on thedipstick (see page ).
Start the engine, and watch the oilpressure indicator. If it does not goout within 10 seconds, turn off theengine. There is a mechanicalproblem that needs to be repairedbefore you can continue driving(see on page
).
This indicator should nevercome on when the engine is
running. If it starts flashing or stayson, or if you see a ‘‘CHECK ENGINEOIL LEVEL’’ message on the multi-information display, the oil pressurehas dropped very low or lostpressure. Serious engine damage ispossible, and you should takeimmediate action.
If the charging systemindicator comes on brightly
when the engine is running, or if yousee a ‘‘CHECK CHARGINGSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display, the battery isnot being charged.
Immediately turn off all electricalaccessories. Try not to use otherelectrically operated controls such asthe power windows. Keep the enginerunning; starting the engine willdischarge the battery rapidly.
Go to a dealer or a service stationwhere you can get technicalassistance.
Safely pull off the road and shutoff the engine. Turn on the hazardwarning lights.
1.
2.
3.
4.
331
395
455
Low Oil Pressure Indicator
Emergency Towing
Charging System Indicator
Low Oil Pressure Indicator, Charging System Indicator
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
443
Running the engine with low oilpressure can cause serious mechanicaldamage almost immediately. Turn of fthe engine as soon as you can saf ely getthe vehicle stopped.
06/08/12 19:17:16 31SJA620 0448
To check if they are set, turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, without starting the engine.The malfunction indicator lamp willcome on for 20 seconds. If it thengoes off, the readiness codes are set.If it blinks five times, the readinesscodes are not set. If possible, do nottake your vehicle for a stateemissions test until the readinesscodes are set. Refer to
for moreinformation (see page ).
Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that are part of the on-boarddiagnostics for the emissionssystems. In some states, part of theemissions testing is to make surethese codes are set. If they are notset, the test cannot be completed.
If this indicator comes onwhile driving, or if you seea ‘‘CHECK EMISSION
SYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display, it means one ofthe engine’s emissions controlsystems may have a problem. Eventhough you may feel no difference inyour vehicle’s performance, it canreduce your fuel economy and causeincreased emissions. Continuedoperation may cause serious damage.
If the indicator comes on repeatedly,even though it may go off as youcontinue driving, have the vehiclechecked by your dealer as soon aspossible.
If you have recently refueled yourvehicle, the indicator coming oncould be due to a loose or missingfuel fill cap. You will also see a‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ message onthe multi-information display.Tighten the cap until it clicks at leastonce (see page ). Tightening thecap will not turn the indicator offimmediately; it can take several daysof normal driving.
If the battery in your vehicle hasbeen disconnected or gone dead,these codes are erased. It can takeseveral days of driving under variousconditions to set the codes again.
328
471
StateEmissions Testing
Readiness Code
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
444
If you keep driving with themalf unction indicator lamp on, you candamage your vehicle’s emissionscontrols and engine. Those repairs maynot be covered by your vehicle’swarranties.
06/08/12 19:17:23 31SJA620 0449
However, if the brake pedal does notfeel normal, you should takeimmediate action. A problem in onepart of the system’s dual circuitdesign will still give you braking attwo wheels. You will feel the brakepedal go down much farther beforethe vehicle begins to slow down, andyou will have to press harder on thepedal.
Slow down by shifting to a lowergear, and pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe. Because of the longdistance needed to stop, it ishazardous to drive the vehicle. Youshould have it towed and repaired assoon as possible (see
on page ).
If the fluid level is low, take yourvehicle to a dealer, and have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display.
If the brake system indicator comeson while driving, the brake fluid levelis probably low. You will see a‘‘BRAKE FLUID LOW’’ message onthe multi-information display. Presslightly on the brake pedal to see if itfeels normal. If it does, check thebrake fluid level the next time youstop at a service station (see page
).
The brake systemindicator normallycomes on when
you turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position and as a reminder tocheck the parking brake. If you donot release the parking brake, theindicator will stay on, and you willsee a ‘‘RELEASE PARKINGBRAKE’’ message on the multi-information display.
402
455Emergency
Towing
Brake System Indicator
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
445
U.S. Canada
06/08/12 19:17:30 31SJA620 0450
If you must drive the vehicle a shortdistance in this condition, driveslowly and carefully.
If the ABS indicator and the VSAsystem indicator come on with thebrake system indicator, have yourvehicle inspected by your dealerimmediately.
If the fuel fill door release buttondoes not work, use the release leverinside the left maintenance lid in thetrunk.
To open the fuel fill door, pull therelease lever rearward.
Brake System Indicator, Opening the Fuel Fill Door Manually
Opening the Fuel Fill DoorManually
446
LID RELEASE LEVER
06/08/12 19:17:36 31SJA620 0451
To remove the fuse box lid, put yourfinger in the notch on the lid, pull ittoward you, and take it out of itshinges.
The fuses are located in five fuseboxes. The interior fuse boxes arelocated under the dashboard on thedriver’s and passenger’s side.
To open the secondary fuse box lid,push the tab in the direction asshown in the illustration.
Fuses
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
447
FUSE BOX TAB
INTERIOR FUSE BOXINTERIOR FUSE BOXDriver’s side
SECONDARY INTERIOR FUSE BOXDriver’s sidePassenger’s side
NOTCH NOTCH
06/08/12 19:17:43 31SJA620 0452
The primary under-hood fuse box isin the engine compartment on thedriver’s side. To open it, push thetabs as shown.
The secondary under-hood fuse boxis on the battery. To open it, pushthe tabs as shown.
To check the fuse box, remove thebattery cover first (see page ).424
Fuses
448
PRIMARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX SECONDARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
TAB
TAB
06/08/12 19:17:50 31SJA620 0453
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Make sure theheadlights and all otheraccessories are off.
If something electrical in yourvehicle stops working, the first thingyou should check for is a blown fuse.Determine from the chart on pages
, , and , or the diagramon the fuse box lid, which fuse orfuses control that device. Checkthose fuses first, but check all thefuses before deciding that a blownfuse is the cause. Replace any blownfuses, and check if the device works.
Check each of the large fuses inthe under-hood fuse box bylooking through the top at the wireinside. Removing these fusesrequires a Phillips-headscrewdriver.
Check the smaller fuses in theunder-hood fuse box and all thefuses in the interior fuse boxes bypulling out each fuse with the fusepuller. The fuse puller is inside theprimary under-hood fuse box.Remove the cover from the fuse
box.
3. 4.1.
2.
452 453 454
Checking and Replacing Fuses
Fuses
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
449
FUSE
BLOWN
FUSEPULLER
06/08/12 19:17:58 31SJA620 0454
If you cannot drive the vehiclewithout fixing the problem, and youdo not have a spare fuse, take a fuseof the same rating or a lower ratingfrom one of the other circuits withthe fuse puller provided in the under-hood fuse box. Make sure you cando without that circuit temporarily(such as the accessory power socketor radio).If you replace the blown fuse with aspare fuse that has a lower rating, itmight blow out again. This does notindicate anything wrong. Replace thefuse with one of the correct rating assoon as you can.
If the replacement fuse of thesame rating blows in a short time,there is probably a seriouselectrical problem with yourvehicle. Leave the blown fuse inthat circuit, and have your vehiclechecked by a qualified technician.
Look for a blown wire inside thefuse. If it is blown, replace it withone of the spare fuses of the samerating or lower.
6.
5.
Fuses
450
BLOWN
Replacing a f use with one that has ahigher rating greatly increases thechances of damaging the electricalsystem. If you do not have areplacement f use with the proper ratingf or the circuit, install one with a lowerrating.
06/08/12 19:18:03 31SJA620 0455
If the fuse for the driving positionmemory system is removed, allstored driving positions will be lost.To store the driving positions again,see page .
If the navigation system fuse isremoved, the navigation system willdisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to thenavigation system manual.
If the compass system fuse isremoved, the compass system willdisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Enter the four-digit anti-theft security code (seepage ). You will also need resetthe clock according to theinstruction of the clock setting (see
page ).
If the radio fuse is removed, theaudio system will disable itself. Thenext time you turn on the audiosystem you will see ‘‘ ’’ in thefrequency display. Use the presetbuttons to enter the five-digit code(see page ).
If the fuse for the power tilttelescopic steering is removed, thesystem will be disabled. The systemneeds to be reset after reinstallingthe fuse (see page ).
160
257
239
148
272
On vehicles with navigation system
On vehicles without navigation system
Fuses
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
451
06/08/12 19:18:10 31SJA620 0456
*
*
No. Amps.
No. Amps.
No.
Circuits Protected
Circuits Protected Amps. Circuits Protected
123456789
1011121314
15 A30 A10 A15 A10 A15 A
7.5 A15 A30 A30 A20 A7.5 A15 A40 A
1 50 A
1516171819202122
23
Radiator fan
Left headlight low beamRear defroster coilLeft headlight high beamSmall lightRight headlight high beamRight headlight low beamBack-upFI ECUWiperHeadlight washerFog lightsMG clutchHorn, StopRear defroster
40 A15 A30 A40 A40 A
(40 A)40 A70 A
120 A50 A50 A
Back-up, ACCHazardABS/VSA motorABS/VSADrive by wire, LAF heaterOptionHeater motorPassenger’s fuse boxBatteryIG mainPower window
: On Canadian models
Fuse Locations
452
PRIMARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
SECONDARY UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOX
06/08/12 19:18:19 31SJA620 0457
No.
No. Circuits Protected
Amps.
Amps.
Amps.No.Circuits Protected Circuits Protected123456789
10
111213141516
12
Starter diag.Starter signal
15 A15 A10 A15 A7.5 A7.5 A10 A20 A20 A7.5 A
7.5 A7.5 A20 A20 A10 A20 A
7.5 A7.5 A
20 A15 A20 A15 A10 A10 A7.5 A20 A20 A20 A30 A20 A7.5 A
7.5 A7.5 A10 A
(7.5 A)
17181920212223242526272829
30313233
Drive by WireIgnition coilDaytime running lightLAF heaterRadioInterior lightBack-upDoor lockAccessory socketOccupant position detectionsystemWiper
Driver’s power seat slidingPower lumbar supportDriver’s power seat reclining
ACGFuel PumpIGN SOLMeterSRSIGP (PGM-FI ECU)Left rear power windowETS (telescopic)ETS (tilt)Driver’s power windowMoonroofAdaptive Front LightingSystemAir Conditionere-pretensionerACCOption
Tire pressure monitoring systemPassenger’s power seat reclining
Passenger’s power seat sliding
Fuse Locations
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
453
INTERIOR FUSE BOXDriver’s side
SECONDARY INTERIOR FUSE BOXDriver’s side
06/08/12 19:18:27 31SJA620 0458
No. Amps. Circuits Protected No. Amps. Circuits Protected1234
5
30 A30 A30 A30 A
20 A
SH-AWDPremium amplifierPassenger’s power windowDriver’s automatic seat belttensioner/e-pretensionerRight rear power window
67
8
9
20 A7.5 A
30 A
7.5 A
Heated seatsInterior lightsPassenger’s automatic seatbelt tensioner/e-pretensionerAir conditioner
Fuse Locations
454
INTERIOR FUSE BOXPassenger’s side
06/08/12 19:18:34 31SJA620 0459
To use the towing hook:Remove the cover from the frontbumper by pushing the rightcorner edge of the cover with afinger until the cover comes out asshown in the illustration.
The operator will loadyour vehicle on the back of a truck.Any other method of towing willdamage the drive system. When youcontact the towing agency, informthem a flat-bed is required.
If your vehicle needs to be towed,call a professional towing service ororganization. Never tow your vehiclewith just a rope or chain. It is verydangerous.
If your vehicle gets stuck in sand,mud, or snow, call a towing serviceto pull it out (see the previouscolumn).
For very short distances, such asfreeing the vehicle, you can use thedetachable towing hook that mountson the anchor in the front bumper.
1.
Emergency Towing, If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
The only way you can safely towyour vehicle is with flat-bedequipment.
Emergency Towing If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
455
Push
COVER
Towing with only two tires on theground will damage parts of theall-wheel-drive system. Your vehicleshould be transported on a f lat-bedtruck or trailer.
06/08/12 19:18:42 31SJA620 0460
Screw the towing hook into thehole, and tighten it with the wheelnut wrench.
Remove the towing hook andwheel nut wrench from the toolcase in the spare tire.
The cover is attached to the bumperwith a tether.
2.
3.
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
456
WHEEL NUT WRENCHCOVER
TETHER
To avoid damage to your vehicle, usethe towing hook f or straight, f latground towing only. Do not tow at anangle. The tow hook should not be usedto tow the vehicle onto a f lat bed. Donot use it as a tie down.
06/08/12 19:18:48 31SJA620 0461
-
The diagrams in this section giveyou the dimensions and capacities ofyour vehicle, and the location ofidentification numbers. It alsoincludes information you shouldknow about your vehicle’s tires andemissions control systems.
................Identification Numbers . 458................................Specifications . 460
DOT Tire Quality Grading......................(U.S. Vehicles) . 462
.................................Treadwear . 462......................................Traction . 462
.............................Temperature . 463.................................Tire Labeling . 464
Tire Pressure Monitoring System(TPMS) Required Federal
............................Explanation . 466
.......................Emissions Controls . 468.....................The Clean Air Act . 468
Crankcase Emissions Control....................................System . 468
Evaporative Emissions Control....................................System . 468
Onboard Refueling Vapor................................Recovery . 468
...Exhaust Emissions Controls . 469....................PGM-FI System . 469
Ignition Timing Control................................System . 469
Exhaust Gas Recirculation...................(EGR) System . 469
Three Way Catalytic...........................Converter . 469
....................Replacement Parts . 469Three Way Catalytic
.................................Converters . 470..............State Emissions Testing . 471
Technical Information
TechnicalInform
ation
457
06/08/12 19:18:52 31SJA620 0462
Your vehicle has several identifyingnumbers in various places.
The vehicle identification number(VIN) is the 17-digit number yourdealer uses to register your vehiclefor warranty purposes. It is alsonecessary for licensing and insuringyour vehicle. The easiest place tofind the VIN is on a plate fastened tothe top of the dashboard. You cansee it by looking through thewindshield on the driver’s side. It isalso on the certification labelattached to the driver’s doorjamb,and is stamped on the enginecompartment bulkhead. The VIN isalso provided in bar code on thecertification label.
Identif ication Numbers
458
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
CERTIFICATION LABEL
U.S. vehicle is shown.
06/08/12 19:18:56 31SJA620 0463
The engine number is stamped intothe engine block. It is on the frontleft, below the valve cover.
The transmission number is on alabel on top of the transmission.
Identif ication Numbers
TechnicalInform
ation
459
ENGINE NUMBER
TRANSMISSION NUMBER
06/08/12 19:19:00 31SJA620 0464
- -
*
*
*
*
Specifications
460
Dimensions
Weights
Air Conditioning
Capacities
4.2 US qt (4.0 )
193.6 in (4,917 mm)72.7 in (1,847 mm)57.1 in (1,451 mm)110.2 in (2,800 mm)62.0 in (1,576 mm)62.4 in (1,585 mm)
HFC-134a (R-134a)15.8 17.60 oz (450 500 g)
ND-OIL8
1.59 US gal (6.0 )2.27 US gal (8.6 )
4.5 US qt (4.3 )
5.3 US qt (5.0 )2.9 US qt (2.7 )7.6 US qt (7.2 )
LengthWidthHeightWheelbaseTrack
Gross vehicle weight rating
Refrigerant typeCharge quantityLubricant type
See the certification label attachedto the driver’s doorjamb.
0.79 US qt (0.75 )0.77 US qt (0.73 )
Excluding the oil remaining in the engine
Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in theengineReserve tank capacity:
6.9 US qt (6.5 )2.6 US qt (2.5 )
0.45 US qt (0.43 )0.48 US qt (0.45 )
3.3 US qt (3.1 )
Fuel tank
EnginecoolantEngine oil
AutomatictransmissionfluidRear differential fluid
SH-AWDdifferentialcaseSH-AWDclutch case
TransferassemblyfluidWindshieldwasherreservoir
1 :
2 :
Approx.
FrontRear
ChangeTotalChange
Including filterWithout filter
TotalChangeTotal
ChangeTotal
ChangeTotalChangeTotal
U.S. vehiclesCanadianvehicles
19.4 US gal (73 )
0.16 US gal (0.58 )
2.8 US qt (2.7 )
1
2
06/08/12 19:19:16 31SJA620 0465
--
--
**
*
*
-------------
*
+-
*
*
*
Specifications
TechnicalInform
ation
461
Engine
Alignment
Tires
Lights
Fuses
Battery
12 V12 V
60 W24/2.2 CP
12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V
TypeBore x StrokeDisplacementCompression ratioSpark plugs
Spark plug gap
3.54 x 3.58 in (89 x 93 mm)212 cu-in (3,471 cm )
11.0 : 1IZFR6K11SKJ20DR-M11
0.04 in (1.1 mm)
0.00 in (0.0 mm)0.08 in (2.0 mm)
0°8’1°15’
2°10’
P245/50R17 98V
SOHC VTEC V-6 gasoline engine
Toe-in
Camber
Caster
Size
Pressure
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm )32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
T155/70D17 110M245-680R460A 102V
Headlights (High Beam)Front turn signal/parking lights
Front side markerRear turn signal lightsBack-up lightFog lightsLicense plate lightsCeiling lights
Vanity mirror lightsDoor courtesy lightsTrunk light 12 V 5 W
2 CP2 W8 W8 W5 W55 W21 W21 W3 CP
Low beam headlight bulbs are a type of high voltage dischargetube (D2S).
Interior
Under-hood
Capacity12 V12 V
72 AH/20 HR55 AH/5 HR
See page 453 and 454 or the fuselabel attached to the inside ofeach fuse box cover.See page 452 or the fuse boxcover.
12 V 21 W
FrontRearFrontRearFront
FrontRear
NGK:DENSO:
Front/Rear
SpareFrontRearSpare
1 : Michelin PAX system model2 : If equipped
(HB3)(Amber)
(5W)(Amber)
(H11)
On model without adaptive front lighting system
1 :
2 :
(Amber)
1
00.1 mm
1
2
2
06/08/12 19:19:42 31SJA620 0466
-The tires on your vehicle meet allU.S. Federal Safety Requirements.All tires are also graded fortreadwear, traction, and temperatureperformance according toDepartment of Transportation(DOT) standards. The followingexplains these gradings.
All passenger car tires must conformto Federal Safety Requirements inaddition to these grades.
Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween the tread shoulder and themaximum section width. Forexample:
The treadwear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified governmenttest course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on thegovernment course as a tire graded100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and maydepart significantly from the normdue to variations in driving habits,service practices, and differences inroad characteristics and climate.
The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Thosegrades represent the tire’s ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions onspecified government test surfacesof asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor tractionperformance.
Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based onstraight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Treadwear 200Traction AATemperature A
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Treadwear Traction AA, A, B, C
462
06/08/12 19:19:50 31SJA620 0467
-The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B, and C, representing thetire’s resistance to the generation ofheat and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustained hightemperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reducetire life, and excessive temperaturecan lead to sudden tire failure. Thegrade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger cartires must meet under the FederalMotor Vehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A representhigher levels of performance on thelaboratory test wheel than theminimum required by law.
Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and notoverloaded. Excessive speed,underinflation, or excessive loading,either separately or in combination,can cause heat buildup and possibletire failure.
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Temperature A, B, C
TechnicalInform
ation
463
06/08/12 19:19:55 31SJA620 0468
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Whenever tires are replaced, theyshould be replaced with tires of thesame size. Following is an exampleof tire size with an explanation ofwhat each component means.
Vehicle type (P indicatespassenger vehicle).
Tire width in millimeters.
Aspect ratio (the tire’s sectionheight as a percentage of itswidth).
Tire construction code (Rindicates radial).
Rim diameter in inches.
Load index (a numerical codeassociated with the maximumload the tire can carry).
Speed symbol (analphabetical code indicatingthe maximum speed rating).
The tire identification number (TIN)is a group of numbers and lettersthat look like the following exampleTIN. TIN is located on the sidewallof the tire.
The tires that came on your vehiclehave a number of markings. Thoseyou should be aware of are describedbelow.
Date of manufacture.
Tire type code.
Max Press The maximum airpressure the tire canhold.
Manufacturer’sidentification mark.
This indicates that the tiremeets all requirements ofthe U.S. Department ofTransportation.
Max Load The maximum load thetire can carry atmaximum air pressure.
P
R
V
DOT
FW6X
2202
245
50
17
98
B97R
Tire Labeling
Tire Size
Tire Identif ication Number
Maximum Tire Pressure
Maximum Tire Load
464
P245/50R17 98V
DOT B97R FW6X 2202
06/08/12 19:20:12 31SJA620 0469
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Load index (a numerical codeassociated with the maximumload the tire can carry).
Speed symbol (analphabetical code indicatingthe maximum speed rating).
The PAX system tires have differentmarkings from conventional tiremarkings. Following is an example ofPAX system tire size with anexplanation of what each componentmeans.
Symmetric
Nominal diameter at the rimseat in millimeters.
Tire construction code (Rindicates radial)
Outside diameter of the tire inmillimeters.
Tire width in millimeters.
A
R
460
680
245
102
V
If equipped
Tire Labeling (PAX System Tires)
PAX System Tire Labeling
TechnicalInform
ation
465
TM
245-680R460A 102V
06/08/12 19:20:22 31SJA620 0470
-
Each tire, including the spare (ifprovided), should be checkedmonthly when cold and inflated tothe inflation pressure recommendedby the vehicle manufacturer on thevehicle placard or tire inflationpressure label.
(If your vehicle has tires of adifferent size than the size indicatedon the vehicle placard or tireinflation pressure label, you shoulddetermine the proper tire inflationpressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, yourvehicle has been equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that illuminates a low tire pressuretelltale
when one or more of your tires issignificantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tirepressure telltale illuminates, youshould stop and check your tires assoon as possible, and inflate them tothe proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Under-inflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not asubstitute for proper tiremaintenance, and it is the driver’sresponsibility to maintain correct tirepressure, even if under-inflation hasnot reached the level to triggerillumination of the TPMS low tirepressure telltale.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
466
06/08/12 19:20:28 31SJA620 0471
-
Your vehicle has also been equippedwith a TPMS malfunction indicatorto indicate when the system is notoperating properly. The TPMSmalfunction indicator is provided bya separate telltale, which displays thesymbol ‘‘TPMS’’ when illuminated.
When the malfunction indicator isilluminated,
the system may not be able to detector signal low tire pressure asintended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for avariety of reasons, including theinstallation of replacement oralternate tires or wheels on thevehicle that prevent the TPMS fromfunctioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunctiontelltale after replacing one or moretires or wheels on your vehicle toensure that the replacement oralternate tires and wheels allow theTPMS to continue to functionproperly.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
TechnicalInform
ation
467
06/08/12 19:20:34 31SJA620 0472
*
*The burning of gasoline in yourvehicle’s engine produces several by-products. Some of these are carbonmonoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen(NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC).Gasoline evaporating from the tankalso produces hydrocarbons. Con-trolling the production of NOx, CO,and HC is important to the environ-ment. Under certain conditions ofsunlight and climate, NOx and HCreact to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’Carbon monoxide does not contri-bute to smog creation, but it is apoisonous gas.
In Canada, Acura vehicles complywith the Canadian emissionrequirements, as specified in anagreement with EnvironmentCanada, at the time they aremanufactured.
Your vehicle has a positivecrankcase ventilation system. Thiskeeps gasses that build up in theengine’s crankcase from going intothe atmosphere. The positive
crankcase ventilation valve routesthem from the crankcase back to theintake manifold. They are thendrawn into the engine and burned.
As gasoline evaporates in the fueltank, an evaporative emissionscontrol canister filled with charcoaladsorbs the vapor. It is stored in thiscanister while the engine is off. Afterthe engine is started and warmed up,the vapor is drawn into the engineand burned during driving.
The onboard refueling vaporrecovery (ORVR) system capturesthe fuel vapors during refueling. Thevapors are adsorbed in a canisterfilled with activated carbon. Whiledriving, the fuel vapors are drawninto the engine and burned off.
The United States Clean Air Actsets standards for automobileemissions. It also requires thatautomobile manufacturers explain toowners how their emissions controlswork and what to do to maintainthem. This section summarizes howthe emissions controls work.Scheduled maintenance is on pages
and .389 390
The Clean Air Act
Crankcase Emissions ControlSystem
Evaporative Emissions ControlSystem
Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery
Emissions Controls
468
06/08/12 19:20:42 31SJA620 0473
The exhaust emissions controlsinclude four systems: PGM-FI,ignition timing control, exhaust gasrecirculation, and three way catalyticconverter. These four systems worktogether to control the engine’scombustion and minimize theamount of HC, CO, and NOx thatcome out the tailpipe. The exhaustemissions control systems areseparate from the crankcase andevaporative emissions controlsystems.
The PGM-FI system uses sequentialmultiport fuel injection.It has three subsystems: air intake,engine control, and fuel control. Thepowertrain control module (PCM)uses various sensors to determinehow much air is going into theengine. It then controls how muchfuel to inject under all operatingconditions.
This system constantly adjusts theignition timing, reducing the amountof HC, CO, and NOx produced.
The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR)system takes some of the exhaustgas and routes it back into the intakemanifold. Adding exhaust gas to theair/fuel mixture reduces the amountof NOx produced when the fuel isburned.
The emissions control systems aredesigned and certified to worktogether in reducing emissions tolevels that comply with the Clean AirAct. To make sure the emissionsremain low, you should use only newAcura replacement parts or theirequivalent for repairs. Using lowerquality parts may increase theemissions from your vehicle.
The emissions control systems arecovered by warranties separate fromthe rest of your vehicle. Read yourwarranty manual for more informa-tion.The three way catalytic converters
are in the exhaust system. Throughchemical reactions, they convert HC,CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaustto carbon dioxide (CO ), nitrogen(N ), and water vapor.
2
2
Exhaust Emissions Controls Replacement Parts
PGM-FI System
Ignition Timing Control System
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)System
Three Way Catalytic Converter
Emissions Controls
TechnicalInform
ation
469
06/08/12 19:20:51 31SJA620 0474
The three way catalytic converterscontain precious metals that serve ascatalysts, promoting chemicalreactions to convert the exhaustgasses without affecting the metals.The catalytic converters are referredto as three-way catalysts, since theyact on HC, CO, and NOx.Replacement units must be originalAcura parts or their equivalent.
The three way catalytic convertersmust operate at a high temperaturefor the chemical reactions to takeplace. They can set on fire anycombustible materials that comenear them. Park your vehicle awayfrom high grass, dry leaves, or otherflammables.
A defective three way catalyticconverter contributes to air pollution,and can impair your engine’s per-formance. Follow these guidelines toprotect your vehicle’s three waycatalytic converters.
Always use unleaded gasoline.Even a small amount of leadedgasoline can contaminate thecatalyst metals, making the threeway catalytic convertersineffective.
Have your vehicle diagnosed andrepaired if it is misfiring, back-firing, stalling, or otherwise notrunning properly.
Keep the engine well maintained.
Three Way Catalytic Converters
470
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTERS
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
06/08/12 19:20:58 31SJA620 0475
If you take your vehicle for a stateemissions test shortly after thebattery has been disconnected orgone dead, it may not pass the test.This is because of certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that must be set in the on-board diagnostics for the emissionssystems. These codes are erasedwhen the battery is disconnected,and set again only after several daysof driving under a variety ofconditions.
If the testing facility determines thatthe readiness codes are not set, youwill be requested to return at a laterdate to complete the test. If you mustget the vehicle retested within thenext two or three days, you cancondition the vehicle for retesting bydoing the following.
Make sure the gas tank is nearly,but not completely, full (around3/4).
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine, and let itidle for 20 seconds.
Keep the vehicle in Park. Increasethe engine speed to 2,000 rpm, andhold it there until the temperaturegauge rises to at least 1/4 of thescale (about 3 minutes).
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 6hours or more.
Make sure the ambienttemperature is between 40° and95°F.
Testing of Readiness Codes
State Emissions Testing
TechnicalInform
ation
471
06/08/12 19:21:05 31SJA620 0476
Then drive in city/suburbantraffic for at least 10 minutes.When traffic conditions allow, letthe vehicle coast for severalseconds without using theaccelerator pedal or the brakepedal.
Stop the vehicle, turn off theignition switch, and leave it off for30 minutes.
If the testing facility determines thereadiness codes are still not set, seeyour dealer.
Select a nearby lightly traveledmajor highway where you canmaintain a speed of 50 to 60 mphfor at least 20 minutes. Drive onthe highway in D. Do not use thecruise control. When traffic allows,drive for 90 seconds withoutmoving the accelerator pedal.(Vehicle speed may vary slightly;this is okay.) If you cannot do thisfor a continuous 90 secondsbecause of traffic conditions, drivefor at least 30 seconds, then repeatit two more times (for a total of 90seconds).
State Emissions Testing
472
06/08/12 19:21:10 31SJA620 0477
Customer Service................................Information . 474
....................Warranty Coverages . 475Reporting Safety Defects
..........................(U.S. Vehicles) . 476.....................Authorized Manuals . 477
Warranty and Customer Relations
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
473
06/08/12 19:21:13 31SJA620 0478
If you are dissatisfied with thedecision made by the dealership’smanagement, contact the AcuraClient Services Office.
U.S. Owners:
Canadian Owners:
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. VirginIslands:
When you call or write, please giveus this information:
Acura dealership personnel aretrained professionals. They shouldbe able to answer all your questions.If you encounter a problem that yourdealership does not solve to yoursatisfaction, please discuss it withthe dealership’s management. Theservice manager or general managercan help. Almost all problems aresolved in this way.
Vehicle identification number(see page )Name and address of the dealerwho services your vehicleDate of purchaseMileage on your vehicleYour name, address, and tele-phone numberA detailed description of theproblemName of the dealer who sold thevehicle to you
458
Customer Service Information
474
CUSTOMER RELATIONS
RELATIONS AVEC LA CLIENTÈLE
Honda Canada Inc.715 Milner AvenueToronto, ONM1B 2K8
Tel: 1-888-9-ACURA-9Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909
Toronto (416) 287-4776
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.Acura Client ServicesMail Stop 500-2N-7E1919 Torrance Blvd.Torrance, CA 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 382-2238
Vortex Motor Corp.Bella InternationalP.O. Box 190816San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: (787) 620-7546
06/08/12 19:21:20 31SJA620 0479
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
covers your new vehicle, except forthe battery, emissions controlsystems, and accessories, againstdefects in materials andworkmanship.
these twowarranties cover your vehicle’semissions control systems. Time,mileage, and coverage areconditional. Please read yourwarranty booklet for exactinformation.
providescoverage for as long as the pur-chaser of the muffler owns thevehicle.
Your new vehicle is covered by thesewarranties:
provides proratedcoverage for a replacement batterypurchased from your dealer.
this warranty gives upto 100 % credit toward a replacementbattery.
a seatbelt that fails to function properly iscovered by a limited warranty.Please read your warranty bookletfor details.
covers all Acurareplacement parts against defects inmaterials and workmanship.
Acura accessories are covered underthis warranty. Time and mileagelimits depend on the type ofaccessory and other factors. Pleaseread your warranty manual fordetails.
all exterior body panels arecovered for rust-through from theinside for the specified time periodwith no mileage limit.
Restrictions and exclusions apply toall these warranties. Please read the2007 Acura warranty informationbooklet that came with your vehiclefor precise information on warrantycoverages. Your vehicle’s originaltires are covered by theirmanufacturer. Tire warrantyinformation is in a separate booklet.
Please refer to the 2007 warrantymanual that came with your vehicle.
Warranty Coverages
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Emissions Control Systems DefectsWarranty and EmissionsPerformance Warranty
Replacement Muffler LifetimeLimited Warranty
Replacement Battery LimitedWarranty
Original Equipment Battery LimitedWarranty
Seat Belt Limited Warranty
Replacement Parts LimitedWarranty
Accessory Limited Warranty
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
475
06/08/12 19:21:31 31SJA620 0480
If you believe that your vehicle has adefect which could cause a crash orcould cause injury or death, youshould immediately inform theNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration (NHTSA), in additionto notifying American Honda MotorCo., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call theVehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at1-888-327-4236(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to
; or write to:Administrator, NHTSA, 400 SeventhStreet, SW., Washington, DC 20590.You can also obtain otherinformation about motor vehiclesafety from .
If NHTSA receives similar com-plaints, it may open an investigation,and if it finds that a safety defectexists in a group of vehicles, it mayorder a recall and remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannot becomeinvolved in individual problemsbetween you, your dealer, orAmerican Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)
476
http://www.saf ercar.gov
http://www.saf ercar.gov
06/08/12 19:21:35 31SJA620 0481
-
*
*
*
*2007
ACU
The publications shown below can be purchased from HelmIncorporated. You can order in any of three ways:
Detach and mail the order form on the right half of this pageCall Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356Go online at
If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc.at 1-800-782-4356.
(credit card orders only)
Valid only for sales within the United States. Canadianowners should contact their authorized Acura dealer.
Authorized Manuals
Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)
Authorized
Manuals
477
ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-782-4356
OR
(NOTE: For Credit Card Holder Orders Only)
MINIMUM CREDIT CARD PURCHASE $10.00
Price
Each
$80.00
$50.00
$44.00
$42.00
$29.00
$12.00
$12.00
FREE
Publication
Form Number
61SJA02
61SJA02EL
61SJA30
31SJA620
31SJA800
31SJAM20
31SJAQ20
ACU-R
Form Description
2005-2007 Acura RL
Service Manual
2005-2007 Acura RL
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual
2005 Model Series Acura RL
Body Repair Manual
2007 Acura RL Owner’s Manual
2007 Acura RL
Navigation System Manual
2007 Acura RL
Maintenance Journal
2007 Acura RL Quick Start Guide
Order Form for Previous Years
Indicate Year and Model Desired
PUBLICATION NUMBERVEHICLE MODEL
Name YearQty
Price
Each
Total
Price
GRAND TOTAL
HANDLING CHARGE
Mich. Purchases
Add 6% Sales Tax
TOTAL MATERIAL
$6.95
Monday-Friday 8:00 A.M. 6:00 P.M. EST
By completing this form you can order the materials desired. You canpay by check or money order, or charge to your credit card. Mail toHelm Incorporated at the address shown on the back of the order form.
Prices are subject to change withoutnotice and without incurring obligation.
Orders are mailed within 10 days. Pleaseallow adequate time for delivery.
Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurring obligation.
www. helminc. com
06/08/12 19:21:45 31SJA620 0482
-
-
-
SHIP
TO
PAYMENT
This manual covers maintenance and recommendedprocedures for repair to engine and chassis components.It is written for the journeyman mechanic, but is simpleenough for most mechanically-inclined owners to under-stand.
This manual complements the service manual byproviding in-depth troubleshooting information for eachelectrical circuit in your vehicle.
This manual describes the procedures involved in thereplacement of damaged body parts.
Authorized Manuals
Service Manual:
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:
Body Repair Manual:
478
NOTE: Dealers and Companies please provide dealer or company name,and also the name of the person to whose attention the shipment shouldbe sent. For purchases outside U.S.A. please write to the address shownbelow for a quotation.
P.O. BOX 07280·DETROIT, MICHIGAN 48207·1-800-782-4356
Customer Name Attention
Apartment Number
State & Zip CodeCity
Daytime Telephone Number
Check or money order enclosed payable to Helm Inc U.S. funds only.Do not send cash
MasterCard
VISA Check here if your billing address is differentfrom the shipping address shown above.
Account Number Expiration: Mo. Yr.
CUSTOMER SIGNATURE DATE
Street Address No P.O. Box Number
( )
These Publications cannot be returned for credit without receiving advance authorization within 14days of delivery. On returns, a restocking fee may be applied against the original order.
06/08/12 19:21:54 31SJA620 0483
CONTINUED
BatteryCharging System
...........................Indicator . 62, 443............................Jump Starting . 437
..............................Maintenance . 423..........................................Cover . 424
............................Specifications . 461..............................Before Driving . 325
..................................Belts, Seat . 10, 21.........................Beverage Holders . 190
..................................Booster Seats . 53Brakes
Anti-lock Brake System.....................................(ABS) . 353
.............Break-in, New Linings . 326...........................................Fluid . 402
.......................................Parking . 187.................System Indicator . 63, 445........................Wear Indicators . 352
.............................Braking System . 352.................Break-in, New Vehicle . 326
Brightness Control,...............................Instruments . 145
......................Brights, Headlights . 140Bulb Replacement
..........................Back-up Lights . 410.................................Fog Lights . 408
...............Front Position Lights . 407........Front Side Marker Lights . 407
.................................Headlights . 404............................Specifications . 461
....................Turn Signal Lights . 406
....................................Accessories . 333ACCESSORY (Ignition Switch
.....................................Position) . 151............Accessory Power Sockets . 192
......................................AcuraLink . 297Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
.....................................Indicator . 278...................................Operation . 280
Adaptive Front Lighting System..........................................(AFS) . 143
....................Additives, Engine Oil . 395.............................Airbag (SRS) . 11, 27
............................Air Conditioning . 198.......................Air Pressure, Tires . 417.......................Alcohol in Gasoline . 326
......................................Antifreeze . 398Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
...............................Indicator . 64, 353...................................Operation . 353
..............Anti-theft, Audio System . 239Anti-theft Steering Column
............................................Lock . 151.........................................Ashtrays . 193
................................Audio System . 207
Auto Control Mode, Starting........................................Engine . 341
..........Automatic Climate Control . 205.......................Automatic Lighting . 141
...Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners . 23.............Automatic Speed Control . 275..............Automatic Transmission . 343
..........................Capacity, Fluid . 460...............Checking Fluid Level . 400
.......................................Shifting . 343Shift Lever Position
...............................Indicators . 343................Shift Lever Positions . 343
....................Shift Lock Release . 348......................Auxiliary Input Jack . 236
Index
A
B
IND
EX
I
06/08/12 19:21:58 31SJA620 0484
.....................................Built-in-key . 164..............................Bulbs, Halogen . 404
............................Capacities Chart . 460.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 56
....................Cargo, How to Carry . 335.............CAUTION, Explanation of . iii
.........................................CD Care . 234.......................CD Error Message . 235
...................................CD Changer . 223................................Ceiling Lights . 196
........................Certification Label . 458.................................Chains, Tires . 420
....................Changing a Flat Tire . 432Changing Oil
........................................How to . 396......................................When to . 381
..........Charging System Indicator . 443............Checklist, Before Driving . 340
.....................................Child Safety . 38..............................Booster Seats . 53
...................................Child Seats . 45.....Important Safety Reminders . 38
..........................................Infants . 43
..........................Larger Children . 52.........................................LATCH . 47
......................Risks with Airbags . 39.............................Small Children . 44
.........................................Tethers . 51.........Where Should a Child Sit? . 39
.......................................Child Seats . 44.........................................LATCH . 47
..........Tether Anchorage Points . 51................Childproof Door Locks . 154
Cleaning...................................Seat Belts . 411
...............Climate Control System . 198.........................Clock, Setting the . 273........................CO in the Exhaust . 468
............Cold Weather, Starting in . 341Collision Mitigation Brake System
(CMBS).....................................Indicator . 360...................................Operation . 355
......................Compact Spare Tire . 431...........................Compass System . 240
.................Console Compartment . 191
.................Consumer Information . 474.............Controls, Instruments and . 59
Coolant........................................Adding . 398
....................................Checking . 331.........................Proper Solution . 398
...................Temperature Gauge . 70Crankcase Emissions Control
........................................System . 468................Cruise Control Indicator . 66............Cruise Control Operation . 275
...................................Cup Holders . 190.............Customer Service Office . 474
.........................Customize Settings . 81...................................ACC Setup . 89
................Door/Window Setup . 122.......KEYLESS ACCESS Setup . 108
...........................Lighting Setup . 115.................................Meter Setup . 94
...........................Position Setup . 103........................Setting to Default . 85
...............................Wiper Setup . 133
...............DANGER, Explanation of . iii...................................Dashboard . 4, 60
Index
D
C
II
06/08/12 19:22:03 31SJA620 0485
*
CONTINUED
..............Daytime Running Lights . 142.......................................Indicator . 66
.................................Dead Battery . 437............Defects, Reporting Safety . 476
..............Defogger, Rear Window . 146
..............Defrosting the Windows . 204..........................Differential Fluid . 460
....................................Dimensions . 460.............Dimming the Headlights . 140
Dipstick..........Automatic Transmission . 400
..................................Engine Oil . 331........................Directional Signals . 140
........Disc Brake Wear Indicators . 352.....................Disposal of Used Oil . 397
Doors............Locking and Unlocking . 152
..................Lockout Prevention . 152.................Monitor Indicator . 13, 79....................Power Door Locks . 152
........DOT Tire Quality Grading . 462...........Driver and Passenger Safety . 7
.......................................Driver’s ID . 81...........................................Driving . 339
....................................Economy . 332
Driving Position Memory........................................System . 160
..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 411
..............................Economy, Fuel . 332..................................Emergencies . 427
.............Battery, Jump Starting . 437...........Brake System Indicator . 445
................Changing a Flat Tire . 432.....Charging System Indicator . 443
..................Checking the Fuses . 449.......Hazard Warning Flashers . 145
............................Jump Starting . 437.....Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 443...Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 444
Opening the Fuel Fill Door................................Manually . 446
..................Overheated Engine . 440.......................................Towing . 455
.........................Emergency Brake . 187....................Emergency Flashers . 145
......................Emergency Towing . 455..........Emergency Trunk Opener . 154
.......................Emissions Controls . 468
.............Emissions Testing, State . 471Engine
............Check Starting System . 342...............Compartment Covers . 394
....Coolant Temperature Gauge . 70.........................If It Won’t Start . 436
Malfunction Indicator................................Lamp . 62, 444
.........................................Oil life . 381........Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 443..............Oil, What Kind to Use . 395
...............................Overheating . 440............................Specifications . 461............................Speed Limiter . 348
.......................................Starting . 341...................Engine Speed Limiter . 348
......................Ethanol in Gasoline . 326.Evaporative Emissions Controls . 468
...............................Exhaust Fumes . 56Exhaust Gas Recirculation
........................................System . 469Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat
........................................Belts by . 19
Index
E
IND
EX
III
06/08/12 19:22:08 31SJA620 0486
**
...................................Fan, Interior . 200.........................................Features . 197
....................Filling the Fuel Tank . 327Filters
.........................Dust and Pollen . 411...............................................Oil . 396
...........Flashers, Hazard Warning . 145...................Flat Tire, Changing a . 432
.....................................Floor Mats . 412Fluids
..........Automatic Transmission . 400..........................................Brake . 402
..........................Power Steering . 402..................Windshield Washer . 400
.....................................Fog Lights . 142........................Four-way Flashers . 145
............................Front Airbags . 11, 29......................................Front Seat . 155....................................Adjusting . 155
.......................................Heaters . 178
...................................Airbags . 11, 29...........................Air Ventilation . 179
.................................................Fuel . 326......................Fill Door and Cap . 327
...........................................Gauge . 70.....................Low Fuel Indicator . 66
................Octane Requirement . 326Opening the Fuel Fill Door
................................Manually . 446...............................Oxygenated . 326
........................Tank, Refueling . 327......................Tighten Fuel Cap . 328.....................Fuses, Checking the . 449
................Gas Mileage Improving . 332.........................................Gasoline . 326...........................................Gauge . 70
.....................Low Fuel Indicator . 66................Octane Requirement . 326
........................Tank, Refueling . 327................Gas Station Procedures . 327
.............................................Gauges . 70...Engine Coolant Temperature . 70
...............................................Fuel . 70GAWR (Gross Axle Weight
.......................................Rating) . 374............Gearshift Lever Positions . 343
......................................Glove Box . 189
...........................GPS initialization . 257GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight
.......................................Rating) . 374
.............Halogen Headlight Bulbs . 404..........................HandsFreeLink . 306
............Hazard Warning Flashers . 145Headlights
Adaptive Front Lighting System......................................(AFS) . 143
........................................Aiming . 404..................Automatic Lighting . 141
.........Daytime Running Lights . 142..................High Beam Indicator . 66
....................Lights On Indicator . 64..........Low Beams, Turning on . 140
.......................Reminder Chime . 140........Replacing Halogen Bulbs . 404
..........High beams, Turning on . 140...................................Washer . 138
............................Head Restraints . 156...............................Heated Mirror . 159
...................................Heater, Seat . 178.............High Altitude, Starting at . 341
Index
G
H
F
IV
TM
06/08/12 19:22:12 31SJA620 0487
CONTINUED
................................................Keys . 149................Keyless Access System . 163...............Keyless Access Remote . 164
...........Keyless Memory Settings . 170
.................Jacking up the Vehicle . 433.......................................Jack, Tire . 432
................................Jump Starting . 437
HomeLink Universal................................Transceiver . 293
.......................Hood, Opening the . 329...........................................Horn . 5, 136
...Identification Number, Vehicle . 458Ignition
............................................Keys . 149.........................................Switch . 151
............Timing Control System . 469......................Immobilizer System . 150
.........Important Safety Precautions . 8.........................................Indicators . 62
ABS (Anti-lock Brake............................System) . 64, 353
Aduptive Front lighting..................System (AFS) . 69, 143
Brake (Parking and Brake............................System) . 63, 445
................Charging System . 62, 443Collision Mitigation Brake
..............System (CMBS) . 69, 360.............................Cruise Control . 66
Electronically Controlled Power........Steering System (ECPS) . 68
.....................................Fog Light . 66...................................High Beam . 66
........Key (Immobilizer System) . 64.....Keyless Access System . 68, 176
.....................................Lights On . 64......................................Low Fuel . 66
................Low Oil Pressure . 62, 443Low Tire Pressure
...........................Indicator . 67, 365.............Malfunction (MIL) . 62, 444
.......................................Message . 68..............Seat Belt Reminder . 21, 62
..................Security System . 69, 274......................................SH-AWD . 67
...........................Side Airbag Off . 63...............................................SRS . 63
Turn Signal and Hazard...................................Warning . 65
..VSA (Vehicle Stability Assist) . 65VSA (Vehicle Stability Assist)
.........................Activation . 65, 371.........Indicators, Instrument Panel . 61
...............................Infant Restraint . 43
......................................Infant Seats . 43..........Tether Anchorage Points . 51
...................Inflation, Proper Tire . 415.................................Inside Mirror . 158
.............................Inspection, Tire . 417............................Instrument Panel . 61
......Instrument Panel Brightness . 145................Interface Dial . 199, 207, 297...............................Interior Lights . 196
........................................Introduction . i
Index
J
K
I
IND
EX
V
06/08/12 19:22:18 31SJA620 0488
.......................Label, Certification . 458...............Lane Change, Signaling . 140
........................Lap/Shoulder Belts . 22
........................Lights On Indicator . 64Lights
....................Bulb Replacement . 404.......................................Indicator . 61
......................................Position . 140................................Turn Signal . 140
.....................................Load Limit . 373....LOCK (Ignition Key Position) . 151
Locks.....Anti-theft Steering Column . 151
........................Childproof Door . 154............................Fuel Fill Door . 327
..................................Glove Box . 189...............................Power Door . 152
.........................................Trunk . 153......Trunk Pass-through Cover . 157
........................Low Coolant Level . 331.........................Low Fuel Indicator . 66
...Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 443...Lubricant Specifications Chart . 460
..........................Luggage, Storing . 335 ...................Neutral Gear Position . 344
..................New Vehicle Break-in . 326...................NOTICE, Explanation of . i
...............Numbers, Identification . 458..................................Maintenance . 379................................Main Items . 389
........................................Minder . 381Owner’s Maintenance
...................................Checks . 388.................................Record . 391-392
..........................................Safety . 380...................................Sub Items . 390
.Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 62, 444...........Memory, Driving Position . 160
.............................Message Display . 78..........................Message Indicator . 68
...............................Meters, Gauges . 70...................Methanol in Gasoline . 326
........................Mirrors, Adjusting . 158.................................Modifications . 333
...............Modifying Your Vehicle . 334................................Moonroof . 183-186
................................................MP3 . 230.............Multi-Information Display . 71
...Octane Requirement, Gasoline . 326.........................................Odometer . 72
...............................Odometer, Trip . 72Oil
........................Change, How to . 396......................Change, When to . 381......................Checking Engine . 331
...............................Life, Engine . 381..............Pressure Indicator . 62, 443
Selecting Proper Viscosity......................................Chart . 395
.....ON (Ignition Switch Position) . 151Onboard Refueling Vapor
....................................Recovery . 468............................Outside Mirrors . 158
....Outside Temperature Indicator . 73....................Overheating, Engine . 440
....Owner’s Maintenance Checks . 388.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 326
Index
O
M
N
L
VI
06/08/12 19:22:23 31SJA620 0489
*
*
CONTINUED
...................Radiator Overheating . 440.............Radio/CD Sound System . 207
...........................Readiness Codes . 444..Rear Lights, Bulb Replacement . 410
..........................Rear View Mirror . 158...............Rear Window Defogger . 146.............Reclining the Seat Backs . 155
.......................Reminder Indicators . 62...........................................Remote . 163
Replacement Information................Engine Oil and Filter . 396
..........................................Fuses . 447................................Light Bulbs . 404
....................................Schedule . 381...........................................Tires . 415
.............................Wiper Blades . 413Replacing Seat Belts After a
............................................Crash . 25...Reserve Tank, Engine Coolant . 331
...............................Restraint, Child . 38..................Reverse Gear Position . 344
............Reverse Tilt Door Mirror . 159..........................Rearview Camera . 324
......................................Roof Rack . 337
................................Rotation, Tire . 418
..............................Paddle Shifters . 345............Panel Brightness Control . 145
........................Park Gear Position . 344...........................................Parking . 351
...............................Parking Brake . 187Parking Brake and Brake
.................System Indicator . 63, 445..Parking Over Things that Burn . 470
...................................PAX System . 422.............................PGM-FI System . 469
........................Power Door Locks . 152...............Power Socket Locations . 192
............................Power Windows . 181.........Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . 19.........Protecting Adults and Teens . 13
...Additional Safety Precautions . 20.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19
........................Protecting Children . 38.......................Protecting Infants . 43
.......Protecting Larger Children . 52.........Protecting Small Children . 44
Using Child Seats with.....................................Tethers . 51
.............................Using LATCH . 47
................................Safety Belts . 10, 21.........Safety Defects, Reporting . 476
.................................Safety Features . 9.........................................Airbags . 11
.....................................Seat Belts . 10.............Safety Labels, Location of . 57
..............................Safety Messages . iii.................Satellite Digital Radio . 217
...................................Seat Belts . 10, 21...............Additional Information . 21
Automatic Seat Belt...............................Tensioners . 23
.....................................Cleaning . 411.............................e-pretensioner . 24
................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 17, 22................................Maintenance . 25
Reminder Indicator and................................Beeper . 21, 62
...................System Components . 21...............Use During Pregnancy . 19
Index
IND
EX
R
S
P
VII
06/08/12 19:22:29 31SJA620 0490
**
*
..................................Seat Heaters . 178..................Seat Position Memory . 160
.........................Seat Ventilation . 179......................Seats, Adjusting the . 155
............................Security System . 274.....Sequential Sports Shift Mode . 345
..........................Paddle Shifters . 345...............................Serial Number . 458
...........................Service Intervals . 381......Service Manual, Purchasing . 477
.........Service Station Procedures . 327........................................SH-AWD . 350
..Torque Distribution Monitor . 350.......................................Indicator . 67
...Shift Lever Position Indicators . 343........................Shift Lock Release . 348
..............................Side Airbags . 11, 32How the Side Airbag off
......................Indicator Works . 35...How Your Side Airbags Work . 32
................Side Curtain Airbags . 11, 34How Your Side Curtain
..........................Airbags Work . 34Side Marker Lights, Bulb
.........................Replacement in . 407.............................Signaling Turns . 140
.....................................Snow Tires . 420................................Sound System . 207
Spare Tire......................................Inflating . 431
............................Specifications . 461.....................Specification Charts . 460
................................Speed Limiter . 348.......................................Spotlights . 196
..........SRS, Additional Information . 26...Additional Safety Precautions . 37..How the SRS Indicator Works . 34
How Your Airbags............................Work . 29, 32, 34
........................SRS Components . 26..................................SRS Service . 36
.............................SRS Indicator . 34, 63START (Ignition Switch
.....................................Position) . 151.......................Starting the Engine . 341
...................Auto Control Mode . 341In Cold Weather at High
..................................Altitude . 341................With a Dead Battery . 437..............State Emissions Testing . 471
........Steam Coming from Engine . 440
Steering Wheel..............................Adjustments . 147
...........Anti-theft Column Lock . 151......................Position Memory . 160
Steering Wheel Buttons/.....................................Switches . 136
...................Stereo Sound System . 207....................Storing Your Vehicle . 425
......................................Sun Visors . 192Supplemental Restraint
................................System . 11, 26
......................................Servicing . 36.........................SRS Indicator . 34, 63
...................System Components . 26..................................Synthetic Oil . 396
.Taking Care of the Unexpected . 427Technical Descriptions
......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 462.....Emissions Control Systems . 468
Three Way Catalytic.............................Converters . 470
.......................Temperature Gauge . 70........Temperature, Inside Sensor . 206
Index
T
VIII
06/08/12 19:22:33 31SJA620 0491
CONTINUED
....................Temperature, Outside . 73..............Tether Anchorage Points . 51
Three Way Catalytic.................................Converters . 470
Tilt/Telescopic Steering.........................................Wheel . 147
....................................Timing Belt . 403
....................................Tire Chains . 420.........Tire, How to Change a Flat . 432
Tire Pressure Monitoring System..................................(TPMS) . 368
Monitoring Tire Pressure..................................Reading . 415
...........TPMS System Warning . 365...............................................Tires . 415
..............................Air Pressure . 417........................................Chains . 420
.........................Checking Wear . 417..........................Compact Spare . 431
......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 462......................................Inflation . 415
..................................Inspection . 417.............................Labeling . 464, 465
Low Tire Pressure...........................Indicator . 67, 365
..............Michelin PAX System . 422
......................Pressure Monitor . 367........Pressure Monitor System . 365
...................................Replacing . 419......................................Rotating . 418
...........................................Snow . 420............................Specifications . 461
...................Tools, Tire Changing . 432Torque Distribution Monitor
.................................(SH-AWD) . 350Towing
.....................................A Trailer . 373....Equipment and Accessories . 374
.............................Weight Limit . 373TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring
..................................System) . 365Required Federal
............................Explanation . 466.....................Warning Message . 369
.............................Trailer Loading . 373......................Trailer Towing Tips . 377
TransmissionChecking Fluid Level,
..............................Automatic . 400...........................Fluid Selection . 401
..............Identification Number . 458.............Shifting the Automatic . 343
.............................Treadwear . 418, 431
.......................................Trip Meter . 72..............................................Trunk . 153
..................Emergency Opener . 154...............................Opening the . 153
.......Open Monitor Indicator . 13, 79..................................Turn Signals . 140
Unexpected, Taking Care..........................................of the . 427
....Uniform Tire Quality Grading . 462........................Unleaded Gasoline . 326
.......Used Oil, How to Dispose of . 397
.................Vehicle Capacity Load . 336......................Vehicle Dimensions . 460
....Vehicle Identification Number . 458
Index
IND
EX
V
U
IX
06/08/12 19:22:38 31SJA620 0492
*
*
**
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)....................................System . 371
...VSA Activation Indicator . 65, 371.........................VSA Off Switch . 372
........VSA System Indicator . 65, 371.............................Vehicle Storage . 425
.................................................VIN . 458..................................Viscosity, Oil . 395
...................Voice Control System . 263
......................XM Satellite Radio . 217
............WARNING, Explanation of . iii.........Warning Labels, Location of . 57
....................Warranty Coverages . 475Washer, Windshield
........Checking the Fluid Level . 400...................................Operation . 137
Wheels.............Adjusting the Steering . 147............Alignment and Balance . 418
..........................Compact Spare . 431...............................Nut Wrench . 433
Windows.............................Auto Reverse . 182
................Operating the Power . 181
.........................Rear, Defogger . 146Windshield
.....................................Cleaning . 137...................................Defroster . 201
.....................................Washers . 137Wipers, Windshield
.......................Changing Blades . 413...................................Operation . 137
........Summer/Winter Position . 139..............................................WMA . 230
....................................Worn Tires . 417.....Wrecker, Emergency Towing . 455
::
U.S. onlyCanada only
Index
X
W
X
06/08/12 19:22:42 31SJA620 0493
Service Information Summary
Gasoline:
Fuel Tank Capacity:
Recommended Engine Oil:
Automatic Transmission Fluid:
Rear Differential Fluid: Brake Fluid:
Power Steering Fluid:
Transfer Assembly Fluid:
Tire Pressure (measured cold):
Spare Tire Pressure:4.5 US qt (4.3 )
Oil change capacity (includingfilter):
Premium unleaded gasoline,pump octane number of 91 orhigher.
API Premium grade 5W-20detergent oil (see page ).
SAE 90 or SAE 80W-90 viscosityhypoid gear oil, API serviceclassified GL4 or GL5 only.
SH-AWD clutch case
Capacity:SH-AWD differential case
0.77 US qt (0.73 )
Honda ATF-Z1 (AutomaticTransmission Fluid) preferred, ora DEXRON III ATF as atemporary replacement.
Honda Power Steering Fluidpreferred, or another brand ofpower steering fluid as atemporary replacement. Do notuse ATF (see page ).
Honda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 orDOT 4 brake fluid as a temporaryreplacement (see page ).
Front:32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
Rear:30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm )
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
Honda ATF-Z1 (AutomaticTransmission Fluid) preferred, ora DEXRON III ATF as atemporary replacement (see page
).
19.4 US gal (73 )
2.8 US qt (2.7 )395
400402
402
06/08/12 19:23:08 31SJA620 0497